blob: c747c0deacb8c5518df2d8ef885a8af0602d0bc9 [file] [log] [blame]
Andrew Geisslerf0343792020-11-18 10:42:21 -06001.. SPDX-License-Identifier: CC-BY-SA-2.0-UK
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002
3************
4Common Tasks
5************
6
7This chapter describes fundamental procedures such as creating layers,
8adding new software packages, extending or customizing images, porting
9work to new hardware (adding a new machine), and so forth. You will find
10that the procedures documented here occur often in the development cycle
11using the Yocto Project.
12
13Understanding and Creating Layers
14=================================
15
16The OpenEmbedded build system supports organizing
17:term:`Metadata` into multiple layers.
18Layers allow you to isolate different types of customizations from each
19other. For introductory information on the Yocto Project Layer Model,
20see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060021":ref:`overview-manual/yp-intro:the yocto project layer model`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050022section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
23
24Creating Your Own Layer
25-----------------------
26
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000027.. note::
28
29 It is very easy to create your own layers to use with the OpenEmbedded
30 build system, as the Yocto Project ships with tools that speed up creating
31 layers. This section describes the steps you perform by hand to create
32 layers so that you can better understand them. For information about the
33 layer-creation tools, see the
34 ":ref:`bsp-guide/bsp:creating a new bsp layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`"
35 section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package (BSP) Developer's
36 Guide and the ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:creating a general layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`"
37 section further down in this manual.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050038
39Follow these general steps to create your layer without using tools:
40
411. *Check Existing Layers:* Before creating a new layer, you should be
42 sure someone has not already created a layer containing the Metadata
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -060043 you need. You can see the :oe_layerindex:`OpenEmbedded Metadata Index <>`
44 for a list of layers from the OpenEmbedded community that can be used in
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050045 the Yocto Project. You could find a layer that is identical or close
46 to what you need.
47
482. *Create a Directory:* Create the directory for your layer. When you
49 create the layer, be sure to create the directory in an area not
50 associated with the Yocto Project :term:`Source Directory`
51 (e.g. the cloned ``poky`` repository).
52
53 While not strictly required, prepend the name of the directory with
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050054 the string "meta-". For example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050055
56 meta-mylayer
57 meta-GUI_xyz
58 meta-mymachine
59
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050060 With rare exceptions, a layer's name follows this form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050061
62 meta-root_name
63
64 Following this layer naming convention can save
65 you trouble later when tools, components, or variables "assume" your
66 layer name begins with "meta-". A notable example is in configuration
67 files as shown in the following step where layer names without the
68 "meta-" string are appended to several variables used in the
69 configuration.
70
713. *Create a Layer Configuration File:* Inside your new layer folder,
72 you need to create a ``conf/layer.conf`` file. It is easiest to take
73 an existing layer configuration file and copy that to your layer's
74 ``conf`` directory and then modify the file as needed.
75
76 The ``meta-yocto-bsp/conf/layer.conf`` file in the Yocto Project
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060077 :yocto_git:`Source Repositories </poky/tree/meta-yocto-bsp/conf>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050078 demonstrates the required syntax. For your layer, you need to replace
79 "yoctobsp" with a unique identifier for your layer (e.g. "machinexyz"
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050080 for a layer named "meta-machinexyz")::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050081
82 # We have a conf and classes directory, add to BBPATH
83 BBPATH .= ":${LAYERDIR}"
84
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050085 # We have recipes-* directories, add to BBFILES
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050086 BBFILES += "${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bb \
87 ${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bbappend"
88
89 BBFILE_COLLECTIONS += "yoctobsp"
90 BBFILE_PATTERN_yoctobsp = "^${LAYERDIR}/"
91 BBFILE_PRIORITY_yoctobsp = "5"
92 LAYERVERSION_yoctobsp = "4"
93 LAYERSERIES_COMPAT_yoctobsp = "dunfell"
94
95 Following is an explanation of the layer configuration file:
96
97 - :term:`BBPATH`: Adds the layer's
98 root directory to BitBake's search path. Through the use of the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050099 :term:`BBPATH` variable, BitBake locates class files (``.bbclass``),
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500100 configuration files, and files that are included with ``include``
101 and ``require`` statements. For these cases, BitBake uses the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500102 first file that matches the name found in :term:`BBPATH`. This is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500103 similar to the way the ``PATH`` variable is used for binaries. It
104 is recommended, therefore, that you use unique class and
105 configuration filenames in your custom layer.
106
107 - :term:`BBFILES`: Defines the
108 location for all recipes in the layer.
109
110 - :term:`BBFILE_COLLECTIONS`:
111 Establishes the current layer through a unique identifier that is
112 used throughout the OpenEmbedded build system to refer to the
113 layer. In this example, the identifier "yoctobsp" is the
114 representation for the container layer named "meta-yocto-bsp".
115
116 - :term:`BBFILE_PATTERN`:
117 Expands immediately during parsing to provide the directory of the
118 layer.
119
120 - :term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY`:
121 Establishes a priority to use for recipes in the layer when the
122 OpenEmbedded build finds recipes of the same name in different
123 layers.
124
125 - :term:`LAYERVERSION`:
126 Establishes a version number for the layer. You can use this
127 version number to specify this exact version of the layer as a
128 dependency when using the
129 :term:`LAYERDEPENDS`
130 variable.
131
132 - :term:`LAYERDEPENDS`:
133 Lists all layers on which this layer depends (if any).
134
135 - :term:`LAYERSERIES_COMPAT`:
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -0600136 Lists the :yocto_wiki:`Yocto Project </Releases>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500137 releases for which the current version is compatible. This
138 variable is a good way to indicate if your particular layer is
139 current.
140
1414. *Add Content:* Depending on the type of layer, add the content. If
142 the layer adds support for a machine, add the machine configuration
143 in a ``conf/machine/`` file within the layer. If the layer adds
144 distro policy, add the distro configuration in a ``conf/distro/``
145 file within the layer. If the layer introduces new recipes, put the
146 recipes you need in ``recipes-*`` subdirectories within the layer.
147
148 .. note::
149
150 For an explanation of layer hierarchy that is compliant with the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500151 Yocto Project, see the ":ref:`bsp-guide/bsp:example filesystem layout`"
152 section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package (BSP) Developer's Guide.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500153
1545. *Optionally Test for Compatibility:* If you want permission to use
155 the Yocto Project Compatibility logo with your layer or application
156 that uses your layer, perform the steps to apply for compatibility.
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -0500157 See the
158 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:making sure your layer is compatible with yocto project`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500159 section for more information.
160
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500161Following Best Practices When Creating Layers
162---------------------------------------------
163
164To create layers that are easier to maintain and that will not impact
165builds for other machines, you should consider the information in the
166following list:
167
168- *Avoid "Overlaying" Entire Recipes from Other Layers in Your
169 Configuration:* In other words, do not copy an entire recipe into
170 your layer and then modify it. Rather, use an append file
171 (``.bbappend``) to override only those parts of the original recipe
172 you need to modify.
173
174- *Avoid Duplicating Include Files:* Use append files (``.bbappend``)
175 for each recipe that uses an include file. Or, if you are introducing
176 a new recipe that requires the included file, use the path relative
177 to the original layer directory to refer to the file. For example,
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500178 use ``require recipes-core/``\ `package`\ ``/``\ `file`\ ``.inc`` instead
179 of ``require`` `file`\ ``.inc``. If you're finding you have to overlay
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500180 the include file, it could indicate a deficiency in the include file
181 in the layer to which it originally belongs. If this is the case, you
182 should try to address that deficiency instead of overlaying the
183 include file. For example, you could address this by getting the
184 maintainer of the include file to add a variable or variables to make
185 it easy to override the parts needing to be overridden.
186
187- *Structure Your Layers:* Proper use of overrides within append files
188 and placement of machine-specific files within your layer can ensure
189 that a build is not using the wrong Metadata and negatively impacting
190 a build for a different machine. Following are some examples:
191
192 - *Modify Variables to Support a Different Machine:* Suppose you
193 have a layer named ``meta-one`` that adds support for building
194 machine "one". To do so, you use an append file named
195 ``base-files.bbappend`` and create a dependency on "foo" by
196 altering the :term:`DEPENDS`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500197 variable::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500198
199 DEPENDS = "foo"
200
201 The dependency is created during any
202 build that includes the layer ``meta-one``. However, you might not
203 want this dependency for all machines. For example, suppose you
204 are building for machine "two" but your ``bblayers.conf`` file has
205 the ``meta-one`` layer included. During the build, the
206 ``base-files`` for machine "two" will also have the dependency on
207 ``foo``.
208
209 To make sure your changes apply only when building machine "one",
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500210 use a machine override with the :term:`DEPENDS` statement::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500211
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500212 DEPENDS:one = "foo"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500213
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500214 You should follow the same strategy when using ``:append``
215 and ``:prepend`` operations::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500216
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500217 DEPENDS:append:one = " foo"
218 DEPENDS:prepend:one = "foo "
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500219
220 As an actual example, here's a
221 snippet from the generic kernel include file ``linux-yocto.inc``,
222 wherein the kernel compile and link options are adjusted in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500223 case of a subset of the supported architectures::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500224
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500225 DEPENDS:append:aarch64 = " libgcc"
226 KERNEL_CC:append:aarch64 = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
227 KERNEL_LD:append:aarch64 = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500228
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500229 DEPENDS:append:nios2 = " libgcc"
230 KERNEL_CC:append:nios2 = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
231 KERNEL_LD:append:nios2 = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500232
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500233 DEPENDS:append:arc = " libgcc"
234 KERNEL_CC:append:arc = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
235 KERNEL_LD:append:arc = " ${TOOLCHAIN_OPTIONS}"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500236
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500237 KERNEL_FEATURES:append:qemuall=" features/debug/printk.scc"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500238
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500239 - *Place Machine-Specific Files in Machine-Specific Locations:* When
240 you have a base recipe, such as ``base-files.bb``, that contains a
241 :term:`SRC_URI` statement to a
242 file, you can use an append file to cause the build to use your
243 own version of the file. For example, an append file in your layer
244 at ``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files.bbappend`` could
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500245 extend :term:`FILESPATH` using :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` as follows::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500246
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500247 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "${THISDIR}/${BPN}:"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500248
249 The build for machine "one" will pick up your machine-specific file as
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500250 long as you have the file in
251 ``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files/``. However, if you
252 are building for a different machine and the ``bblayers.conf``
253 file includes the ``meta-one`` layer and the location of your
254 machine-specific file is the first location where that file is
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500255 found according to :term:`FILESPATH`, builds for all machines will
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500256 also use that machine-specific file.
257
258 You can make sure that a machine-specific file is used for a
259 particular machine by putting the file in a subdirectory specific
260 to the machine. For example, rather than placing the file in
261 ``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files/`` as shown above,
262 put it in ``meta-one/recipes-core/base-files/base-files/one/``.
263 Not only does this make sure the file is used only when building
264 for machine "one", but the build process locates the file more
265 quickly.
266
267 In summary, you need to place all files referenced from
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -0400268 :term:`SRC_URI` in a machine-specific subdirectory within the layer in
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500269 order to restrict those files to machine-specific builds.
270
271- *Perform Steps to Apply for Yocto Project Compatibility:* If you want
272 permission to use the Yocto Project Compatibility logo with your
273 layer or application that uses your layer, perform the steps to apply
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -0500274 for compatibility. See the
275 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:making sure your layer is compatible with yocto project`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500276 section for more information.
277
278- *Follow the Layer Naming Convention:* Store custom layers in a Git
279 repository that use the ``meta-layer_name`` format.
280
281- *Group Your Layers Locally:* Clone your repository alongside other
282 cloned ``meta`` directories from the :term:`Source Directory`.
283
284Making Sure Your Layer is Compatible With Yocto Project
285-------------------------------------------------------
286
287When you create a layer used with the Yocto Project, it is advantageous
288to make sure that the layer interacts well with existing Yocto Project
289layers (i.e. the layer is compatible with the Yocto Project). Ensuring
290compatibility makes the layer easy to be consumed by others in the Yocto
291Project community and could allow you permission to use the Yocto
292Project Compatible Logo.
293
294.. note::
295
296 Only Yocto Project member organizations are permitted to use the
297 Yocto Project Compatible Logo. The logo is not available for general
298 use. For information on how to become a Yocto Project member
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500299 organization, see the :yocto_home:`Yocto Project Website <>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500300
301The Yocto Project Compatibility Program consists of a layer application
302process that requests permission to use the Yocto Project Compatibility
303Logo for your layer and application. The process consists of two parts:
304
3051. Successfully passing a script (``yocto-check-layer``) that when run
306 against your layer, tests it against constraints based on experiences
307 of how layers have worked in the real world and where pitfalls have
308 been found. Getting a "PASS" result from the script is required for
309 successful compatibility registration.
310
3112. Completion of an application acceptance form, which you can find at
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -0600312 :yocto_home:`/webform/yocto-project-compatible-registration`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500313
314To be granted permission to use the logo, you need to satisfy the
315following:
316
317- Be able to check the box indicating that you got a "PASS" when
318 running the script against your layer.
319
320- Answer "Yes" to the questions on the form or have an acceptable
321 explanation for any questions answered "No".
322
323- Be a Yocto Project Member Organization.
324
325The remainder of this section presents information on the registration
326form and on the ``yocto-check-layer`` script.
327
328Yocto Project Compatible Program Application
329~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
330
331Use the form to apply for your layer's approval. Upon successful
332application, you can use the Yocto Project Compatibility Logo with your
333layer and the application that uses your layer.
334
335To access the form, use this link:
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -0600336:yocto_home:`/webform/yocto-project-compatible-registration`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500337Follow the instructions on the form to complete your application.
338
339The application consists of the following sections:
340
341- *Contact Information:* Provide your contact information as the fields
342 require. Along with your information, provide the released versions
343 of the Yocto Project for which your layer is compatible.
344
345- *Acceptance Criteria:* Provide "Yes" or "No" answers for each of the
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -0700346 items in the checklist. There is space at the bottom of the form for
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500347 any explanations for items for which you answered "No".
348
349- *Recommendations:* Provide answers for the questions regarding Linux
350 kernel use and build success.
351
352``yocto-check-layer`` Script
353~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
354
355The ``yocto-check-layer`` script provides you a way to assess how
356compatible your layer is with the Yocto Project. You should run this
357script prior to using the form to apply for compatibility as described
358in the previous section. You need to achieve a "PASS" result in order to
359have your application form successfully processed.
360
361The script divides tests into three areas: COMMON, BSP, and DISTRO. For
362example, given a distribution layer (DISTRO), the layer must pass both
363the COMMON and DISTRO related tests. Furthermore, if your layer is a BSP
364layer, the layer must pass the COMMON and BSP set of tests.
365
366To execute the script, enter the following commands from your build
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500367directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500368
369 $ source oe-init-build-env
370 $ yocto-check-layer your_layer_directory
371
372Be sure to provide the actual directory for your
373layer as part of the command.
374
375Entering the command causes the script to determine the type of layer
376and then to execute a set of specific tests against the layer. The
377following list overviews the test:
378
379- ``common.test_readme``: Tests if a ``README`` file exists in the
380 layer and the file is not empty.
381
382- ``common.test_parse``: Tests to make sure that BitBake can parse the
383 files without error (i.e. ``bitbake -p``).
384
385- ``common.test_show_environment``: Tests that the global or per-recipe
386 environment is in order without errors (i.e. ``bitbake -e``).
387
388- ``common.test_world``: Verifies that ``bitbake world`` works.
389
390- ``common.test_signatures``: Tests to be sure that BSP and DISTRO
391 layers do not come with recipes that change signatures.
392
393- ``common.test_layerseries_compat``: Verifies layer compatibility is
394 set properly.
395
396- ``bsp.test_bsp_defines_machines``: Tests if a BSP layer has machine
397 configurations.
398
399- ``bsp.test_bsp_no_set_machine``: Tests to ensure a BSP layer does not
400 set the machine when the layer is added.
401
402- ``bsp.test_machine_world``: Verifies that ``bitbake world`` works
403 regardless of which machine is selected.
404
405- ``bsp.test_machine_signatures``: Verifies that building for a
406 particular machine affects only the signature of tasks specific to
407 that machine.
408
409- ``distro.test_distro_defines_distros``: Tests if a DISTRO layer has
410 distro configurations.
411
412- ``distro.test_distro_no_set_distros``: Tests to ensure a DISTRO layer
413 does not set the distribution when the layer is added.
414
415Enabling Your Layer
416-------------------
417
418Before the OpenEmbedded build system can use your new layer, you need to
419enable it. To enable your layer, simply add your layer's path to the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500420:term:`BBLAYERS` variable in your ``conf/bblayers.conf`` file, which is
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -0500421found in the :term:`Build Directory`. The following example shows how to
422enable your new ``meta-mylayer`` layer (note how your new layer exists
423outside of the official ``poky`` repository which you would have checked
424out earlier)::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500425
426 # POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION is increased each time build/conf/bblayers.conf
427 # changes incompatibly
428 POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION = "2"
429 BBPATH = "${TOPDIR}"
430 BBFILES ?= ""
431 BBLAYERS ?= " \
432 /home/user/poky/meta \
433 /home/user/poky/meta-poky \
434 /home/user/poky/meta-yocto-bsp \
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -0500435 /home/user/mystuff/meta-mylayer \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500436 "
437
438BitBake parses each ``conf/layer.conf`` file from the top down as
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500439specified in the :term:`BBLAYERS` variable within the ``conf/bblayers.conf``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500440file. During the processing of each ``conf/layer.conf`` file, BitBake
441adds the recipes, classes and configurations contained within the
442particular layer to the source directory.
443
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500444Appending Other Layers Metadata With Your Layer
445-----------------------------------------------
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500446
447A recipe that appends Metadata to another recipe is called a BitBake
448append file. A BitBake append file uses the ``.bbappend`` file type
449suffix, while the corresponding recipe to which Metadata is being
450appended uses the ``.bb`` file type suffix.
451
452You can use a ``.bbappend`` file in your layer to make additions or
453changes to the content of another layer's recipe without having to copy
454the other layer's recipe into your layer. Your ``.bbappend`` file
455resides in your layer, while the main ``.bb`` recipe file to which you
456are appending Metadata resides in a different layer.
457
458Being able to append information to an existing recipe not only avoids
459duplication, but also automatically applies recipe changes from a
460different layer into your layer. If you were copying recipes, you would
461have to manually merge changes as they occur.
462
463When you create an append file, you must use the same root name as the
464corresponding recipe file. For example, the append file
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500465``someapp_3.1.bbappend`` must apply to ``someapp_3.1.bb``. This
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500466means the original recipe and append filenames are version
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500467number-specific. If the corresponding recipe is renamed to update to a
468newer version, you must also rename and possibly update the
469corresponding ``.bbappend`` as well. During the build process, BitBake
470displays an error on starting if it detects a ``.bbappend`` file that
471does not have a corresponding recipe with a matching name. See the
472:term:`BB_DANGLINGAPPENDS_WARNONLY`
473variable for information on how to handle this error.
474
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500475Overlaying a File Using Your Layer
476~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
477
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500478As an example, consider the main formfactor recipe and a corresponding
479formfactor append file both from the :term:`Source Directory`.
480Here is the main
481formfactor recipe, which is named ``formfactor_0.0.bb`` and located in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500482the "meta" layer at ``meta/recipes-bsp/formfactor``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500483
484 SUMMARY = "Device formfactor information"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500485 DESCRIPTION = "A formfactor configuration file provides information about the \
486 target hardware for which the image is being built and information that the \
487 build system cannot obtain from other sources such as the kernel."
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500488 SECTION = "base"
489 LICENSE = "MIT"
490 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://${COREBASE}/meta/COPYING.MIT;md5=3da9cfbcb788c80a0384361b4de20420"
491 PR = "r45"
492
493 SRC_URI = "file://config file://machconfig"
494 S = "${WORKDIR}"
495
496 PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}"
497 INHIBIT_DEFAULT_DEPS = "1"
498
499 do_install() {
500 # Install file only if it has contents
501 install -d ${D}${sysconfdir}/formfactor/
502 install -m 0644 ${S}/config ${D}${sysconfdir}/formfactor/
503 if [ -s "${S}/machconfig" ]; then
504 install -m 0644 ${S}/machconfig ${D}${sysconfdir}/formfactor/
505 fi
506 }
507
508In the main recipe, note the :term:`SRC_URI`
509variable, which tells the OpenEmbedded build system where to find files
510during the build.
511
512Following is the append file, which is named ``formfactor_0.0.bbappend``
513and is from the Raspberry Pi BSP Layer named ``meta-raspberrypi``. The
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500514file is in the layer at ``recipes-bsp/formfactor``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500515
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500516 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500517
518By default, the build system uses the
519:term:`FILESPATH` variable to
520locate files. This append file extends the locations by setting the
521:term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS`
522variable. Setting this variable in the ``.bbappend`` file is the most
523reliable and recommended method for adding directories to the search
524path used by the build system to find files.
525
526The statement in this example extends the directories to include
527``${``\ :term:`THISDIR`\ ``}/${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``,
528which resolves to a directory named ``formfactor`` in the same directory
529in which the append file resides (i.e.
530``meta-raspberrypi/recipes-bsp/formfactor``. This implies that you must
531have the supporting directory structure set up that will contain any
532files or patches you will be including from the layer.
533
534Using the immediate expansion assignment operator ``:=`` is important
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500535because of the reference to :term:`THISDIR`. The trailing colon character is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500536important as it ensures that items in the list remain colon-separated.
537
538.. note::
539
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500540 BitBake automatically defines the :term:`THISDIR` variable. You should
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500541 never set this variable yourself. Using ":prepend" as part of the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500542 :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` ensures your path will be searched prior to other
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500543 paths in the final list.
544
545 Also, not all append files add extra files. Many append files simply
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -0700546 allow to add build options (e.g. ``systemd``). For these cases, your
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500547 append file would not even use the :term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` statement.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500548
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500549The end result of this ``.bbappend`` file is that on a Raspberry Pi, where
550``rpi`` will exist in the list of :term:`OVERRIDES`, the file
551``meta-raspberrypi/recipes-bsp/formfactor/formfactor/rpi/machconfig`` will be
552used during :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch` and the test for a non-zero file size in
553:ref:`ref-tasks-install` will return true, and the file will be installed.
554
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -0500555Installing Additional Files Using Your Layer
556~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
557
558As another example, consider the main ``xserver-xf86-config`` recipe and a
559corresponding ``xserver-xf86-config`` append file both from the :term:`Source
560Directory`. Here is the main ``xserver-xf86-config`` recipe, which is named
561``xserver-xf86-config_0.1.bb`` and located in the "meta" layer at
562``meta/recipes-graphics/xorg-xserver``::
563
564 SUMMARY = "X.Org X server configuration file"
565 HOMEPAGE = "http://www.x.org"
566 SECTION = "x11/base"
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +0000567 LICENSE = "MIT"
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -0500568 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://${COREBASE}/meta/COPYING.MIT;md5=3da9cfbcb788c80a0384361b4de20420"
569 PR = "r33"
570
571 SRC_URI = "file://xorg.conf"
572
573 S = "${WORKDIR}"
574
575 CONFFILES:${PN} = "${sysconfdir}/X11/xorg.conf"
576
577 PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}"
578 ALLOW_EMPTY:${PN} = "1"
579
580 do_install () {
581 if test -s ${WORKDIR}/xorg.conf; then
582 install -d ${D}/${sysconfdir}/X11
583 install -m 0644 ${WORKDIR}/xorg.conf ${D}/${sysconfdir}/X11/
584 fi
585 }
586
587Following is the append file, which is named ``xserver-xf86-config_%.bbappend``
588and is from the Raspberry Pi BSP Layer named ``meta-raspberrypi``. The
589file is in the layer at ``recipes-graphics/xorg-xserver``::
590
591 FILESEXTRAPATHS:prepend := "${THISDIR}/${PN}:"
592
593 SRC_URI:append:rpi = " \
594 file://xorg.conf.d/98-pitft.conf \
595 file://xorg.conf.d/99-calibration.conf \
596 "
597 do_install:append:rpi () {
598 PITFT="${@bb.utils.contains("MACHINE_FEATURES", "pitft", "1", "0", d)}"
599 if [ "${PITFT}" = "1" ]; then
600 install -d ${D}/${sysconfdir}/X11/xorg.conf.d/
601 install -m 0644 ${WORKDIR}/xorg.conf.d/98-pitft.conf ${D}/${sysconfdir}/X11/xorg.conf.d/
602 install -m 0644 ${WORKDIR}/xorg.conf.d/99-calibration.conf ${D}/${sysconfdir}/X11/xorg.conf.d/
603 fi
604 }
605
606 FILES:${PN}:append:rpi = " ${sysconfdir}/X11/xorg.conf.d/*"
607
608Building off of the previous example, we once again are setting the
609:term:`FILESEXTRAPATHS` variable. In this case we are also using
610:term:`SRC_URI` to list additional source files to use when ``rpi`` is found in
611the list of :term:`OVERRIDES`. The :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task will then perform a
612check for an additional :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` that if set will cause these
613additional files to be installed. These additional files are listed in
614:term:`FILES` so that they will be packaged.
615
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500616Prioritizing Your Layer
617-----------------------
618
619Each layer is assigned a priority value. Priority values control which
620layer takes precedence if there are recipe files with the same name in
621multiple layers. For these cases, the recipe file from the layer with a
622higher priority number takes precedence. Priority values also affect the
623order in which multiple ``.bbappend`` files for the same recipe are
624applied. You can either specify the priority manually, or allow the
625build system to calculate it based on the layer's dependencies.
626
627To specify the layer's priority manually, use the
628:term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500629variable and append the layer's root name::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500630
631 BBFILE_PRIORITY_mylayer = "1"
632
633.. note::
634
635 It is possible for a recipe with a lower version number
636 :term:`PV` in a layer that has a higher
637 priority to take precedence.
638
639 Also, the layer priority does not currently affect the precedence
640 order of ``.conf`` or ``.bbclass`` files. Future versions of BitBake
641 might address this.
642
643Managing Layers
644---------------
645
646You can use the BitBake layer management tool ``bitbake-layers`` to
647provide a view into the structure of recipes across a multi-layer
648project. Being able to generate output that reports on configured layers
649with their paths and priorities and on ``.bbappend`` files and their
650applicable recipes can help to reveal potential problems.
651
652For help on the BitBake layer management tool, use the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500653command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500654
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500655 $ bitbake-layers --help
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500656
657The following list describes the available commands:
658
659- ``help:`` Displays general help or help on a specified command.
660
661- ``show-layers:`` Shows the current configured layers.
662
663- ``show-overlayed:`` Lists overlayed recipes. A recipe is overlayed
664 when a recipe with the same name exists in another layer that has a
665 higher layer priority.
666
667- ``show-recipes:`` Lists available recipes and the layers that
668 provide them.
669
670- ``show-appends:`` Lists ``.bbappend`` files and the recipe files to
671 which they apply.
672
673- ``show-cross-depends:`` Lists dependency relationships between
674 recipes that cross layer boundaries.
675
676- ``add-layer:`` Adds a layer to ``bblayers.conf``.
677
678- ``remove-layer:`` Removes a layer from ``bblayers.conf``
679
680- ``flatten:`` Flattens the layer configuration into a separate
681 output directory. Flattening your layer configuration builds a
682 "flattened" directory that contains the contents of all layers, with
683 any overlayed recipes removed and any ``.bbappend`` files appended to
684 the corresponding recipes. You might have to perform some manual
685 cleanup of the flattened layer as follows:
686
687 - Non-recipe files (such as patches) are overwritten. The flatten
688 command shows a warning for these files.
689
690 - Anything beyond the normal layer setup has been added to the
691 ``layer.conf`` file. Only the lowest priority layer's
692 ``layer.conf`` is used.
693
694 - Overridden and appended items from ``.bbappend`` files need to be
695 cleaned up. The contents of each ``.bbappend`` end up in the
696 flattened recipe. However, if there are appended or changed
697 variable values, you need to tidy these up yourself. Consider the
698 following example. Here, the ``bitbake-layers`` command adds the
699 line ``#### bbappended ...`` so that you know where the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500700 lines originate::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500701
702 ...
703 DESCRIPTION = "A useful utility"
704 ...
705 EXTRA_OECONF = "--enable-something"
706 ...
707
708 #### bbappended from meta-anotherlayer ####
709
710 DESCRIPTION = "Customized utility"
711 EXTRA_OECONF += "--enable-somethingelse"
712
713
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500714 Ideally, you would tidy up these utilities as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500715
716 ...
717 DESCRIPTION = "Customized utility"
718 ...
719 EXTRA_OECONF = "--enable-something --enable-somethingelse"
720 ...
721
722- ``layerindex-fetch``: Fetches a layer from a layer index, along
723 with its dependent layers, and adds the layers to the
724 ``conf/bblayers.conf`` file.
725
726- ``layerindex-show-depends``: Finds layer dependencies from the
727 layer index.
728
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -0500729- ``save-build-conf``: Saves the currently active build configuration
730 (``conf/local.conf``, ``conf/bblayers.conf``) as a template into a layer.
731 This template can later be used for setting up builds via :term:``TEMPLATECONF``.
732 For information about saving and using configuration templates, see
733 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:creating a custom template configuration directory`".
734
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500735- ``create-layer``: Creates a basic layer.
736
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -0500737- ``create-layers-setup``: Writes out a configuration file and/or a script that
738 can replicate the directory structure and revisions of the layers in a current build.
739 For more information, see ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:saving and restoring the layers setup`".
740
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500741Creating a General Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers`` Script
742------------------------------------------------------------
743
744The ``bitbake-layers`` script with the ``create-layer`` subcommand
745simplifies creating a new general layer.
746
747.. note::
748
749 - For information on BSP layers, see the ":ref:`bsp-guide/bsp:bsp layers`"
750 section in the Yocto
751 Project Board Specific (BSP) Developer's Guide.
752
753 - In order to use a layer with the OpenEmbedded build system, you
754 need to add the layer to your ``bblayers.conf`` configuration
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -0600755 file. See the ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:adding a layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500756 section for more information.
757
758The default mode of the script's operation with this subcommand is to
759create a layer with the following:
760
761- A layer priority of 6.
762
763- A ``conf`` subdirectory that contains a ``layer.conf`` file.
764
765- A ``recipes-example`` subdirectory that contains a further
766 subdirectory named ``example``, which contains an ``example.bb``
767 recipe file.
768
769- A ``COPYING.MIT``, which is the license statement for the layer. The
770 script assumes you want to use the MIT license, which is typical for
771 most layers, for the contents of the layer itself.
772
773- A ``README`` file, which is a file describing the contents of your
774 new layer.
775
776In its simplest form, you can use the following command form to create a
777layer. The command creates a layer whose name corresponds to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500778"your_layer_name" in the current directory::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500779
780 $ bitbake-layers create-layer your_layer_name
781
782As an example, the following command creates a layer named ``meta-scottrif``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500783in your home directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500784
785 $ cd /usr/home
786 $ bitbake-layers create-layer meta-scottrif
787 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
788 Add your new layer with 'bitbake-layers add-layer meta-scottrif'
789
790If you want to set the priority of the layer to other than the default
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500791value of "6", you can either use the ``--priority`` option or you
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500792can edit the
793:term:`BBFILE_PRIORITY` value
794in the ``conf/layer.conf`` after the script creates it. Furthermore, if
795you want to give the example recipe file some name other than the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500796default, you can use the ``--example-recipe-name`` option.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500797
798The easiest way to see how the ``bitbake-layers create-layer`` command
799works is to experiment with the script. You can also read the usage
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500800information by entering the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500801
802 $ bitbake-layers create-layer --help
803 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
804 usage: bitbake-layers create-layer [-h] [--priority PRIORITY]
805 [--example-recipe-name EXAMPLERECIPE]
806 layerdir
807
808 Create a basic layer
809
810 positional arguments:
811 layerdir Layer directory to create
812
813 optional arguments:
814 -h, --help show this help message and exit
815 --priority PRIORITY, -p PRIORITY
816 Layer directory to create
817 --example-recipe-name EXAMPLERECIPE, -e EXAMPLERECIPE
818 Filename of the example recipe
819
820Adding a Layer Using the ``bitbake-layers`` Script
821--------------------------------------------------
822
823Once you create your general layer, you must add it to your
824``bblayers.conf`` file. Adding the layer to this configuration file
825makes the OpenEmbedded build system aware of your layer so that it can
826search it for metadata.
827
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500828Add your layer by using the ``bitbake-layers add-layer`` command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500829
830 $ bitbake-layers add-layer your_layer_name
831
832Here is an example that adds a
833layer named ``meta-scottrif`` to the configuration file. Following the
834command that adds the layer is another ``bitbake-layers`` command that
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500835shows the layers that are in your ``bblayers.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500836
837 $ bitbake-layers add-layer meta-scottrif
838 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
839 Parsing recipes: 100% |##########################################################| Time: 0:00:49
840 Parsing of 1441 .bb files complete (0 cached, 1441 parsed). 2055 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors.
841 $ bitbake-layers show-layers
842 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
843 layer path priority
844 ==========================================================================
845 meta /home/scottrif/poky/meta 5
846 meta-poky /home/scottrif/poky/meta-poky 5
847 meta-yocto-bsp /home/scottrif/poky/meta-yocto-bsp 5
848 workspace /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace 99
849 meta-scottrif /home/scottrif/poky/build/meta-scottrif 6
850
851
852Adding the layer to this file
853enables the build system to locate the layer during the build.
854
855.. note::
856
857 During a build, the OpenEmbedded build system looks in the layers
858 from the top of the list down to the bottom in that order.
859
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -0500860Saving and restoring the layers setup
861-------------------------------------
862
863Once you have a working build with the correct set of layers, it is beneficial
864to capture the layer setup --- what they are, which repositories they come from
865and which SCM revisions they're at --- into a configuration file, so that this
866setup can be easily replicated later, perhaps on a different machine. Here's
867how to do this::
868
869 $ bitbake-layers create-layers-setup /srv/work/alex/meta-alex/
870 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
871 NOTE: Created /srv/work/alex/meta-alex/setup-layers.json
872 NOTE: Created /srv/work/alex/meta-alex/setup-layers
873
874The tool needs a single argument which tells where to place the output, consisting
875of a json formatted layer configuration, and a ``setup-layers`` script that can use that configuration
876to restore the layers in a different location, or on a different host machine. The argument
877can point to a custom layer (which is then deemed a "bootstrap" layer that needs to be
878checked out first), or into a completely independent location.
879
880The replication of the layers is performed by running the ``setup-layers`` script provided
881above:
882
8831. Clone the bootstrap layer or some other repository to obtain
884 the json config and the setup script that can use it.
885
8862. Run the script directly with no options::
887
888 alex@Zen2:/srv/work/alex/my-build$ meta-alex/setup-layers
889 Note: not checking out source meta-alex, use --force-bootstraplayer-checkout to override.
890
891 Setting up source meta-intel, revision 15.0-hardknott-3.3-310-g0a96edae, branch master
892 Running 'git init -q /srv/work/alex/my-build/meta-intel'
893 Running 'git remote remove origin > /dev/null 2>&1; git remote add origin git://git.yoctoproject.org/meta-intel' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/meta-intel
894 Running 'git fetch -q origin || true' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/meta-intel
895 Running 'git checkout -q 0a96edae609a3f48befac36af82cf1eed6786b4a' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/meta-intel
896
897 Setting up source poky, revision 4.1_M1-372-g55483d28f2, branch akanavin/setup-layers
898 Running 'git init -q /srv/work/alex/my-build/poky'
899 Running 'git remote remove origin > /dev/null 2>&1; git remote add origin git://git.yoctoproject.org/poky' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/poky
900 Running 'git fetch -q origin || true' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/poky
901 Running 'git remote remove poky-contrib > /dev/null 2>&1; git remote add poky-contrib ssh://git@push.yoctoproject.org/poky-contrib' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/poky
902 Running 'git fetch -q poky-contrib || true' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/poky
903 Running 'git checkout -q 11db0390b02acac1324e0f827beb0e2e3d0d1d63' in /srv/work/alex/my-build/poky
904
905.. note::
906 This will work to update an existing checkout as well.
907
908.. note::
909 The script is self-sufficient and requires only python3
910 and git on the build machine.
911
912.. note::
913 Both the ``create-layers-setup`` and the ``setup-layers`` provided several additional options
914 that customize their behavior - you are welcome to study them via ``--help`` command line parameter.
915
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500916Customizing Images
917==================
918
919You can customize images to satisfy particular requirements. This
920section describes several methods and provides guidelines for each.
921
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500922Customizing Images Using ``local.conf``
923---------------------------------------
924
925Probably the easiest way to customize an image is to add a package by
926way of the ``local.conf`` configuration file. Because it is limited to
927local use, this method generally only allows you to add packages and is
928not as flexible as creating your own customized image. When you add
929packages using local variables this way, you need to realize that these
930variable changes are in effect for every build and consequently affect
931all images, which might not be what you require.
932
933To add a package to your image using the local configuration file, use
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500934the :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable with the ``:append`` operator::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500935
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500936 IMAGE_INSTALL:append = " strace"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500937
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -0500938Use of the syntax is important; specifically, the leading space
939after the opening quote and before the package name, which is
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500940``strace`` in this example. This space is required since the ``:append``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500941operator does not add the space.
942
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500943Furthermore, you must use ``:append`` instead of the ``+=`` operator if
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500944you want to avoid ordering issues. The reason for this is because doing
945so unconditionally appends to the variable and avoids ordering problems
946due to the variable being set in image recipes and ``.bbclass`` files
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500947with operators like ``?=``. Using ``:append`` ensures the operation
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500948takes effect.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500949
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500950As shown in its simplest use, ``IMAGE_INSTALL:append`` affects all
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500951images. It is possible to extend the syntax so that the variable applies
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500952to a specific image only. Here is an example::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500953
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -0500954 IMAGE_INSTALL:append:pn-core-image-minimal = " strace"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500955
956This example adds ``strace`` to the ``core-image-minimal`` image only.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500957
958You can add packages using a similar approach through the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500959:term:`CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL` variable. If you use this variable, only
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500960``core-image-*`` images are affected.
961
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500962Customizing Images Using Custom ``IMAGE_FEATURES`` and ``EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES``
963-------------------------------------------------------------------------------
964
965Another method for customizing your image is to enable or disable
966high-level image features by using the
967:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` and
968:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`
969variables. Although the functions for both variables are nearly
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500970equivalent, best practices dictate using :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` from within
971a recipe and using :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` from within your
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -0500972``local.conf`` file, which is found in the :term:`Build Directory`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500973
974To understand how these features work, the best reference is
Patrick Williams975a06f2022-10-21 14:42:47 -0500975:ref:`meta/classes-recipe/image.bbclass <ref-classes-image>`.
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +0000976This class lists out the available
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500977:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` of which most map to package groups while some, such
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500978as ``debug-tweaks`` and ``read-only-rootfs``, resolve as general
979configuration settings.
980
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500981In summary, the file looks at the contents of the :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500982variable and then maps or configures the feature accordingly. Based on
983this information, the build system automatically adds the appropriate
984packages or configurations to the
985:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable.
986Effectively, you are enabling extra features by extending the class or
987creating a custom class for use with specialized image ``.bb`` files.
988
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500989Use the :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` variable from within your local
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500990configuration file. Using a separate area from which to enable features
991with this variable helps you avoid overwriting the features in the image
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -0500992recipe that are enabled with :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`. The value of
993:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` is added to :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` within
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -0500994``meta/conf/bitbake.conf``.
995
996To illustrate how you can use these variables to modify your image,
997consider an example that selects the SSH server. The Yocto Project ships
998with two SSH servers you can use with your images: Dropbear and OpenSSH.
999Dropbear is a minimal SSH server appropriate for resource-constrained
1000environments, while OpenSSH is a well-known standard SSH server
1001implementation. By default, the ``core-image-sato`` image is configured
1002to use Dropbear. The ``core-image-full-cmdline`` and ``core-image-lsb``
1003images both include OpenSSH. The ``core-image-minimal`` image does not
1004contain an SSH server.
1005
1006You can customize your image and change these defaults. Edit the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001007:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variable in your recipe or use the
1008:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` in your ``local.conf`` file so that it
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001009configures the image you are working with to include
1010``ssh-server-dropbear`` or ``ssh-server-openssh``.
1011
1012.. note::
1013
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001014 See the ":ref:`ref-manual/features:image features`" section in the Yocto
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001015 Project Reference Manual for a complete list of image features that ship
1016 with the Yocto Project.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001017
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001018Customizing Images Using Custom .bb Files
1019-----------------------------------------
1020
1021You can also customize an image by creating a custom recipe that defines
1022additional software as part of the image. The following example shows
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001023the form for the two lines you need::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001024
1025 IMAGE_INSTALL = "packagegroup-core-x11-base package1 package2"
1026 inherit core-image
1027
1028Defining the software using a custom recipe gives you total control over
1029the contents of the image. It is important to use the correct names of
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001030packages in the :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable. You must use the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001031OpenEmbedded notation and not the Debian notation for the names (e.g.
1032``glibc-dev`` instead of ``libc6-dev``).
1033
1034The other method for creating a custom image is to base it on an
1035existing image. For example, if you want to create an image based on
1036``core-image-sato`` but add the additional package ``strace`` to the
1037image, copy the ``meta/recipes-sato/images/core-image-sato.bb`` to a new
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001038``.bb`` and add the following line to the end of the copy::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001039
1040 IMAGE_INSTALL += "strace"
1041
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001042Customizing Images Using Custom Package Groups
1043----------------------------------------------
1044
1045For complex custom images, the best approach for customizing an image is
1046to create a custom package group recipe that is used to build the image
1047or images. A good example of a package group recipe is
1048``meta/recipes-core/packagegroups/packagegroup-base.bb``.
1049
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001050If you examine that recipe, you see that the :term:`PACKAGES` variable lists
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001051the package group packages to produce. The ``inherit packagegroup``
1052statement sets appropriate default values and automatically adds
1053``-dev``, ``-dbg``, and ``-ptest`` complementary packages for each
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001054package specified in the :term:`PACKAGES` statement.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001055
1056.. note::
1057
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001058 The ``inherit packagegroup`` line should be located near the top of the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001059 recipe, certainly before the :term:`PACKAGES` statement.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001060
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001061For each package you specify in :term:`PACKAGES`, you can use :term:`RDEPENDS`
1062and :term:`RRECOMMENDS` entries to provide a list of packages the parent
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001063task package should contain. You can see examples of these further down
1064in the ``packagegroup-base.bb`` recipe.
1065
1066Here is a short, fabricated example showing the same basic pieces for a
1067hypothetical packagegroup defined in ``packagegroup-custom.bb``, where
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001068the variable :term:`PN` is the standard way to abbreviate the reference to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001069the full packagegroup name ``packagegroup-custom``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001070
1071 DESCRIPTION = "My Custom Package Groups"
1072
1073 inherit packagegroup
1074
1075 PACKAGES = "\
1076 ${PN}-apps \
1077 ${PN}-tools \
1078 "
1079
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001080 RDEPENDS:${PN}-apps = "\
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001081 dropbear \
1082 portmap \
1083 psplash"
1084
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001085 RDEPENDS:${PN}-tools = "\
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001086 oprofile \
1087 oprofileui-server \
1088 lttng-tools"
1089
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001090 RRECOMMENDS:${PN}-tools = "\
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001091 kernel-module-oprofile"
1092
1093In the previous example, two package group packages are created with
1094their dependencies and their recommended package dependencies listed:
1095``packagegroup-custom-apps``, and ``packagegroup-custom-tools``. To
1096build an image using these package group packages, you need to add
1097``packagegroup-custom-apps`` and/or ``packagegroup-custom-tools`` to
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001098:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`. For other forms of image dependencies see the other
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001099areas of this section.
1100
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001101Customizing an Image Hostname
1102-----------------------------
1103
1104By default, the configured hostname (i.e. ``/etc/hostname``) in an image
1105is the same as the machine name. For example, if
1106:term:`MACHINE` equals "qemux86", the
1107configured hostname written to ``/etc/hostname`` is "qemux86".
1108
1109You can customize this name by altering the value of the "hostname"
1110variable in the ``base-files`` recipe using either an append file or a
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001111configuration file. Use the following in an append file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001112
1113 hostname = "myhostname"
1114
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001115Use the following in a configuration file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001116
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001117 hostname:pn-base-files = "myhostname"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001118
1119Changing the default value of the variable "hostname" can be useful in
1120certain situations. For example, suppose you need to do extensive
1121testing on an image and you would like to easily identify the image
1122under test from existing images with typical default hostnames. In this
1123situation, you could change the default hostname to "testme", which
1124results in all the images using the name "testme". Once testing is
1125complete and you do not need to rebuild the image for test any longer,
1126you can easily reset the default hostname.
1127
1128Another point of interest is that if you unset the variable, the image
1129will have no default hostname in the filesystem. Here is an example that
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001130unsets the variable in a configuration file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001131
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001132 hostname:pn-base-files = ""
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001133
1134Having no default hostname in the filesystem is suitable for
1135environments that use dynamic hostnames such as virtual machines.
1136
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001137Writing a New Recipe
1138====================
1139
1140Recipes (``.bb`` files) are fundamental components in the Yocto Project
1141environment. Each software component built by the OpenEmbedded build
1142system requires a recipe to define the component. This section describes
1143how to create, write, and test a new recipe.
1144
1145.. note::
1146
1147 For information on variables that are useful for recipes and for
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001148 information about recipe naming issues, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001149 ":ref:`ref-manual/varlocality:recipes`" section of the Yocto Project
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001150 Reference Manual.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001151
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001152Overview
1153--------
1154
1155The following figure shows the basic process for creating a new recipe.
1156The remainder of the section provides details for the steps.
1157
1158.. image:: figures/recipe-workflow.png
1159 :align: center
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05001160 :width: 50%
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001161
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001162Locate or Automatically Create a Base Recipe
1163--------------------------------------------
1164
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07001165You can always write a recipe from scratch. However, there are three choices
1166that can help you quickly get started with a new recipe:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001167
1168- ``devtool add``: A command that assists in creating a recipe and an
1169 environment conducive to development.
1170
1171- ``recipetool create``: A command provided by the Yocto Project that
1172 automates creation of a base recipe based on the source files.
1173
1174- *Existing Recipes:* Location and modification of an existing recipe
1175 that is similar in function to the recipe you need.
1176
1177.. note::
1178
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001179 For information on recipe syntax, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001180 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:recipe syntax`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001181
1182Creating the Base Recipe Using ``devtool add``
1183~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1184
1185The ``devtool add`` command uses the same logic for auto-creating the
1186recipe as ``recipetool create``, which is listed below. Additionally,
1187however, ``devtool add`` sets up an environment that makes it easy for
1188you to patch the source and to make changes to the recipe as is often
1189necessary when adding a recipe to build a new piece of software to be
1190included in a build.
1191
1192You can find a complete description of the ``devtool add`` command in
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001193the ":ref:`sdk-manual/extensible:a closer look at \`\`devtool add\`\``" section
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001194in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible Software
1195Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
1196
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001197Creating the Base Recipe Using ``recipetool create``
1198~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1199
1200``recipetool create`` automates creation of a base recipe given a set of
1201source code files. As long as you can extract or point to the source
1202files, the tool will construct a recipe and automatically configure all
1203pre-build information into the recipe. For example, suppose you have an
1204application that builds using Autotools. Creating the base recipe using
1205``recipetool`` results in a recipe that has the pre-build dependencies,
1206license requirements, and checksums configured.
1207
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05001208To run the tool, you just need to be in your :term:`Build Directory` and
1209have sourced the build environment setup script (i.e.
1210:ref:`structure-core-script`). To get help on the tool, use the following
1211command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001212
1213 $ recipetool -h
1214 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
1215 usage: recipetool [-d] [-q] [--color COLOR] [-h] <subcommand> ...
1216
1217 OpenEmbedded recipe tool
1218
1219 options:
1220 -d, --debug Enable debug output
1221 -q, --quiet Print only errors
1222 --color COLOR Colorize output (where COLOR is auto, always, never)
1223 -h, --help show this help message and exit
1224
1225 subcommands:
1226 create Create a new recipe
1227 newappend Create a bbappend for the specified target in the specified
1228 layer
1229 setvar Set a variable within a recipe
1230 appendfile Create/update a bbappend to replace a target file
1231 appendsrcfiles Create/update a bbappend to add or replace source files
1232 appendsrcfile Create/update a bbappend to add or replace a source file
1233 Use recipetool <subcommand> --help to get help on a specific command
1234
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001235Running ``recipetool create -o OUTFILE`` creates the base recipe and
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001236locates it properly in the layer that contains your source files.
1237Following are some syntax examples:
1238
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001239 - Use this syntax to generate a recipe based on source. Once generated,
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001240 the recipe resides in the existing source code layer::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001241
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001242 recipetool create -o OUTFILE source
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001243
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001244 - Use this syntax to generate a recipe using code that
1245 you extract from source. The extracted code is placed in its own layer
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001246 defined by :term:`EXTERNALSRC`.
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001247 ::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001248
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001249 recipetool create -o OUTFILE -x EXTERNALSRC source
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001250
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001251 - Use this syntax to generate a recipe based on source. The options
1252 direct ``recipetool`` to generate debugging information. Once generated,
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001253 the recipe resides in the existing source code layer::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001254
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001255 recipetool create -d -o OUTFILE source
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001256
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001257Locating and Using a Similar Recipe
1258~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1259
1260Before writing a recipe from scratch, it is often useful to discover
1261whether someone else has already written one that meets (or comes close
1262to meeting) your needs. The Yocto Project and OpenEmbedded communities
1263maintain many recipes that might be candidates for what you are doing.
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -06001264You can find a good central index of these recipes in the
1265:oe_layerindex:`OpenEmbedded Layer Index <>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001266
1267Working from an existing recipe or a skeleton recipe is the best way to
1268get started. Here are some points on both methods:
1269
1270- *Locate and modify a recipe that is close to what you want to do:*
1271 This method works when you are familiar with the current recipe
1272 space. The method does not work so well for those new to the Yocto
1273 Project or writing recipes.
1274
1275 Some risks associated with this method are using a recipe that has
1276 areas totally unrelated to what you are trying to accomplish with
1277 your recipe, not recognizing areas of the recipe that you might have
1278 to add from scratch, and so forth. All these risks stem from
1279 unfamiliarity with the existing recipe space.
1280
1281- *Use and modify the following skeleton recipe:* If for some reason
1282 you do not want to use ``recipetool`` and you cannot find an existing
1283 recipe that is close to meeting your needs, you can use the following
1284 structure to provide the fundamental areas of a new recipe.
1285 ::
1286
1287 DESCRIPTION = ""
1288 HOMEPAGE = ""
1289 LICENSE = ""
1290 SECTION = ""
1291 DEPENDS = ""
1292 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = ""
1293
1294 SRC_URI = ""
1295
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001296Storing and Naming the Recipe
1297-----------------------------
1298
1299Once you have your base recipe, you should put it in your own layer and
1300name it appropriately. Locating it correctly ensures that the
1301OpenEmbedded build system can find it when you use BitBake to process
1302the recipe.
1303
1304- *Storing Your Recipe:* The OpenEmbedded build system locates your
1305 recipe through the layer's ``conf/layer.conf`` file and the
1306 :term:`BBFILES` variable. This
1307 variable sets up a path from which the build system can locate
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001308 recipes. Here is the typical use::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001309
1310 BBFILES += "${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bb \
1311 ${LAYERDIR}/recipes-*/*/*.bbappend"
1312
1313 Consequently, you need to be sure you locate your new recipe inside
1314 your layer such that it can be found.
1315
1316 You can find more information on how layers are structured in the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001317 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:understanding and creating layers`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001318
1319- *Naming Your Recipe:* When you name your recipe, you need to follow
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001320 this naming convention::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001321
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001322 basename_version.bb
1323
1324 Use lower-cased characters and do not include the reserved suffixes
1325 ``-native``, ``-cross``, ``-initial``, or ``-dev`` casually (i.e. do not use
1326 them as part of your recipe name unless the string applies). Here are some
1327 examples:
1328
1329 .. code-block:: none
1330
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001331 cups_1.7.0.bb
1332 gawk_4.0.2.bb
1333 irssi_0.8.16-rc1.bb
1334
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001335Running a Build on the Recipe
1336-----------------------------
1337
1338Creating a new recipe is usually an iterative process that requires
1339using BitBake to process the recipe multiple times in order to
1340progressively discover and add information to the recipe file.
1341
1342Assuming you have sourced the build environment setup script (i.e.
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05001343:ref:`structure-core-script`) and you are in the :term:`Build Directory`, use
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001344BitBake to process your recipe. All you need to provide is the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001345``basename`` of the recipe as described in the previous section::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001346
1347 $ bitbake basename
1348
1349During the build, the OpenEmbedded build system creates a temporary work
1350directory for each recipe
1351(``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}``)
1352where it keeps extracted source files, log files, intermediate
1353compilation and packaging files, and so forth.
1354
1355The path to the per-recipe temporary work directory depends on the
1356context in which it is being built. The quickest way to find this path
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001357is to have BitBake return it by running the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001358
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001359 $ bitbake -e basename | grep ^WORKDIR=
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001360
1361As an example, assume a Source Directory
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05001362top-level folder named ``poky``, a default :term:`Build Directory` at
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001363``poky/build``, and a ``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system.
1364Furthermore, suppose your recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0.bb``. In this
1365case, the work directory the build system uses to build the package
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001366would be as follows::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001367
1368 poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0
1369
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001370Inside this directory you can find sub-directories such as ``image``,
1371``packages-split``, and ``temp``. After the build, you can examine these
1372to determine how well the build went.
1373
1374.. note::
1375
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001376 You can find log files for each task in the recipe's ``temp``
1377 directory (e.g. ``poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0/temp``).
1378 Log files are named ``log.taskname`` (e.g. ``log.do_configure``,
1379 ``log.do_fetch``, and ``log.do_compile``).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001380
1381You can find more information about the build process in
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001382":doc:`/overview-manual/development-environment`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001383chapter of the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
1384
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001385Fetching Code
1386-------------
1387
1388The first thing your recipe must do is specify how to fetch the source
1389files. Fetching is controlled mainly through the
1390:term:`SRC_URI` variable. Your recipe
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001391must have a :term:`SRC_URI` variable that points to where the source is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001392located. For a graphical representation of source locations, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001393":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:sources`" section in
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001394the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
1395
1396The :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch` task uses
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001397the prefix of each entry in the :term:`SRC_URI` variable value to determine
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001398which :ref:`fetcher <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-fetching:fetchers>` to use to get your
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001399source files. It is the :term:`SRC_URI` variable that triggers the fetcher.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001400The :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task uses
1401the variable after source is fetched to apply patches. The OpenEmbedded
1402build system uses
1403:term:`FILESOVERRIDES` for
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001404scanning directory locations for local files in :term:`SRC_URI`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001405
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001406The :term:`SRC_URI` variable in your recipe must define each unique location
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001407for your source files. It is good practice to not hard-code version
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04001408numbers in a URL used in :term:`SRC_URI`. Rather than hard-code these
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001409values, use ``${``\ :term:`PV`\ ``}``,
1410which causes the fetch process to use the version specified in the
1411recipe filename. Specifying the version in this manner means that
1412upgrading the recipe to a future version is as simple as renaming the
1413recipe to match the new version.
1414
1415Here is a simple example from the
1416``meta/recipes-devtools/strace/strace_5.5.bb`` recipe where the source
1417comes from a single tarball. Notice the use of the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001418:term:`PV` variable::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001419
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001420 SRC_URI = "https://strace.io/files/${PV}/strace-${PV}.tar.xz \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001421
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001422Files mentioned in :term:`SRC_URI` whose names end in a typical archive
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001423extension (e.g. ``.tar``, ``.tar.gz``, ``.tar.bz2``, ``.zip``, and so
1424forth), are automatically extracted during the
1425:ref:`ref-tasks-unpack` task. For
1426another example that specifies these types of files, see the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001427":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:autotooled package`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001428
1429Another way of specifying source is from an SCM. For Git repositories,
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00001430you must specify :term:`SRCREV` and you should specify :term:`PV` to include
1431the revision with :term:`SRCPV`. Here is an example from the recipe
1432``meta/recipes-core/musl/gcompat_git.bb``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001433
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00001434 SRC_URI = "git://git.adelielinux.org/adelie/gcompat.git;protocol=https;branch=current"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001435
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00001436 PV = "1.0.0+1.1+git${SRCPV}"
1437 SRCREV = "af5a49e489fdc04b9cf02547650d7aeaccd43793"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001438
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001439If your :term:`SRC_URI` statement includes URLs pointing to individual files
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001440fetched from a remote server other than a version control system,
1441BitBake attempts to verify the files against checksums defined in your
1442recipe to ensure they have not been tampered with or otherwise modified
1443since the recipe was written. Two checksums are used:
1444``SRC_URI[md5sum]`` and ``SRC_URI[sha256sum]``.
1445
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001446If your :term:`SRC_URI` variable points to more than a single URL (excluding
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001447SCM URLs), you need to provide the ``md5`` and ``sha256`` checksums for
1448each URL. For these cases, you provide a name for each URL as part of
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001449the :term:`SRC_URI` and then reference that name in the subsequent checksum
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001450statements. Here is an example combining lines from the files
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001451``git.inc`` and ``git_2.24.1.bb``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001452
1453 SRC_URI = "${KERNELORG_MIRROR}/software/scm/git/git-${PV}.tar.gz;name=tarball \
1454 ${KERNELORG_MIRROR}/software/scm/git/git-manpages-${PV}.tar.gz;name=manpages"
1455
1456 SRC_URI[tarball.md5sum] = "166bde96adbbc11c8843d4f8f4f9811b"
1457 SRC_URI[tarball.sha256sum] = "ad5334956301c86841eb1e5b1bb20884a6bad89a10a6762c958220c7cf64da02"
1458 SRC_URI[manpages.md5sum] = "31c2272a8979022497ba3d4202df145d"
1459 SRC_URI[manpages.sha256sum] = "9a7ae3a093bea39770eb96ca3e5b40bff7af0b9f6123f089d7821d0e5b8e1230"
1460
1461Proper values for ``md5`` and ``sha256`` checksums might be available
1462with other signatures on the download page for the upstream source (e.g.
1463``md5``, ``sha1``, ``sha256``, ``GPG``, and so forth). Because the
1464OpenEmbedded build system only deals with ``sha256sum`` and ``md5sum``,
1465you should verify all the signatures you find by hand.
1466
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001467If no :term:`SRC_URI` checksums are specified when you attempt to build the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001468recipe, or you provide an incorrect checksum, the build will produce an
1469error for each missing or incorrect checksum. As part of the error
1470message, the build system provides the checksum string corresponding to
1471the fetched file. Once you have the correct checksums, you can copy and
1472paste them into your recipe and then run the build again to continue.
1473
1474.. note::
1475
1476 As mentioned, if the upstream source provides signatures for
1477 verifying the downloaded source code, you should verify those
1478 manually before setting the checksum values in the recipe and
1479 continuing with the build.
1480
1481This final example is a bit more complicated and is from the
1482``meta/recipes-sato/rxvt-unicode/rxvt-unicode_9.20.bb`` recipe. The
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001483example's :term:`SRC_URI` statement identifies multiple files as the source
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001484files for the recipe: a tarball, a patch file, a desktop file, and an
1485icon.
1486::
1487
1488 SRC_URI = "http://dist.schmorp.de/rxvt-unicode/Attic/rxvt-unicode-${PV}.tar.bz2 \
1489 file://xwc.patch \
1490 file://rxvt.desktop \
1491 file://rxvt.png"
1492
1493When you specify local files using the ``file://`` URI protocol, the
1494build system fetches files from the local machine. The path is relative
1495to the :term:`FILESPATH` variable
1496and searches specific directories in a certain order:
1497``${``\ :term:`BP`\ ``}``,
1498``${``\ :term:`BPN`\ ``}``, and
1499``files``. The directories are assumed to be subdirectories of the
1500directory in which the recipe or append file resides. For another
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001501example that specifies these types of files, see the
1502":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:single .c file package (hello world!)`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001503
1504The previous example also specifies a patch file. Patch files are files
1505whose names usually end in ``.patch`` or ``.diff`` but can end with
1506compressed suffixes such as ``diff.gz`` and ``patch.bz2``, for example.
1507The build system automatically applies patches as described in the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001508":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:patching code`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001509
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00001510Fetching Code Through Firewalls
1511~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1512
1513Some users are behind firewalls and need to fetch code through a proxy.
1514See the ":doc:`/ref-manual/faq`" chapter for advice.
1515
1516Limiting the Number of Parallel Connections
1517~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
1518
1519Some users are behind firewalls or use servers where the number of parallel
1520connections is limited. In such cases, you can limit the number of fetch
1521tasks being run in parallel by adding the following to your ``local.conf``
1522file::
1523
1524 do_fetch[number_threads] = "4"
1525
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001526Unpacking Code
1527--------------
1528
1529During the build, the
1530:ref:`ref-tasks-unpack` task unpacks
1531the source with ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``
1532pointing to where it is unpacked.
1533
1534If you are fetching your source files from an upstream source archived
1535tarball and the tarball's internal structure matches the common
1536convention of a top-level subdirectory named
1537``${``\ :term:`BPN`\ ``}-${``\ :term:`PV`\ ``}``,
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001538then you do not need to set :term:`S`. However, if :term:`SRC_URI` specifies to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001539fetch source from an archive that does not use this convention, or from
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001540an SCM like Git or Subversion, your recipe needs to define :term:`S`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001541
1542If processing your recipe using BitBake successfully unpacks the source
1543files, you need to be sure that the directory pointed to by ``${S}``
1544matches the structure of the source.
1545
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001546Patching Code
1547-------------
1548
1549Sometimes it is necessary to patch code after it has been fetched. Any
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001550files mentioned in :term:`SRC_URI` whose names end in ``.patch`` or
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001551``.diff`` or compressed versions of these suffixes (e.g. ``diff.gz`` are
1552treated as patches. The
1553:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` task
1554automatically applies these patches.
1555
1556The build system should be able to apply patches with the "-p1" option
1557(i.e. one directory level in the path will be stripped off). If your
1558patch needs to have more directory levels stripped off, specify the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001559number of levels using the "striplevel" option in the :term:`SRC_URI` entry
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001560for the patch. Alternatively, if your patch needs to be applied in a
1561specific subdirectory that is not specified in the patch file, use the
1562"patchdir" option in the entry.
1563
1564As with all local files referenced in
1565:term:`SRC_URI` using ``file://``,
1566you should place patch files in a directory next to the recipe either
1567named the same as the base name of the recipe
1568(:term:`BP` and
1569:term:`BPN`) or "files".
1570
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001571Licensing
1572---------
1573
1574Your recipe needs to have both the
1575:term:`LICENSE` and
1576:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
1577variables:
1578
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001579- :term:`LICENSE`: This variable specifies the license for the software.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001580 If you do not know the license under which the software you are
1581 building is distributed, you should go to the source code and look
1582 for that information. Typical files containing this information
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001583 include ``COPYING``, :term:`LICENSE`, and ``README`` files. You could
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001584 also find the information near the top of a source file. For example,
1585 given a piece of software licensed under the GNU General Public
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001586 License version 2, you would set :term:`LICENSE` as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001587
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00001588 LICENSE = "GPL-2.0-only"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001589
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001590 The licenses you specify within :term:`LICENSE` can have any name as long
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001591 as you do not use spaces, since spaces are used as separators between
1592 license names. For standard licenses, use the names of the files in
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001593 ``meta/files/common-licenses/`` or the :term:`SPDXLICENSEMAP` flag names
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001594 defined in ``meta/conf/licenses.conf``.
1595
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001596- :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`: The OpenEmbedded build system uses this
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001597 variable to make sure the license text has not changed. If it has,
1598 the build produces an error and it affords you the chance to figure
1599 it out and correct the problem.
1600
1601 You need to specify all applicable licensing files for the software.
1602 At the end of the configuration step, the build process will compare
1603 the checksums of the files to be sure the text has not changed. Any
1604 differences result in an error with the message containing the
1605 current checksum. For more explanation and examples of how to set the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001606 :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` variable, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001607 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:tracking license changes`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001608
1609 To determine the correct checksum string, you can list the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001610 appropriate files in the :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` variable with incorrect
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001611 md5 strings, attempt to build the software, and then note the
1612 resulting error messages that will report the correct md5 strings.
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001613 See the ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:fetching code`" section for
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001614 additional information.
1615
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001616 Here is an example that assumes the software has a ``COPYING`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001617
1618 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=xxx"
1619
1620 When you try to build the
1621 software, the build system will produce an error and give you the
1622 correct string that you can substitute into the recipe file for a
1623 subsequent build.
1624
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001625Dependencies
1626------------
1627
1628Most software packages have a short list of other packages that they
1629require, which are called dependencies. These dependencies fall into two
1630main categories: build-time dependencies, which are required when the
1631software is built; and runtime dependencies, which are required to be
1632installed on the target in order for the software to run.
1633
1634Within a recipe, you specify build-time dependencies using the
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07001635:term:`DEPENDS` variable. Although there are nuances,
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001636items specified in :term:`DEPENDS` should be names of other
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001637recipes. It is important that you specify all build-time dependencies
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001638explicitly.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001639
1640Another consideration is that configure scripts might automatically
1641check for optional dependencies and enable corresponding functionality
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001642if those dependencies are found. If you wish to make a recipe that is
1643more generally useful (e.g. publish the recipe in a layer for others to
1644use), instead of hard-disabling the functionality, you can use the
1645:term:`PACKAGECONFIG` variable to allow functionality and the
1646corresponding dependencies to be enabled and disabled easily by other
1647users of the recipe.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001648
1649Similar to build-time dependencies, you specify runtime dependencies
1650through a variable -
1651:term:`RDEPENDS`, which is
1652package-specific. All variables that are package-specific need to have
1653the name of the package added to the end as an override. Since the main
1654package for a recipe has the same name as the recipe, and the recipe's
1655name can be found through the
1656``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}`` variable, then
1657you specify the dependencies for the main package by setting
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001658``RDEPENDS:${PN}``. If the package were named ``${PN}-tools``, then you
1659would set ``RDEPENDS:${PN}-tools``, and so forth.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001660
1661Some runtime dependencies will be set automatically at packaging time.
1662These dependencies include any shared library dependencies (i.e. if a
1663package "example" contains "libexample" and another package "mypackage"
1664contains a binary that links to "libexample" then the OpenEmbedded build
1665system will automatically add a runtime dependency to "mypackage" on
1666"example"). See the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001667":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001668section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for further
1669details.
1670
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001671Configuring the Recipe
1672----------------------
1673
1674Most software provides some means of setting build-time configuration
1675options before compilation. Typically, setting these options is
1676accomplished by running a configure script with options, or by modifying
1677a build configuration file.
1678
1679.. note::
1680
1681 As of Yocto Project Release 1.7, some of the core recipes that
1682 package binary configuration scripts now disable the scripts due to
1683 the scripts previously requiring error-prone path substitution. The
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001684 OpenEmbedded build system uses ``pkg-config`` now, which is much more
1685 robust. You can find a list of the ``*-config`` scripts that are disabled
1686 in the ":ref:`migration-1.7-binary-configuration-scripts-disabled`" section
1687 in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001688
1689A major part of build-time configuration is about checking for
1690build-time dependencies and possibly enabling optional functionality as
1691a result. You need to specify any build-time dependencies for the
1692software you are building in your recipe's
1693:term:`DEPENDS` value, in terms of
1694other recipes that satisfy those dependencies. You can often find
1695build-time or runtime dependencies described in the software's
1696documentation.
1697
1698The following list provides configuration items of note based on how
1699your software is built:
1700
1701- *Autotools:* If your source files have a ``configure.ac`` file, then
1702 your software is built using Autotools. If this is the case, you just
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07001703 need to modify the configuration.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001704
1705 When using Autotools, your recipe needs to inherit the
1706 :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class
1707 and your recipe does not have to contain a
1708 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task.
1709 However, you might still want to make some adjustments. For example,
1710 you can set
1711 :term:`EXTRA_OECONF` or
1712 :term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`
1713 to pass any needed configure options that are specific to the recipe.
1714
1715- *CMake:* If your source files have a ``CMakeLists.txt`` file, then
1716 your software is built using CMake. If this is the case, you just
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07001717 need to modify the configuration.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001718
1719 When you use CMake, your recipe needs to inherit the
1720 :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` class and your
1721 recipe does not have to contain a
1722 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task.
1723 You can make some adjustments by setting
1724 :term:`EXTRA_OECMAKE` to
1725 pass any needed configure options that are specific to the recipe.
1726
1727 .. note::
1728
1729 If you need to install one or more custom CMake toolchain files
1730 that are supplied by the application you are building, install the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001731 files to ``${D}${datadir}/cmake/Modules`` during :ref:`ref-tasks-install`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001732
1733- *Other:* If your source files do not have a ``configure.ac`` or
1734 ``CMakeLists.txt`` file, then your software is built using some
1735 method other than Autotools or CMake. If this is the case, you
1736 normally need to provide a
1737 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task
1738 in your recipe unless, of course, there is nothing to configure.
1739
1740 Even if your software is not being built by Autotools or CMake, you
1741 still might not need to deal with any configuration issues. You need
1742 to determine if configuration is even a required step. You might need
1743 to modify a Makefile or some configuration file used for the build to
1744 specify necessary build options. Or, perhaps you might need to run a
1745 provided, custom configure script with the appropriate options.
1746
1747 For the case involving a custom configure script, you would run
1748 ``./configure --help`` and look for the options you need to set.
1749
1750Once configuration succeeds, it is always good practice to look at the
1751``log.do_configure`` file to ensure that the appropriate options have
1752been enabled and no additional build-time dependencies need to be added
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001753to :term:`DEPENDS`. For example, if the configure script reports that it
1754found something not mentioned in :term:`DEPENDS`, or that it did not find
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001755something that it needed for some desired optional functionality, then
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001756you would need to add those to :term:`DEPENDS`. Looking at the log might
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001757also reveal items being checked for, enabled, or both that you do not
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001758want, or items not being found that are in :term:`DEPENDS`, in which case
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001759you would need to look at passing extra options to the configure script
1760as needed. For reference information on configure options specific to
1761the software you are building, you can consult the output of the
1762``./configure --help`` command within ``${S}`` or consult the software's
1763upstream documentation.
1764
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001765Using Headers to Interface with Devices
1766---------------------------------------
1767
1768If your recipe builds an application that needs to communicate with some
1769device or needs an API into a custom kernel, you will need to provide
1770appropriate header files. Under no circumstances should you ever modify
1771the existing
1772``meta/recipes-kernel/linux-libc-headers/linux-libc-headers.inc`` file.
1773These headers are used to build ``libc`` and must not be compromised
1774with custom or machine-specific header information. If you customize
1775``libc`` through modified headers all other applications that use
1776``libc`` thus become affected.
1777
1778.. note::
1779
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001780 Never copy and customize the ``libc`` header file (i.e.
1781 ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux-libc-headers/linux-libc-headers.inc``).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001782
1783The correct way to interface to a device or custom kernel is to use a
1784separate package that provides the additional headers for the driver or
1785other unique interfaces. When doing so, your application also becomes
1786responsible for creating a dependency on that specific provider.
1787
1788Consider the following:
1789
1790- Never modify ``linux-libc-headers.inc``. Consider that file to be
1791 part of the ``libc`` system, and not something you use to access the
1792 kernel directly. You should access ``libc`` through specific ``libc``
1793 calls.
1794
1795- Applications that must talk directly to devices should either provide
1796 necessary headers themselves, or establish a dependency on a special
1797 headers package that is specific to that driver.
1798
1799For example, suppose you want to modify an existing header that adds I/O
1800control or network support. If the modifications are used by a small
1801number programs, providing a unique version of a header is easy and has
1802little impact. When doing so, bear in mind the guidelines in the
1803previous list.
1804
1805.. note::
1806
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001807 If for some reason your changes need to modify the behavior of the ``libc``,
1808 and subsequently all other applications on the system, use a ``.bbappend``
1809 to modify the ``linux-kernel-headers.inc`` file. However, take care to not
1810 make the changes machine specific.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001811
1812Consider a case where your kernel is older and you need an older
1813``libc`` ABI. The headers installed by your recipe should still be a
1814standard mainline kernel, not your own custom one.
1815
1816When you use custom kernel headers you need to get them from
1817:term:`STAGING_KERNEL_DIR`,
1818which is the directory with kernel headers that are required to build
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001819out-of-tree modules. Your recipe will also need the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001820
1821 do_configure[depends] += "virtual/kernel:do_shared_workdir"
1822
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001823Compilation
1824-----------
1825
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001826During a build, the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task happens after source is fetched,
1827unpacked, and configured. If the recipe passes through :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001828successfully, nothing needs to be done.
1829
1830However, if the compile step fails, you need to diagnose the failure.
1831Here are some common issues that cause failures.
1832
1833.. note::
1834
1835 For cases where improper paths are detected for configuration files
1836 or for when libraries/headers cannot be found, be sure you are using
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001837 the more robust ``pkg-config``. See the note in section
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06001838 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:Configuring the Recipe`" for additional information.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001839
1840- *Parallel build failures:* These failures manifest themselves as
1841 intermittent errors, or errors reporting that a file or directory
1842 that should be created by some other part of the build process could
1843 not be found. This type of failure can occur even if, upon
1844 inspection, the file or directory does exist after the build has
1845 failed, because that part of the build process happened in the wrong
1846 order.
1847
1848 To fix the problem, you need to either satisfy the missing dependency
1849 in the Makefile or whatever script produced the Makefile, or (as a
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001850 workaround) set :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` to an empty string::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001851
1852 PARALLEL_MAKE = ""
1853
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001854 For information on parallel Makefile issues, see the
1855 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:debugging parallel make races`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001856
1857- *Improper host path usage:* This failure applies to recipes building
1858 for the target or ``nativesdk`` only. The failure occurs when the
1859 compilation process uses improper headers, libraries, or other files
1860 from the host system when cross-compiling for the target.
1861
1862 To fix the problem, examine the ``log.do_compile`` file to identify
1863 the host paths being used (e.g. ``/usr/include``, ``/usr/lib``, and
1864 so forth) and then either add configure options, apply a patch, or do
1865 both.
1866
1867- *Failure to find required libraries/headers:* If a build-time
1868 dependency is missing because it has not been declared in
1869 :term:`DEPENDS`, or because the
1870 dependency exists but the path used by the build process to find the
1871 file is incorrect and the configure step did not detect it, the
1872 compilation process could fail. For either of these failures, the
1873 compilation process notes that files could not be found. In these
1874 cases, you need to go back and add additional options to the
1875 configure script as well as possibly add additional build-time
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001876 dependencies to :term:`DEPENDS`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001877
1878 Occasionally, it is necessary to apply a patch to the source to
1879 ensure the correct paths are used. If you need to specify paths to
1880 find files staged into the sysroot from other recipes, use the
1881 variables that the OpenEmbedded build system provides (e.g.
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05001882 :term:`STAGING_BINDIR`, :term:`STAGING_INCDIR`, :term:`STAGING_DATADIR`, and so
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001883 forth).
1884
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001885Installing
1886----------
1887
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001888During :ref:`ref-tasks-install`, the task copies the built files along with their
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001889hierarchy to locations that would mirror their locations on the target
1890device. The installation process copies files from the
1891``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``,
1892``${``\ :term:`B`\ ``}``, and
1893``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}``
1894directories to the ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}``
1895directory to create the structure as it should appear on the target
1896system.
1897
1898How your software is built affects what you must do to be sure your
1899software is installed correctly. The following list describes what you
1900must do for installation depending on the type of build system used by
1901the software being built:
1902
1903- *Autotools and CMake:* If the software your recipe is building uses
1904 Autotools or CMake, the OpenEmbedded build system understands how to
1905 install the software. Consequently, you do not have to have a
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001906 :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task as part of your recipe. You just need to make
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001907 sure the install portion of the build completes with no issues.
1908 However, if you wish to install additional files not already being
1909 installed by ``make install``, you should do this using a
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001910 ``do_install:append`` function using the install command as described
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001911 in the "Manual" bulleted item later in this list.
1912
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001913- *Other (using* ``make install``\ *)*: You need to define a :ref:`ref-tasks-install`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001914 function in your recipe. The function should call
1915 ``oe_runmake install`` and will likely need to pass in the
1916 destination directory as well. How you pass that path is dependent on
1917 how the ``Makefile`` being run is written (e.g. ``DESTDIR=${D}``,
1918 ``PREFIX=${D}``, ``INSTALLROOT=${D}``, and so forth).
1919
1920 For an example recipe using ``make install``, see the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05001921 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:makefile-based package`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001922
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001923- *Manual:* You need to define a :ref:`ref-tasks-install` function in your
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001924 recipe. The function must first use ``install -d`` to create the
1925 directories under
1926 ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}``. Once the
1927 directories exist, your function can use ``install`` to manually
1928 install the built software into the directories.
1929
1930 You can find more information on ``install`` at
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001931 https://www.gnu.org/software/coreutils/manual/html_node/install-invocation.html.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001932
1933For the scenarios that do not use Autotools or CMake, you need to track
1934the installation and diagnose and fix any issues until everything
1935installs correctly. You need to look in the default location of
1936``${D}``, which is ``${WORKDIR}/image``, to be sure your files have been
1937installed correctly.
1938
1939.. note::
1940
1941 - During the installation process, you might need to modify some of
1942 the installed files to suit the target layout. For example, you
1943 might need to replace hard-coded paths in an initscript with
1944 values of variables provided by the build system, such as
1945 replacing ``/usr/bin/`` with ``${bindir}``. If you do perform such
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001946 modifications during :ref:`ref-tasks-install`, be sure to modify the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001947 destination file after copying rather than before copying.
1948 Modifying after copying ensures that the build system can
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001949 re-execute :ref:`ref-tasks-install` if needed.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001950
1951 - ``oe_runmake install``, which can be run directly or can be run
1952 indirectly by the
1953 :ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` and
1954 :ref:`cmake <ref-classes-cmake>` classes,
1955 runs ``make install`` in parallel. Sometimes, a Makefile can have
1956 missing dependencies between targets that can result in race
1957 conditions. If you experience intermittent failures during
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001958 :ref:`ref-tasks-install`, you might be able to work around them by disabling
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05001959 parallel Makefile installs by adding the following to the recipe::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001960
1961 PARALLEL_MAKEINST = ""
1962
1963 See :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST` for additional information.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001964
1965 - If you need to install one or more custom CMake toolchain files
1966 that are supplied by the application you are building, install the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05001967 files to ``${D}${datadir}/cmake/Modules`` during
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001968 :ref:`ref-tasks-install`.
1969
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001970Enabling System Services
1971------------------------
1972
1973If you want to install a service, which is a process that usually starts
1974on boot and runs in the background, then you must include some
1975additional definitions in your recipe.
1976
1977If you are adding services and the service initialization script or the
1978service file itself is not installed, you must provide for that
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001979installation in your recipe using a ``do_install:append`` function. If
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05001980your recipe already has a :ref:`ref-tasks-install` function, update the function
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05001981near its end rather than adding an additional ``do_install:append``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05001982function.
1983
1984When you create the installation for your services, you need to
1985accomplish what is normally done by ``make install``. In other words,
1986make sure your installation arranges the output similar to how it is
1987arranged on the target system.
1988
1989The OpenEmbedded build system provides support for starting services two
1990different ways:
1991
1992- *SysVinit:* SysVinit is a system and service manager that manages the
1993 init system used to control the very basic functions of your system.
1994 The init program is the first program started by the Linux kernel
1995 when the system boots. Init then controls the startup, running and
1996 shutdown of all other programs.
1997
1998 To enable a service using SysVinit, your recipe needs to inherit the
1999 :ref:`update-rc.d <ref-classes-update-rc.d>`
2000 class. The class helps facilitate safely installing the package on
2001 the target.
2002
2003 You will need to set the
2004 :term:`INITSCRIPT_PACKAGES`,
2005 :term:`INITSCRIPT_NAME`,
2006 and
2007 :term:`INITSCRIPT_PARAMS`
2008 variables within your recipe.
2009
2010- *systemd:* System Management Daemon (systemd) was designed to replace
2011 SysVinit and to provide enhanced management of services. For more
2012 information on systemd, see the systemd homepage at
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002013 https://freedesktop.org/wiki/Software/systemd/.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002014
2015 To enable a service using systemd, your recipe needs to inherit the
2016 :ref:`systemd <ref-classes-systemd>` class. See
2017 the ``systemd.bbclass`` file located in your :term:`Source Directory`
2018 section for
2019 more information.
2020
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002021Packaging
2022---------
2023
2024Successful packaging is a combination of automated processes performed
2025by the OpenEmbedded build system and some specific steps you need to
2026take. The following list describes the process:
2027
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002028- *Splitting Files*: The :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task splits the files produced
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002029 by the recipe into logical components. Even software that produces a
2030 single binary might still have debug symbols, documentation, and
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002031 other logical components that should be split out. The :ref:`ref-tasks-package`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002032 task ensures that files are split up and packaged correctly.
2033
2034- *Running QA Checks*: The
2035 :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class adds a
2036 step to the package generation process so that output quality
2037 assurance checks are generated by the OpenEmbedded build system. This
2038 step performs a range of checks to be sure the build's output is free
2039 of common problems that show up during runtime. For information on
2040 these checks, see the
2041 :ref:`insane <ref-classes-insane>` class and
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002042 the ":ref:`ref-manual/qa-checks:qa error and warning messages`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002043 chapter in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
2044
2045- *Hand-Checking Your Packages*: After you build your software, you
2046 need to be sure your packages are correct. Examine the
2047 ``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/packages-split``
2048 directory and make sure files are where you expect them to be. If you
2049 discover problems, you can set
2050 :term:`PACKAGES`,
2051 :term:`FILES`,
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002052 ``do_install(:append)``, and so forth as needed.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002053
2054- *Splitting an Application into Multiple Packages*: If you need to
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002055 split an application into several packages, see the
2056 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:splitting an application into multiple packages`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002057 section for an example.
2058
2059- *Installing a Post-Installation Script*: For an example showing how
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002060 to install a post-installation script, see the
2061 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:post-installation scripts`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002062
2063- *Marking Package Architecture*: Depending on what your recipe is
2064 building and how it is configured, it might be important to mark the
2065 packages produced as being specific to a particular machine, or to
2066 mark them as not being specific to a particular machine or
2067 architecture at all.
2068
2069 By default, packages apply to any machine with the same architecture
2070 as the target machine. When a recipe produces packages that are
2071 machine-specific (e.g. the
2072 :term:`MACHINE` value is passed
2073 into the configure script or a patch is applied only for a particular
2074 machine), you should mark them as such by adding the following to the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002075 recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002076
2077 PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}"
2078
2079 On the other hand, if the recipe produces packages that do not
2080 contain anything specific to the target machine or architecture at
2081 all (e.g. recipes that simply package script files or configuration
2082 files), you should use the
2083 :ref:`allarch <ref-classes-allarch>` class to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002084 do this for you by adding this to your recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002085
2086 inherit allarch
2087
2088 Ensuring that the package architecture is correct is not critical
2089 while you are doing the first few builds of your recipe. However, it
2090 is important in order to ensure that your recipe rebuilds (or does
2091 not rebuild) appropriately in response to changes in configuration,
2092 and to ensure that you get the appropriate packages installed on the
2093 target machine, particularly if you run separate builds for more than
2094 one target machine.
2095
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002096Sharing Files Between Recipes
2097-----------------------------
2098
2099Recipes often need to use files provided by other recipes on the build
2100host. For example, an application linking to a common library needs
2101access to the library itself and its associated headers. The way this
2102access is accomplished is by populating a sysroot with files. Each
2103recipe has two sysroots in its work directory, one for target files
2104(``recipe-sysroot``) and one for files that are native to the build host
2105(``recipe-sysroot-native``).
2106
2107.. note::
2108
2109 You could find the term "staging" used within the Yocto project
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002110 regarding files populating sysroots (e.g. the :term:`STAGING_DIR`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002111 variable).
2112
2113Recipes should never populate the sysroot directly (i.e. write files
2114into sysroot). Instead, files should be installed into standard
2115locations during the
2116:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task within
2117the ``${``\ :term:`D`\ ``}`` directory. The
2118reason for this limitation is that almost all files that populate the
2119sysroot are cataloged in manifests in order to ensure the files can be
2120removed later when a recipe is either modified or removed. Thus, the
2121sysroot is able to remain free from stale files.
2122
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002123A subset of the files installed by the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task are
Patrick Williams975a06f2022-10-21 14:42:47 -05002124used by the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot` task as defined by the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002125:term:`SYSROOT_DIRS` variable to automatically populate the sysroot. It
2126is possible to modify the list of directories that populate the sysroot.
2127The following example shows how you could add the ``/opt`` directory to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002128the list of directories within a recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002129
2130 SYSROOT_DIRS += "/opt"
2131
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -06002132.. note::
2133
2134 The `/sysroot-only` is to be used by recipes that generate artifacts
2135 that are not included in the target filesystem, allowing them to share
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002136 these artifacts without needing to use the :term:`DEPLOY_DIR`.
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -06002137
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002138For a more complete description of the :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002139task and its associated functions, see the
2140:ref:`staging <ref-classes-staging>` class.
2141
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002142Using Virtual Providers
2143-----------------------
2144
2145Prior to a build, if you know that several different recipes provide the
2146same functionality, you can use a virtual provider (i.e. ``virtual/*``)
2147as a placeholder for the actual provider. The actual provider is
2148determined at build-time.
2149
2150A common scenario where a virtual provider is used would be for the
2151kernel recipe. Suppose you have three kernel recipes whose
2152:term:`PN` values map to ``kernel-big``,
2153``kernel-mid``, and ``kernel-small``. Furthermore, each of these recipes
2154in some way uses a :term:`PROVIDES`
2155statement that essentially identifies itself as being able to provide
2156``virtual/kernel``. Here is one way through the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002157:ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002158
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00002159 PROVIDES += "virtual/kernel"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002160
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00002161Any recipe that inherits the :ref:`kernel <ref-classes-kernel>` class is
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002162going to utilize a :term:`PROVIDES` statement that identifies that recipe as
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002163being able to provide the ``virtual/kernel`` item.
2164
2165Now comes the time to actually build an image and you need a kernel
2166recipe, but which one? You can configure your build to call out the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002167kernel recipe you want by using the :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable. As
2168an example, consider the :yocto_git:`x86-base.inc
Andrew Geisslerd159c7f2021-09-02 21:05:58 -05002169</poky/tree/meta/conf/machine/include/x86/x86-base.inc>` include file, which is a
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002170machine (i.e. :term:`MACHINE`) configuration file. This include file is the
2171reason all x86-based machines use the ``linux-yocto`` kernel. Here are the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002172relevant lines from the include file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002173
2174 PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ??= "linux-yocto"
2175 PREFERRED_VERSION_linux-yocto ??= "4.15%"
2176
2177When you use a virtual provider, you do not have to "hard code" a recipe
2178name as a build dependency. You can use the
2179:term:`DEPENDS` variable to state the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002180build is dependent on ``virtual/kernel`` for example::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002181
2182 DEPENDS = "virtual/kernel"
2183
2184During the build, the OpenEmbedded build system picks
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002185the correct recipe needed for the ``virtual/kernel`` dependency based on
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002186the :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` variable. If you want to use the small kernel
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002187mentioned at the beginning of this section, configure your build as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002188follows::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002189
2190 PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel ??= "kernel-small"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002191
2192.. note::
2193
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002194 Any recipe that :term:`PROVIDES` a ``virtual/*`` item that is ultimately not
2195 selected through :term:`PREFERRED_PROVIDER` does not get built. Preventing these
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002196 recipes from building is usually the desired behavior since this mechanism's
2197 purpose is to select between mutually exclusive alternative providers.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002198
2199The following lists specific examples of virtual providers:
2200
2201- ``virtual/kernel``: Provides the name of the kernel recipe to use
2202 when building a kernel image.
2203
2204- ``virtual/bootloader``: Provides the name of the bootloader to use
2205 when building an image.
2206
2207- ``virtual/libgbm``: Provides ``gbm.pc``.
2208
2209- ``virtual/egl``: Provides ``egl.pc`` and possibly ``wayland-egl.pc``.
2210
2211- ``virtual/libgl``: Provides ``gl.pc`` (i.e. libGL).
2212
2213- ``virtual/libgles1``: Provides ``glesv1_cm.pc`` (i.e. libGLESv1_CM).
2214
2215- ``virtual/libgles2``: Provides ``glesv2.pc`` (i.e. libGLESv2).
2216
2217.. note::
2218
2219 Virtual providers only apply to build time dependencies specified with
2220 :term:`PROVIDES` and :term:`DEPENDS`. They do not apply to runtime
2221 dependencies specified with :term:`RPROVIDES` and :term:`RDEPENDS`.
2222
2223Properly Versioning Pre-Release Recipes
2224---------------------------------------
2225
2226Sometimes the name of a recipe can lead to versioning problems when the
2227recipe is upgraded to a final release. For example, consider the
2228``irssi_0.8.16-rc1.bb`` recipe file in the list of example recipes in
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002229the ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:storing and naming the recipe`" section.
2230This recipe is at a release candidate stage (i.e. "rc1"). When the recipe is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002231released, the recipe filename becomes ``irssi_0.8.16.bb``. The version
2232change from ``0.8.16-rc1`` to ``0.8.16`` is seen as a decrease by the
2233build system and package managers, so the resulting packages will not
2234correctly trigger an upgrade.
2235
2236In order to ensure the versions compare properly, the recommended
2237convention is to set :term:`PV` within the
2238recipe to "previous_version+current_version". You can use an additional
2239variable so that you can use the current version elsewhere. Here is an
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002240example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002241
2242 REALPV = "0.8.16-rc1"
2243 PV = "0.8.15+${REALPV}"
2244
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002245Post-Installation Scripts
2246-------------------------
2247
2248Post-installation scripts run immediately after installing a package on
2249the target or during image creation when a package is included in an
2250image. To add a post-installation script to a package, add a
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002251``pkg_postinst:``\ `PACKAGENAME`\ ``()`` function to the recipe file
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002252(``.bb``) and replace `PACKAGENAME` with the name of the package you want
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002253to attach to the ``postinst`` script. To apply the post-installation
2254script to the main package for the recipe, which is usually what is
2255required, specify
2256``${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}`` in place of
2257PACKAGENAME.
2258
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002259A post-installation function has the following structure::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002260
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002261 pkg_postinst:PACKAGENAME() {
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002262 # Commands to carry out
2263 }
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002264
2265The script defined in the post-installation function is called when the
2266root filesystem is created. If the script succeeds, the package is
2267marked as installed.
2268
2269.. note::
2270
2271 Any RPM post-installation script that runs on the target should
2272 return a 0 exit code. RPM does not allow non-zero exit codes for
2273 these scripts, and the RPM package manager will cause the package to
2274 fail installation on the target.
2275
2276Sometimes it is necessary for the execution of a post-installation
2277script to be delayed until the first boot. For example, the script might
2278need to be executed on the device itself. To delay script execution
2279until boot time, you must explicitly mark post installs to defer to the
2280target. You can use ``pkg_postinst_ontarget()`` or call
2281``postinst_intercept delay_to_first_boot`` from ``pkg_postinst()``. Any
2282failure of a ``pkg_postinst()`` script (including exit 1) triggers an
2283error during the
2284:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task.
2285
2286If you have recipes that use ``pkg_postinst`` function and they require
2287the use of non-standard native tools that have dependencies during
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00002288root filesystem construction, you need to use the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002289:term:`PACKAGE_WRITE_DEPS`
2290variable in your recipe to list these tools. If you do not use this
2291variable, the tools might be missing and execution of the
2292post-installation script is deferred until first boot. Deferring the
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00002293script to the first boot is undesirable and impossible for read-only
2294root filesystems.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002295
2296.. note::
2297
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07002298 There is equivalent support for pre-install, pre-uninstall, and post-uninstall
2299 scripts by way of ``pkg_preinst``, ``pkg_prerm``, and ``pkg_postrm``,
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002300 respectively. These scrips work in exactly the same way as does
2301 ``pkg_postinst`` with the exception that they run at different times. Also,
2302 because of when they run, they are not applicable to being run at image
2303 creation time like ``pkg_postinst``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002304
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002305Testing
2306-------
2307
2308The final step for completing your recipe is to be sure that the
2309software you built runs correctly. To accomplish runtime testing, add
2310the build's output packages to your image and test them on the target.
2311
2312For information on how to customize your image by adding specific
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002313packages, see ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:customizing images`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002314
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002315Examples
2316--------
2317
2318To help summarize how to write a recipe, this section provides some
2319examples given various scenarios:
2320
2321- Recipes that use local files
2322
2323- Using an Autotooled package
2324
2325- Using a Makefile-based package
2326
2327- Splitting an application into multiple packages
2328
2329- Adding binaries to an image
2330
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002331Single .c File Package (Hello World!)
2332~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2333
2334Building an application from a single file that is stored locally (e.g.
2335under ``files``) requires a recipe that has the file listed in the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002336:term:`SRC_URI` variable. Additionally, you need to manually write the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002337:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` and :ref:`ref-tasks-install` tasks. The :term:`S` variable defines the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002338directory containing the source code, which is set to
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05002339:term:`WORKDIR` in this case --- the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002340directory BitBake uses for the build.
2341::
2342
2343 SUMMARY = "Simple helloworld application"
2344 SECTION = "examples"
2345 LICENSE = "MIT"
2346 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://${COMMON_LICENSE_DIR}/MIT;md5=0835ade698e0bcf8506ecda2f7b4f302"
2347
2348 SRC_URI = "file://helloworld.c"
2349
2350 S = "${WORKDIR}"
2351
2352 do_compile() {
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -06002353 ${CC} ${LDFLAGS} helloworld.c -o helloworld
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002354 }
2355
2356 do_install() {
2357 install -d ${D}${bindir}
2358 install -m 0755 helloworld ${D}${bindir}
2359 }
2360
2361By default, the ``helloworld``, ``helloworld-dbg``, and
2362``helloworld-dev`` packages are built. For information on how to
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05002363customize the packaging process, see the
2364":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:splitting an application into multiple packages`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002365section.
2366
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002367Autotooled Package
2368~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2369
2370Applications that use Autotools such as ``autoconf`` and ``automake``
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002371require a recipe that has a source archive listed in :term:`SRC_URI` and
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002372also inherit the
2373:ref:`autotools <ref-classes-autotools>` class,
2374which contains the definitions of all the steps needed to build an
2375Autotool-based application. The result of the build is automatically
2376packaged. And, if the application uses NLS for localization, packages
2377with local information are generated (one package per language).
2378Following is one example: (``hello_2.3.bb``)
2379::
2380
2381 SUMMARY = "GNU Helloworld application"
2382 SECTION = "examples"
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002383 LICENSE = "GPL-2.0-or-later"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002384 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=751419260aa954499f7abaabaa882bbe"
2385
2386 SRC_URI = "${GNU_MIRROR}/hello/hello-${PV}.tar.gz"
2387
2388 inherit autotools gettext
2389
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002390The variable :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` is used to track source license
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002391changes as described in the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002392":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:tracking license changes`" section in
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002393the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual. You can quickly create
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002394Autotool-based recipes in a manner similar to the previous example.
2395
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002396Makefile-Based Package
2397~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2398
2399Applications that use GNU ``make`` also require a recipe that has the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002400source archive listed in :term:`SRC_URI`. You do not need to add a
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002401:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` step since by default BitBake starts the ``make`` command
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002402to compile the application. If you need additional ``make`` options, you
2403should store them in the
2404:term:`EXTRA_OEMAKE` or
2405:term:`PACKAGECONFIG_CONFARGS`
2406variables. BitBake passes these options into the GNU ``make``
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002407invocation. Note that a :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task is still required.
2408Otherwise, BitBake runs an empty :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task by default.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002409
2410Some applications might require extra parameters to be passed to the
2411compiler. For example, the application might need an additional header
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002412path. You can accomplish this by adding to the :term:`CFLAGS` variable. The
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002413following example shows this::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002414
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002415 CFLAGS:prepend = "-I ${S}/include "
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002416
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002417In the following example, ``lz4`` is a makefile-based package::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002418
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002419 SUMMARY = "Extremely Fast Compression algorithm"
2420 DESCRIPTION = "LZ4 is a very fast lossless compression algorithm, providing compression speed at 400 MB/s per core, scalable with multi-cores CPU. It also features an extremely fast decoder, with speed in multiple GB/s per core, typically reaching RAM speed limits on multi-core systems."
2421 HOMEPAGE = "https://github.com/lz4/lz4"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002422
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002423 LICENSE = "BSD-2-Clause | GPL-2.0-only"
2424 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://lib/LICENSE;md5=ebc2ea4814a64de7708f1571904b32cc \
2425 file://programs/COPYING;md5=b234ee4d69f5fce4486a80fdaf4a4263 \
2426 file://LICENSE;md5=d57c0d21cb917fb4e0af2454aa48b956 \
2427 "
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002428
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002429 PE = "1"
2430
2431 SRCREV = "d44371841a2f1728a3f36839fd4b7e872d0927d3"
2432
2433 SRC_URI = "git://github.com/lz4/lz4.git;branch=release;protocol=https \
2434 file://CVE-2021-3520.patch \
2435 "
2436 UPSTREAM_CHECK_GITTAGREGEX = "v(?P<pver>.*)"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002437
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002438 S = "${WORKDIR}/git"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002439
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002440 # Fixed in r118, which is larger than the current version.
2441 CVE_CHECK_IGNORE += "CVE-2014-4715"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002442
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002443 EXTRA_OEMAKE = "PREFIX=${prefix} CC='${CC}' CFLAGS='${CFLAGS}' DESTDIR=${D} LIBDIR=${libdir} INCLUDEDIR=${includedir} BUILD_STATIC=no"
2444
2445 do_install() {
2446 oe_runmake install
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002447 }
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002448
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00002449 BBCLASSEXTEND = "native nativesdk"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002450
2451Splitting an Application into Multiple Packages
2452~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2453
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002454You can use the variables :term:`PACKAGES` and :term:`FILES` to split an
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002455application into multiple packages.
2456
2457Following is an example that uses the ``libxpm`` recipe. By default,
2458this recipe generates a single package that contains the library along
2459with a few binaries. You can modify the recipe to split the binaries
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002460into separate packages::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002461
2462 require xorg-lib-common.inc
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002463
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002464 SUMMARY = "Xpm: X Pixmap extension library"
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05002465 LICENSE = "MIT"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002466 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=51f4270b012ecd4ab1a164f5f4ed6cf7"
2467 DEPENDS += "libxext libsm libxt"
2468 PE = "1"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002469
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002470 XORG_PN = "libXpm"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002471
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002472 PACKAGES =+ "sxpm cxpm"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002473 FILES:cxpm = "${bindir}/cxpm"
2474 FILES:sxpm = "${bindir}/sxpm"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002475
2476In the previous example, we want to ship the ``sxpm`` and ``cxpm``
2477binaries in separate packages. Since ``bindir`` would be packaged into
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002478the main :term:`PN` package by default, we prepend the :term:`PACKAGES` variable
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002479so additional package names are added to the start of list. This results
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002480in the extra ``FILES:*`` variables then containing information that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002481define which files and directories go into which packages. Files
2482included by earlier packages are skipped by latter packages. Thus, the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002483main :term:`PN` package does not include the above listed files.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002484
2485Packaging Externally Produced Binaries
2486~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
2487
2488Sometimes, you need to add pre-compiled binaries to an image. For
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07002489example, suppose that there are binaries for proprietary code,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002490created by a particular division of a company. Your part of the company
2491needs to use those binaries as part of an image that you are building
2492using the OpenEmbedded build system. Since you only have the binaries
2493and not the source code, you cannot use a typical recipe that expects to
2494fetch the source specified in
2495:term:`SRC_URI` and then compile it.
2496
2497One method is to package the binaries and then install them as part of
2498the image. Generally, it is not a good idea to package binaries since,
2499among other things, it can hinder the ability to reproduce builds and
2500could lead to compatibility problems with ABI in the future. However,
2501sometimes you have no choice.
2502
2503The easiest solution is to create a recipe that uses the
2504:ref:`bin_package <ref-classes-bin-package>` class
2505and to be sure that you are using default locations for build artifacts.
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00002506In most cases, the :ref:`bin_package <ref-classes-bin-package>` class handles "skipping" the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002507configure and compile steps as well as sets things up to grab packages
2508from the appropriate area. In particular, this class sets ``noexec`` on
2509both the :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`
2510and :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` tasks,
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002511sets ``FILES:${PN}`` to "/" so that it picks up all files, and sets up a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002512:ref:`ref-tasks-install` task, which
2513effectively copies all files from ``${S}`` to ``${D}``. The
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00002514:ref:`bin_package <ref-classes-bin-package>` class works well when the files extracted into ``${S}``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002515are already laid out in the way they should be laid out on the target.
2516For more information on these variables, see the
2517:term:`FILES`,
2518:term:`PN`,
2519:term:`S`, and
2520:term:`D` variables in the Yocto Project
2521Reference Manual's variable glossary.
2522
2523.. note::
2524
2525 - Using :term:`DEPENDS` is a good
2526 idea even for components distributed in binary form, and is often
2527 necessary for shared libraries. For a shared library, listing the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002528 library dependencies in :term:`DEPENDS` makes sure that the libraries
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002529 are available in the staging sysroot when other recipes link
2530 against the library, which might be necessary for successful
2531 linking.
2532
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002533 - Using :term:`DEPENDS` also allows runtime dependencies between
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002534 packages to be added automatically. See the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002535 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:automatically added runtime dependencies`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002536 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for more
2537 information.
2538
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00002539If you cannot use the :ref:`bin_package <ref-classes-bin-package>` class, you need to be sure you are
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002540doing the following:
2541
2542- Create a recipe where the
2543 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` and
2544 :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` tasks do
2545 nothing: It is usually sufficient to just not define these tasks in
2546 the recipe, because the default implementations do nothing unless a
2547 Makefile is found in
2548 ``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``.
2549
2550 If ``${S}`` might contain a Makefile, or if you inherit some class
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002551 that replaces :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` and :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` with custom
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002552 versions, then you can use the
2553 ``[``\ :ref:`noexec <bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ``]``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002554 flag to turn the tasks into no-ops, as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002555
2556 do_configure[noexec] = "1"
2557 do_compile[noexec] = "1"
2558
2559 Unlike
2560 :ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:deleting a task`,
2561 using the flag preserves the dependency chain from the
2562 :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`,
2563 :ref:`ref-tasks-unpack`, and
2564 :ref:`ref-tasks-patch` tasks to the
2565 :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task.
2566
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002567- Make sure your :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task installs the binaries
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002568 appropriately.
2569
2570- Ensure that you set up :term:`FILES`
2571 (usually
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002572 ``FILES:${``\ :term:`PN`\ ``}``) to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002573 point to the files you have installed, which of course depends on
2574 where you have installed them and whether those files are in
2575 different locations than the defaults.
2576
2577Following Recipe Style Guidelines
2578---------------------------------
2579
2580When writing recipes, it is good to conform to existing style
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -06002581guidelines. The :oe_wiki:`OpenEmbedded Styleguide </Styleguide>` wiki page
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002582provides rough guidelines for preferred recipe style.
2583
2584It is common for existing recipes to deviate a bit from this style.
2585However, aiming for at least a consistent style is a good idea. Some
2586practices, such as omitting spaces around ``=`` operators in assignments
2587or ordering recipe components in an erratic way, are widely seen as poor
2588style.
2589
2590Recipe Syntax
2591-------------
2592
2593Understanding recipe file syntax is important for writing recipes. The
2594following list overviews the basic items that make up a BitBake recipe
2595file. For more complete BitBake syntax descriptions, see the
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05002596":doc:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002597chapter of the BitBake User Manual.
2598
2599- *Variable Assignments and Manipulations:* Variable assignments allow
2600 a value to be assigned to a variable. The assignment can be static
2601 text or might include the contents of other variables. In addition to
2602 the assignment, appending and prepending operations are also
2603 supported.
2604
2605 The following example shows some of the ways you can use variables in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002606 recipes::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002607
2608 S = "${WORKDIR}/postfix-${PV}"
2609 CFLAGS += "-DNO_ASM"
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05002610 CFLAGS:append = " --enable-important-feature"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002611
2612- *Functions:* Functions provide a series of actions to be performed.
2613 You usually use functions to override the default implementation of a
2614 task function or to complement a default function (i.e. append or
2615 prepend to an existing function). Standard functions use ``sh`` shell
2616 syntax, although access to OpenEmbedded variables and internal
2617 methods are also available.
2618
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07002619 Here is an example function from the ``sed`` recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002620
2621 do_install () {
2622 autotools_do_install
2623 install -d ${D}${base_bindir}
2624 mv ${D}${bindir}/sed ${D}${base_bindir}/sed
2625 rmdir ${D}${bindir}/
2626 }
2627
2628 It is
2629 also possible to implement new functions that are called between
2630 existing tasks as long as the new functions are not replacing or
2631 complementing the default functions. You can implement functions in
2632 Python instead of shell. Both of these options are not seen in the
2633 majority of recipes.
2634
2635- *Keywords:* BitBake recipes use only a few keywords. You use keywords
2636 to include common functions (``inherit``), load parts of a recipe
2637 from other files (``include`` and ``require``) and export variables
2638 to the environment (``export``).
2639
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002640 The following example shows the use of some of these keywords::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002641
2642 export POSTCONF = "${STAGING_BINDIR}/postconf"
2643 inherit autoconf
2644 require otherfile.inc
2645
2646- *Comments (#):* Any lines that begin with the hash character (``#``)
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002647 are treated as comment lines and are ignored::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002648
2649 # This is a comment
2650
2651This next list summarizes the most important and most commonly used
2652parts of the recipe syntax. For more information on these parts of the
2653syntax, you can reference the
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05002654":doc:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata`" chapter
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002655in the BitBake User Manual.
2656
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002657- *Line Continuation (\\):* Use the backward slash (``\``) character to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002658 split a statement over multiple lines. Place the slash character at
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002659 the end of the line that is to be continued on the next line::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002660
2661 VAR = "A really long \
2662 line"
2663
2664 .. note::
2665
2666 You cannot have any characters including spaces or tabs after the
2667 slash character.
2668
2669- *Using Variables (${VARNAME}):* Use the ``${VARNAME}`` syntax to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002670 access the contents of a variable::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002671
2672 SRC_URI = "${SOURCEFORGE_MIRROR}/libpng/zlib-${PV}.tar.gz"
2673
2674 .. note::
2675
2676 It is important to understand that the value of a variable
2677 expressed in this form does not get substituted automatically. The
2678 expansion of these expressions happens on-demand later (e.g.
2679 usually when a function that makes reference to the variable
2680 executes). This behavior ensures that the values are most
2681 appropriate for the context in which they are finally used. On the
2682 rare occasion that you do need the variable expression to be
2683 expanded immediately, you can use the
2684 :=
2685 operator instead of
2686 =
2687 when you make the assignment, but this is not generally needed.
2688
2689- *Quote All Assignments ("value"):* Use double quotes around values in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002690 all variable assignments (e.g. ``"value"``). Following is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002691
2692 VAR1 = "${OTHERVAR}"
2693 VAR2 = "The version is ${PV}"
2694
2695- *Conditional Assignment (?=):* Conditional assignment is used to
2696 assign a value to a variable, but only when the variable is currently
2697 unset. Use the question mark followed by the equal sign (``?=``) to
2698 make a "soft" assignment used for conditional assignment. Typically,
2699 "soft" assignments are used in the ``local.conf`` file for variables
2700 that are allowed to come through from the external environment.
2701
2702 Here is an example where ``VAR1`` is set to "New value" if it is
2703 currently empty. However, if ``VAR1`` has already been set, it
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002704 remains unchanged::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002705
2706 VAR1 ?= "New value"
2707
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002708 In this next example, ``VAR1`` is left with the value "Original value"::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002709
2710 VAR1 = "Original value"
2711 VAR1 ?= "New value"
2712
2713- *Appending (+=):* Use the plus character followed by the equals sign
2714 (``+=``) to append values to existing variables.
2715
2716 .. note::
2717
2718 This operator adds a space between the existing content of the
2719 variable and the new content.
2720
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002721 Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002722
2723 SRC_URI += "file://fix-makefile.patch"
2724
2725- *Prepending (=+):* Use the equals sign followed by the plus character
2726 (``=+``) to prepend values to existing variables.
2727
2728 .. note::
2729
2730 This operator adds a space between the new content and the
2731 existing content of the variable.
2732
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002733 Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002734
2735 VAR =+ "Starts"
2736
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002737- *Appending (:append):* Use the ``:append`` operator to append values
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002738 to existing variables. This operator does not add any additional
2739 space. Also, the operator is applied after all the ``+=``, and ``=+``
2740 operators have been applied and after all ``=`` assignments have
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05002741 occurred. This means that if ``:append`` is used in a recipe, it can
2742 only be overridden by another layer using the special ``:remove``
2743 operator, which in turn will prevent further layers from adding it back.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002744
2745 The following example shows the space being explicitly added to the
2746 start to ensure the appended value is not merged with the existing
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002747 value::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002748
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05002749 CFLAGS:append = " --enable-important-feature"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002750
2751 You can also use
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002752 the ``:append`` operator with overrides, which results in the actions
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002753 only being performed for the specified target or machine::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002754
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05002755 CFLAGS:append:sh4 = " --enable-important-sh4-specific-feature"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002756
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002757- *Prepending (:prepend):* Use the ``:prepend`` operator to prepend
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002758 values to existing variables. This operator does not add any
2759 additional space. Also, the operator is applied after all the ``+=``,
2760 and ``=+`` operators have been applied and after all ``=``
2761 assignments have occurred.
2762
2763 The following example shows the space being explicitly added to the
2764 end to ensure the prepended value is not merged with the existing
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002765 value::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002766
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002767 CFLAGS:prepend = "-I${S}/myincludes "
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002768
2769 You can also use the
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002770 ``:prepend`` operator with overrides, which results in the actions
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002771 only being performed for the specified target or machine::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002772
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002773 CFLAGS:prepend:sh4 = "-I${S}/myincludes "
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002774
2775- *Overrides:* You can use overrides to set a value conditionally,
2776 typically based on how the recipe is being built. For example, to set
2777 the :term:`KBRANCH` variable's
2778 value to "standard/base" for any target
2779 :term:`MACHINE`, except for
2780 qemuarm where it should be set to "standard/arm-versatile-926ejs",
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002781 you would do the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002782
2783 KBRANCH = "standard/base"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05002784 KBRANCH:qemuarm = "standard/arm-versatile-926ejs"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002785
2786 Overrides are also used to separate
2787 alternate values of a variable in other situations. For example, when
2788 setting variables such as
2789 :term:`FILES` and
2790 :term:`RDEPENDS` that are
2791 specific to individual packages produced by a recipe, you should
2792 always use an override that specifies the name of the package.
2793
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002794- *Indentation:* Use spaces for indentation rather than tabs. For
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002795 shell functions, both currently work. However, it is a policy
2796 decision of the Yocto Project to use tabs in shell functions. Realize
2797 that some layers have a policy to use spaces for all indentation.
2798
2799- *Using Python for Complex Operations:* For more advanced processing,
2800 it is possible to use Python code during variable assignments (e.g.
2801 search and replacement on a variable).
2802
2803 You indicate Python code using the ``${@python_code}`` syntax for the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002804 variable assignment::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002805
2806 SRC_URI = "ftp://ftp.info-zip.org/pub/infozip/src/zip${@d.getVar('PV',1).replace('.', '')}.tgz
2807
2808- *Shell Function Syntax:* Write shell functions as if you were writing
2809 a shell script when you describe a list of actions to take. You
2810 should ensure that your script works with a generic ``sh`` and that
2811 it does not require any ``bash`` or other shell-specific
2812 functionality. The same considerations apply to various system
2813 utilities (e.g. ``sed``, ``grep``, ``awk``, and so forth) that you
2814 might wish to use. If in doubt, you should check with multiple
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05002815 implementations --- including those from BusyBox.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002816
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002817Adding a New Machine
2818====================
2819
2820Adding a new machine to the Yocto Project is a straightforward process.
2821This section describes how to add machines that are similar to those
2822that the Yocto Project already supports.
2823
2824.. note::
2825
2826 Although well within the capabilities of the Yocto Project, adding a
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002827 totally new architecture might require changes to ``gcc``/``glibc``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002828 and to the site information, which is beyond the scope of this
2829 manual.
2830
2831For a complete example that shows how to add a new machine, see the
2832":ref:`bsp-guide/bsp:creating a new bsp layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`"
2833section in the Yocto Project Board Support Package (BSP) Developer's
2834Guide.
2835
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002836Adding the Machine Configuration File
2837-------------------------------------
2838
2839To add a new machine, you need to add a new machine configuration file
2840to the layer's ``conf/machine`` directory. This configuration file
2841provides details about the device you are adding.
2842
2843The OpenEmbedded build system uses the root name of the machine
2844configuration file to reference the new machine. For example, given a
2845machine configuration file named ``crownbay.conf``, the build system
2846recognizes the machine as "crownbay".
2847
2848The most important variables you must set in your machine configuration
2849file or include from a lower-level configuration file are as follows:
2850
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04002851- :term:`TARGET_ARCH` (e.g. "arm")
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002852
2853- ``PREFERRED_PROVIDER_virtual/kernel``
2854
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002855- :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES` (e.g. "apm screen wifi")
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002856
2857You might also need these variables:
2858
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04002859- :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES` (e.g. "115200;ttyS0 115200;ttyS1")
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002860
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04002861- :term:`KERNEL_IMAGETYPE` (e.g. "zImage")
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002862
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002863- :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES` (e.g. "tar.gz jffs2")
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002864
2865You can find full details on these variables in the reference section.
2866You can leverage existing machine ``.conf`` files from
2867``meta-yocto-bsp/conf/machine/``.
2868
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002869Adding a Kernel for the Machine
2870-------------------------------
2871
2872The OpenEmbedded build system needs to be able to build a kernel for the
2873machine. You need to either create a new kernel recipe for this machine,
2874or extend an existing kernel recipe. You can find several kernel recipe
2875examples in the Source Directory at ``meta/recipes-kernel/linux`` that
2876you can use as references.
2877
2878If you are creating a new kernel recipe, normal recipe-writing rules
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002879apply for setting up a :term:`SRC_URI`. Thus, you need to specify any
2880necessary patches and set :term:`S` to point at the source code. You need to
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05002881create a :ref:`ref-tasks-configure` task that configures the unpacked kernel with
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002882a ``defconfig`` file. You can do this by using a ``make defconfig``
2883command or, more commonly, by copying in a suitable ``defconfig`` file
2884and then running ``make oldconfig``. By making use of ``inherit kernel``
2885and potentially some of the ``linux-*.inc`` files, most other
2886functionality is centralized and the defaults of the class normally work
2887well.
2888
2889If you are extending an existing kernel recipe, it is usually a matter
2890of adding a suitable ``defconfig`` file. The file needs to be added into
2891a location similar to ``defconfig`` files used for other machines in a
2892given kernel recipe. A possible way to do this is by listing the file in
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05002893the :term:`SRC_URI` and adding the machine to the expression in
2894:term:`COMPATIBLE_MACHINE`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002895
2896 COMPATIBLE_MACHINE = '(qemux86|qemumips)'
2897
2898For more information on ``defconfig`` files, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002899":ref:`kernel-dev/common:changing the configuration`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002900section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
2901
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002902Adding a Formfactor Configuration File
2903--------------------------------------
2904
2905A formfactor configuration file provides information about the target
2906hardware for which the image is being built and information that the
2907build system cannot obtain from other sources such as the kernel. Some
2908examples of information contained in a formfactor configuration file
2909include framebuffer orientation, whether or not the system has a
2910keyboard, the positioning of the keyboard in relation to the screen, and
2911the screen resolution.
2912
2913The build system uses reasonable defaults in most cases. However, if
2914customization is necessary, you need to create a ``machconfig`` file in
2915the ``meta/recipes-bsp/formfactor/files`` directory. This directory
2916contains directories for specific machines such as ``qemuarm`` and
2917``qemux86``. For information about the settings available and the
2918defaults, see the ``meta/recipes-bsp/formfactor/files/config`` file
2919found in the same area.
2920
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002921Following is an example for "qemuarm" machine::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002922
2923 HAVE_TOUCHSCREEN=1
2924 HAVE_KEYBOARD=1
2925 DISPLAY_CAN_ROTATE=0
2926 DISPLAY_ORIENTATION=0
2927 #DISPLAY_WIDTH_PIXELS=640
2928 #DISPLAY_HEIGHT_PIXELS=480
2929 #DISPLAY_BPP=16
2930 DISPLAY_DPI=150
2931 DISPLAY_SUBPIXEL_ORDER=vrgb
2932
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002933Upgrading Recipes
2934=================
2935
2936Over time, upstream developers publish new versions for software built
2937by layer recipes. It is recommended to keep recipes up-to-date with
2938upstream version releases.
2939
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07002940While there are several methods to upgrade a recipe, you might
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002941consider checking on the upgrade status of a recipe first. You can do so
2942using the ``devtool check-upgrade-status`` command. See the
2943":ref:`devtool-checking-on-the-upgrade-status-of-a-recipe`"
2944section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual for more information.
2945
2946The remainder of this section describes three ways you can upgrade a
2947recipe. You can use the Automated Upgrade Helper (AUH) to set up
2948automatic version upgrades. Alternatively, you can use
2949``devtool upgrade`` to set up semi-automatic version upgrades. Finally,
2950you can manually upgrade a recipe by editing the recipe itself.
2951
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002952Using the Auto Upgrade Helper (AUH)
2953-----------------------------------
2954
2955The AUH utility works in conjunction with the OpenEmbedded build system
2956in order to automatically generate upgrades for recipes based on new
2957versions being published upstream. Use AUH when you want to create a
2958service that performs the upgrades automatically and optionally sends
2959you an email with the results.
2960
2961AUH allows you to update several recipes with a single use. You can also
2962optionally perform build and integration tests using images with the
2963results saved to your hard drive and emails of results optionally sent
2964to recipe maintainers. Finally, AUH creates Git commits with appropriate
2965commit messages in the layer's tree for the changes made to recipes.
2966
2967.. note::
2968
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07002969 In some conditions, you should not use AUH to upgrade recipes
2970 and should instead use either ``devtool upgrade`` or upgrade your
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002971 recipes manually:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002972
2973 - When AUH cannot complete the upgrade sequence. This situation
2974 usually results because custom patches carried by the recipe
2975 cannot be automatically rebased to the new version. In this case,
2976 ``devtool upgrade`` allows you to manually resolve conflicts.
2977
2978 - When for any reason you want fuller control over the upgrade
2979 process. For example, when you want special arrangements for
2980 testing.
2981
2982The following steps describe how to set up the AUH utility:
2983
29841. *Be Sure the Development Host is Set Up:* You need to be sure that
2985 your development host is set up to use the Yocto Project. For
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05002986 information on how to set up your host, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06002987 ":ref:`dev-manual/start:Preparing the Build Host`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002988
29892. *Make Sure Git is Configured:* The AUH utility requires Git to be
2990 configured because AUH uses Git to save upgrades. Thus, you must have
2991 Git user and email configured. The following command shows your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002992 configurations::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002993
2994 $ git config --list
2995
2996 If you do not have the user and
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05002997 email configured, you can use the following commands to do so::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05002998
2999 $ git config --global user.name some_name
3000 $ git config --global user.email username@domain.com
3001
30023. *Clone the AUH Repository:* To use AUH, you must clone the repository
3003 onto your development host. The following command uses Git to create
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003004 a local copy of the repository on your system::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003005
3006 $ git clone git://git.yoctoproject.org/auto-upgrade-helper
3007 Cloning into 'auto-upgrade-helper'... remote: Counting objects: 768, done.
3008 remote: Compressing objects: 100% (300/300), done.
3009 remote: Total 768 (delta 499), reused 703 (delta 434)
3010 Receiving objects: 100% (768/768), 191.47 KiB | 98.00 KiB/s, done.
3011 Resolving deltas: 100% (499/499), done.
3012 Checking connectivity... done.
3013
3014 AUH is not part of the :term:`OpenEmbedded-Core (OE-Core)` or
3015 :term:`Poky` repositories.
3016
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050030174. *Create a Dedicated Build Directory:* Run the :ref:`structure-core-script`
3018 script to create a fresh :term:`Build Directory` that you use exclusively
3019 for running the AUH utility::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003020
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -05003021 $ cd poky
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003022 $ source oe-init-build-env your_AUH_build_directory
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003023
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003024 Re-using an existing :term:`Build Directory` and its configurations is not
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003025 recommended as existing settings could cause AUH to fail or behave
3026 undesirably.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003027
30285. *Make Configurations in Your Local Configuration File:* Several
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07003029 settings are needed in the ``local.conf`` file in the build
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003030 directory you just created for AUH. Make these following
3031 configurations:
3032
3033 - If you want to enable :ref:`Build
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003034 History <dev-manual/common-tasks:maintaining build output quality>`,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003035 which is optional, you need the following lines in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003036 ``conf/local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003037
3038 INHERIT =+ "buildhistory"
3039 BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1"
3040
3041 With this configuration and a successful
3042 upgrade, a build history "diff" file appears in the
3043 ``upgrade-helper/work/recipe/buildhistory-diff.txt`` file found in
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003044 your :term:`Build Directory`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003045
3046 - If you want to enable testing through the
Patrick Williams975a06f2022-10-21 14:42:47 -05003047 :ref:`testimage <ref-classes-testimage>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003048 class, which is optional, you need to have the following set in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003049 your ``conf/local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003050
3051 INHERIT += "testimage"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003052
3053 .. note::
3054
3055 If your distro does not enable by default ptest, which Poky
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003056 does, you need the following in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003057
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05003058 DISTRO_FEATURES:append = " ptest"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003059
3060
30616. *Optionally Start a vncserver:* If you are running in a server
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003062 without an X11 session, you need to start a vncserver::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003063
3064 $ vncserver :1
3065 $ export DISPLAY=:1
3066
30677. *Create and Edit an AUH Configuration File:* You need to have the
3068 ``upgrade-helper/upgrade-helper.conf`` configuration file in your
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003069 :term:`Build Directory`. You can find a sample configuration file in the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003070 :yocto_git:`AUH source repository </auto-upgrade-helper/tree/>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003071
3072 Read through the sample file and make configurations as needed. For
3073 example, if you enabled build history in your ``local.conf`` as
3074 described earlier, you must enable it in ``upgrade-helper.conf``.
3075
3076 Also, if you are using the default ``maintainers.inc`` file supplied
3077 with Poky and located in ``meta-yocto`` and you do not set a
3078 "maintainers_whitelist" or "global_maintainer_override" in the
3079 ``upgrade-helper.conf`` configuration, and you specify "-e all" on
3080 the AUH command-line, the utility automatically sends out emails to
3081 all the default maintainers. Please avoid this.
3082
3083This next set of examples describes how to use the AUH:
3084
3085- *Upgrading a Specific Recipe:* To upgrade a specific recipe, use the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003086 following form::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003087
3088 $ upgrade-helper.py recipe_name
3089
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003090 For example, this command upgrades the ``xmodmap`` recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003091
3092 $ upgrade-helper.py xmodmap
3093
3094- *Upgrading a Specific Recipe to a Particular Version:* To upgrade a
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003095 specific recipe to a particular version, use the following form::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003096
3097 $ upgrade-helper.py recipe_name -t version
3098
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003099 For example, this command upgrades the ``xmodmap`` recipe to version 1.2.3::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003100
3101 $ upgrade-helper.py xmodmap -t 1.2.3
3102
3103- *Upgrading all Recipes to the Latest Versions and Suppressing Email
3104 Notifications:* To upgrade all recipes to their most recent versions
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003105 and suppress the email notifications, use the following command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003106
3107 $ upgrade-helper.py all
3108
3109- *Upgrading all Recipes to the Latest Versions and Send Email
3110 Notifications:* To upgrade all recipes to their most recent versions
3111 and send email messages to maintainers for each attempted recipe as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003112 well as a status email, use the following command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003113
3114 $ upgrade-helper.py -e all
3115
3116Once you have run the AUH utility, you can find the results in the AUH
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003117:term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003118
3119 ${BUILDDIR}/upgrade-helper/timestamp
3120
3121The AUH utility
3122also creates recipe update commits from successful upgrade attempts in
3123the layer tree.
3124
3125You can easily set up to run the AUH utility on a regular basis by using
3126a cron job. See the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003127:yocto_git:`weeklyjob.sh </auto-upgrade-helper/tree/weeklyjob.sh>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003128file distributed with the utility for an example.
3129
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003130Using ``devtool upgrade``
3131-------------------------
3132
3133As mentioned earlier, an alternative method for upgrading recipes to
3134newer versions is to use
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003135:doc:`devtool upgrade </ref-manual/devtool-reference>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003136You can read about ``devtool upgrade`` in general in the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003137":ref:`sdk-manual/extensible:use \`\`devtool upgrade\`\` to create a version of the recipe that supports a newer version of the software`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003138section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the Extensible
3139Software Development Kit (eSDK) Manual.
3140
3141To see all the command-line options available with ``devtool upgrade``,
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003142use the following help command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003143
3144 $ devtool upgrade -h
3145
3146If you want to find out what version a recipe is currently at upstream
3147without any attempt to upgrade your local version of the recipe, you can
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003148use the following command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003149
3150 $ devtool latest-version recipe_name
3151
3152As mentioned in the previous section describing AUH, ``devtool upgrade``
3153works in a less-automated manner than AUH. Specifically,
3154``devtool upgrade`` only works on a single recipe that you name on the
3155command line, cannot perform build and integration testing using images,
3156and does not automatically generate commits for changes in the source
3157tree. Despite all these "limitations", ``devtool upgrade`` updates the
3158recipe file to the new upstream version and attempts to rebase custom
3159patches contained by the recipe as needed.
3160
3161.. note::
3162
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003163 AUH uses much of ``devtool upgrade`` behind the scenes making AUH somewhat
3164 of a "wrapper" application for ``devtool upgrade``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003165
3166A typical scenario involves having used Git to clone an upstream
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003167repository that you use during build operations. Because you have built the
3168recipe in the past, the layer is likely added to your
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003169configuration already. If for some reason, the layer is not added, you
3170could add it easily using the
3171":ref:`bitbake-layers <bsp-guide/bsp:creating a new bsp layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script>`"
3172script. For example, suppose you use the ``nano.bb`` recipe from the
3173``meta-oe`` layer in the ``meta-openembedded`` repository. For this
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003174example, assume that the layer has been cloned into following area::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003175
3176 /home/scottrif/meta-openembedded
3177
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003178The following command from your :term:`Build Directory` adds the layer to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003179your build configuration (i.e. ``${BUILDDIR}/conf/bblayers.conf``)::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003180
3181 $ bitbake-layers add-layer /home/scottrif/meta-openembedded/meta-oe
3182 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
3183 Parsing recipes: 100% |##########################################| Time: 0:00:55
3184 Parsing of 1431 .bb files complete (0 cached, 1431 parsed). 2040 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors.
3185 Removing 12 recipes from the x86_64 sysroot: 100% |##############| Time: 0:00:00
3186 Removing 1 recipes from the x86_64_i586 sysroot: 100% |##########| Time: 0:00:00
3187 Removing 5 recipes from the i586 sysroot: 100% |#################| Time: 0:00:00
3188 Removing 5 recipes from the qemux86 sysroot: 100% |##############| Time: 0:00:00
3189
3190For this example, assume that the ``nano.bb`` recipe that
3191is upstream has a 2.9.3 version number. However, the version in the
3192local repository is 2.7.4. The following command from your build
3193directory automatically upgrades the recipe for you:
3194
3195.. note::
3196
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003197 Using the ``-V`` option is not necessary. Omitting the version number causes
3198 ``devtool upgrade`` to upgrade the recipe to the most recent version.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003199
3200::
3201
3202 $ devtool upgrade nano -V 2.9.3
3203 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
3204 NOTE: Creating workspace layer in /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace
3205 Parsing recipes: 100% |##########################################| Time: 0:00:46
3206 Parsing of 1431 .bb files complete (0 cached, 1431 parsed). 2040 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors.
3207 NOTE: Extracting current version source...
3208 NOTE: Resolving any missing task queue dependencies
3209 .
3210 .
3211 .
3212 NOTE: Executing SetScene Tasks
3213 NOTE: Executing RunQueue Tasks
3214 NOTE: Tasks Summary: Attempted 74 tasks of which 72 didn't need to be rerun and all succeeded.
3215 Adding changed files: 100% |#####################################| Time: 0:00:00
3216 NOTE: Upgraded source extracted to /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/nano
3217 NOTE: New recipe is /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/recipes/nano/nano_2.9.3.bb
3218
3219Continuing with this example, you can use ``devtool build`` to build the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003220newly upgraded recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003221
3222 $ devtool build nano
3223 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
3224 Loading cache: 100% |################################################################################################| Time: 0:00:01
3225 Loaded 2040 entries from dependency cache.
3226 Parsing recipes: 100% |##############################################################################################| Time: 0:00:00
3227 Parsing of 1432 .bb files complete (1431 cached, 1 parsed). 2041 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors.
3228 NOTE: Resolving any missing task queue dependencies
3229 .
3230 .
3231 .
3232 NOTE: Executing SetScene Tasks
3233 NOTE: Executing RunQueue Tasks
3234 NOTE: nano: compiling from external source tree /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/nano
3235 NOTE: Tasks Summary: Attempted 520 tasks of which 304 didn't need to be rerun and all succeeded.
3236
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07003237Within the ``devtool upgrade`` workflow, you can
3238deploy and test your rebuilt software. For this example,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003239however, running ``devtool finish`` cleans up the workspace once the
3240source in your workspace is clean. This usually means using Git to stage
3241and submit commits for the changes generated by the upgrade process.
3242
3243Once the tree is clean, you can clean things up in this example with the
3244following command from the ``${BUILDDIR}/workspace/sources/nano``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003245directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003246
3247 $ devtool finish nano meta-oe
3248 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
3249 Loading cache: 100% |################################################################################################| Time: 0:00:00
3250 Loaded 2040 entries from dependency cache.
3251 Parsing recipes: 100% |##############################################################################################| Time: 0:00:01
3252 Parsing of 1432 .bb files complete (1431 cached, 1 parsed). 2041 targets, 56 skipped, 0 masked, 0 errors.
3253 NOTE: Adding new patch 0001-nano.bb-Stuff-I-changed-when-upgrading-nano.bb.patch
3254 NOTE: Updating recipe nano_2.9.3.bb
3255 NOTE: Removing file /home/scottrif/meta-openembedded/meta-oe/recipes-support/nano/nano_2.7.4.bb
3256 NOTE: Moving recipe file to /home/scottrif/meta-openembedded/meta-oe/recipes-support/nano
3257 NOTE: Leaving source tree /home/scottrif/poky/build/workspace/sources/nano as-is; if you no longer need it then please delete it manually
3258
3259
3260Using the ``devtool finish`` command cleans up the workspace and creates a patch
3261file based on your commits. The tool puts all patch files back into the
3262source directory in a sub-directory named ``nano`` in this case.
3263
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003264Manually Upgrading a Recipe
3265---------------------------
3266
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003267If for some reason you choose not to upgrade recipes using
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003268:ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:Using the Auto Upgrade Helper (AUH)` or
3269by :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:Using \`\`devtool upgrade\`\``,
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003270you can manually edit the recipe files to upgrade the versions.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003271
3272.. note::
3273
3274 Manually updating multiple recipes scales poorly and involves many
3275 steps. The recommendation to upgrade recipe versions is through AUH
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003276 or ``devtool upgrade``, both of which automate some steps and provide
3277 guidance for others needed for the manual process.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003278
3279To manually upgrade recipe versions, follow these general steps:
3280
32811. *Change the Version:* Rename the recipe such that the version (i.e.
3282 the :term:`PV` part of the recipe name)
3283 changes appropriately. If the version is not part of the recipe name,
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003284 change the value as it is set for :term:`PV` within the recipe itself.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003285
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050032862. *Update* :term:`SRCREV` *if Needed*: If the source code your recipe builds
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003287 is fetched from Git or some other version control system, update
3288 :term:`SRCREV` to point to the
3289 commit hash that matches the new version.
3290
32913. *Build the Software:* Try to build the recipe using BitBake. Typical
3292 build failures include the following:
3293
3294 - License statements were updated for the new version. For this
3295 case, you need to review any changes to the license and update the
3296 values of :term:`LICENSE` and
3297 :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
3298 as needed.
3299
3300 .. note::
3301
3302 License changes are often inconsequential. For example, the
3303 license text's copyright year might have changed.
3304
3305 - Custom patches carried by the older version of the recipe might
3306 fail to apply to the new version. For these cases, you need to
3307 review the failures. Patches might not be necessary for the new
3308 version of the software if the upgraded version has fixed those
3309 issues. If a patch is necessary and failing, you need to rebase it
3310 into the new version.
3311
33124. *Optionally Attempt to Build for Several Architectures:* Once you
3313 successfully build the new software for a given architecture, you
3314 could test the build for other architectures by changing the
3315 :term:`MACHINE` variable and
3316 rebuilding the software. This optional step is especially important
3317 if the recipe is to be released publicly.
3318
33195. *Check the Upstream Change Log or Release Notes:* Checking both these
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07003320 reveals if there are new features that could break
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003321 backwards-compatibility. If so, you need to take steps to mitigate or
3322 eliminate that situation.
3323
33246. *Optionally Create a Bootable Image and Test:* If you want, you can
3325 test the new software by booting it onto actual hardware.
3326
33277. *Create a Commit with the Change in the Layer Repository:* After all
3328 builds work and any testing is successful, you can create commits for
3329 any changes in the layer holding your upgraded recipe.
3330
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003331Finding Temporary Source Code
3332=============================
3333
3334You might find it helpful during development to modify the temporary
3335source code used by recipes to build packages. For example, suppose you
3336are developing a patch and you need to experiment a bit to figure out
3337your solution. After you have initially built the package, you can
3338iteratively tweak the source code, which is located in the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003339:term:`Build Directory`, and then you can force a re-compile and quickly
3340test your altered code. Once you settle on a solution, you can then preserve
3341your changes in the form of patches.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003342
3343During a build, the unpacked temporary source code used by recipes to
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003344build packages is available in the :term:`Build Directory` as defined by the
3345:term:`S` variable. Below is the default value for the :term:`S` variable as
3346defined in the ``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003347:term:`Source Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003348
3349 S = "${WORKDIR}/${BP}"
3350
3351You should be aware that many recipes override the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003352:term:`S` variable. For example, recipes that fetch their source from Git
3353usually set :term:`S` to ``${WORKDIR}/git``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003354
3355.. note::
3356
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003357 The :term:`BP` represents the base recipe name, which consists of the name
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003358 and version::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003359
3360 BP = "${BPN}-${PV}"
3361
3362
3363The path to the work directory for the recipe
3364(:term:`WORKDIR`) is defined as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003365follows::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003366
3367 ${TMPDIR}/work/${MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS}/${PN}/${EXTENDPE}${PV}-${PR}
3368
3369The actual directory depends on several things:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003370
3371- :term:`TMPDIR`: The top-level build
3372 output directory.
3373
3374- :term:`MULTIMACH_TARGET_SYS`:
3375 The target system identifier.
3376
3377- :term:`PN`: The recipe name.
3378
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003379- :term:`EXTENDPE`: The epoch --- if
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003380 :term:`PE` is not specified, which is
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003381 usually the case for most recipes, then :term:`EXTENDPE` is blank.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003382
3383- :term:`PV`: The recipe version.
3384
3385- :term:`PR`: The recipe revision.
3386
3387As an example, assume a Source Directory top-level folder named
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003388``poky``, a default :term:`Build Directory` at ``poky/build``, and a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003389``qemux86-poky-linux`` machine target system. Furthermore, suppose your
3390recipe is named ``foo_1.3.0.bb``. In this case, the work directory the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003391build system uses to build the package would be as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003392
3393 poky/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/foo/1.3.0-r0
3394
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003395Using Quilt in Your Workflow
3396============================
3397
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003398`Quilt <https://savannah.nongnu.org/projects/quilt>`__ is a powerful tool
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003399that allows you to capture source code changes without having a clean
3400source tree. This section outlines the typical workflow you can use to
3401modify source code, test changes, and then preserve the changes in the
3402form of a patch all using Quilt.
3403
3404.. note::
3405
3406 With regard to preserving changes to source files, if you clean a
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003407 recipe or have ``rm_work`` enabled, the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003408 :ref:`devtool workflow <sdk-manual/extensible:using \`\`devtool\`\` in your sdk workflow>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003409 as described in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
3410 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual is a safer
3411 development flow than the flow that uses Quilt.
3412
3413Follow these general steps:
3414
34151. *Find the Source Code:* Temporary source code used by the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003416 OpenEmbedded build system is kept in the :term:`Build Directory`. See the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003417 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:finding temporary source code`" section to
3418 learn how to locate the directory that has the temporary source code for a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003419 particular package.
3420
34212. *Change Your Working Directory:* You need to be in the directory that
3422 has the temporary source code. That directory is defined by the
3423 :term:`S` variable.
3424
34253. *Create a New Patch:* Before modifying source code, you need to
3426 create a new patch. To create a new patch file, use ``quilt new`` as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003427 below::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003428
3429 $ quilt new my_changes.patch
3430
34314. *Notify Quilt and Add Files:* After creating the patch, you need to
3432 notify Quilt about the files you plan to edit. You notify Quilt by
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003433 adding the files to the patch you just created::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003434
3435 $ quilt add file1.c file2.c file3.c
3436
34375. *Edit the Files:* Make your changes in the source code to the files
3438 you added to the patch.
3439
34406. *Test Your Changes:* Once you have modified the source code, the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003441 easiest way to test your changes is by calling the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003442 task as shown in the following example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003443
3444 $ bitbake -c compile -f package
3445
3446 The ``-f`` or ``--force`` option forces the specified task to
3447 execute. If you find problems with your code, you can just keep
3448 editing and re-testing iteratively until things work as expected.
3449
3450 .. note::
3451
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003452 All the modifications you make to the temporary source code disappear
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003453 once you run the :ref:`ref-tasks-clean` or :ref:`ref-tasks-cleanall` tasks using BitBake
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003454 (i.e. ``bitbake -c clean package`` and ``bitbake -c cleanall package``).
3455 Modifications will also disappear if you use the ``rm_work`` feature as
3456 described in the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003457 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:conserving disk space during builds`"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003458 section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003459
34607. *Generate the Patch:* Once your changes work as expected, you need to
3461 use Quilt to generate the final patch that contains all your
3462 modifications.
3463 ::
3464
3465 $ quilt refresh
3466
3467 At this point, the
3468 ``my_changes.patch`` file has all your edits made to the ``file1.c``,
3469 ``file2.c``, and ``file3.c`` files.
3470
3471 You can find the resulting patch file in the ``patches/``
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003472 subdirectory of the source (:term:`S`) directory.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003473
34748. *Copy the Patch File:* For simplicity, copy the patch file into a
3475 directory named ``files``, which you can create in the same directory
3476 that holds the recipe (``.bb``) file or the append (``.bbappend``)
3477 file. Placing the patch here guarantees that the OpenEmbedded build
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003478 system will find the patch. Next, add the patch into the :term:`SRC_URI`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003479 of the recipe. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003480
3481 SRC_URI += "file://my_changes.patch"
3482
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003483Using a Development Shell
3484=========================
3485
3486When debugging certain commands or even when just editing packages,
3487``devshell`` can be a useful tool. When you invoke ``devshell``, all
3488tasks up to and including
3489:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` are run for the
3490specified target. Then, a new terminal is opened and you are placed in
3491``${``\ :term:`S`\ ``}``, the source
3492directory. In the new terminal, all the OpenEmbedded build-related
3493environment variables are still defined so you can use commands such as
3494``configure`` and ``make``. The commands execute just as if the
3495OpenEmbedded build system were executing them. Consequently, working
3496this way can be helpful when debugging a build or preparing software to
3497be used with the OpenEmbedded build system.
3498
3499Following is an example that uses ``devshell`` on a target named
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003500``matchbox-desktop``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003501
3502 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c devshell
3503
3504This command spawns a terminal with a shell prompt within the
3505OpenEmbedded build environment. The
3506:term:`OE_TERMINAL` variable
3507controls what type of shell is opened.
3508
3509For spawned terminals, the following occurs:
3510
3511- The ``PATH`` variable includes the cross-toolchain.
3512
3513- The ``pkgconfig`` variables find the correct ``.pc`` files.
3514
3515- The ``configure`` command finds the Yocto Project site files as well
3516 as any other necessary files.
3517
3518Within this environment, you can run configure or compile commands as if
3519they were being run by the OpenEmbedded build system itself. As noted
3520earlier, the working directory also automatically changes to the Source
3521Directory (:term:`S`).
3522
3523To manually run a specific task using ``devshell``, run the
3524corresponding ``run.*`` script in the
3525``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/temp``
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003526directory (e.g., ``run.do_configure.``\ `pid`). If a task's script does
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003527not exist, which would be the case if the task was skipped by way of the
3528sstate cache, you can create the task by first running it outside of the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003529``devshell``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003530
3531 $ bitbake -c task
3532
3533.. note::
3534
3535 - Execution of a task's ``run.*`` script and BitBake's execution of
3536 a task are identical. In other words, running the script re-runs
3537 the task just as it would be run using the ``bitbake -c`` command.
3538
3539 - Any ``run.*`` file that does not have a ``.pid`` extension is a
3540 symbolic link (symlink) to the most recent version of that file.
3541
3542Remember, that the ``devshell`` is a mechanism that allows you to get
3543into the BitBake task execution environment. And as such, all commands
3544must be called just as BitBake would call them. That means you need to
3545provide the appropriate options for cross-compilation and so forth as
3546applicable.
3547
3548When you are finished using ``devshell``, exit the shell or close the
3549terminal window.
3550
3551.. note::
3552
3553 - It is worth remembering that when using ``devshell`` you need to
3554 use the full compiler name such as ``arm-poky-linux-gnueabi-gcc``
3555 instead of just using ``gcc``. The same applies to other
3556 applications such as ``binutils``, ``libtool`` and so forth.
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003557 BitBake sets up environment variables such as :term:`CC` to assist
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003558 applications, such as ``make`` to find the correct tools.
3559
3560 - It is also worth noting that ``devshell`` still works over X11
3561 forwarding and similar situations.
3562
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05003563Using a Python Development Shell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003564================================
3565
3566Similar to working within a development shell as described in the
3567previous section, you can also spawn and work within an interactive
3568Python development shell. When debugging certain commands or even when
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05003569just editing packages, ``pydevshell`` can be a useful tool. When you
3570invoke the ``pydevshell`` task, all tasks up to and including
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003571:ref:`ref-tasks-patch` are run for the
3572specified target. Then a new terminal is opened. Additionally, key
3573Python objects and code are available in the same way they are to
3574BitBake tasks, in particular, the data store 'd'. So, commands such as
3575the following are useful when exploring the data store and running
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003576functions::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003577
3578 pydevshell> d.getVar("STAGING_DIR")
3579 '/media/build1/poky/build/tmp/sysroots'
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05003580 pydevshell> d.getVar("STAGING_DIR", False)
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003581 '${TMPDIR}/sysroots'
3582 pydevshell> d.setVar("FOO", "bar")
3583 pydevshell> d.getVar("FOO")
3584 'bar'
3585 pydevshell> d.delVar("FOO")
3586 pydevshell> d.getVar("FOO")
3587 pydevshell> bb.build.exec_func("do_unpack", d)
3588 pydevshell>
3589
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05003590See the ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:functions you can call from within python`"
3591section in the BitBake User Manual for details about available functions.
3592
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003593The commands execute just as if the OpenEmbedded build
3594system were executing them. Consequently, working this way can be
3595helpful when debugging a build or preparing software to be used with the
3596OpenEmbedded build system.
3597
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05003598Following is an example that uses ``pydevshell`` on a target named
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003599``matchbox-desktop``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003600
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05003601 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c pydevshell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003602
3603This command spawns a terminal and places you in an interactive Python
3604interpreter within the OpenEmbedded build environment. The
3605:term:`OE_TERMINAL` variable
3606controls what type of shell is opened.
3607
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05003608When you are finished using ``pydevshell``, you can exit the shell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003609either by using Ctrl+d or closing the terminal window.
3610
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003611Building
3612========
3613
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05003614This section describes various build procedures, such as the steps
3615needed for a simple build, building a target for multiple configurations,
3616generating an image for more than one machine, and so forth.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003617
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003618Building a Simple Image
3619-----------------------
3620
3621In the development environment, you need to build an image whenever you
3622change hardware support, add or change system libraries, or add or
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07003623change services that have dependencies. There are several methods that allow
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003624you to build an image within the Yocto Project. This section presents
3625the basic steps you need to build a simple image using BitBake from a
3626build host running Linux.
3627
3628.. note::
3629
3630 - For information on how to build an image using
3631 :term:`Toaster`, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003632 :doc:`/toaster-manual/index`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003633
3634 - For information on how to use ``devtool`` to build images, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003635 ":ref:`sdk-manual/extensible:using \`\`devtool\`\` in your sdk workflow`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003636 section in the Yocto Project Application Development and the
3637 Extensible Software Development Kit (eSDK) manual.
3638
3639 - For a quick example on how to build an image using the
3640 OpenEmbedded build system, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003641 :doc:`/brief-yoctoprojectqs/index` document.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003642
3643The build process creates an entire Linux distribution from source and
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003644places it in your :term:`Build Directory` under ``tmp/deploy/images``. For
3645detailed information on the build process using BitBake, see the
3646":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:images`" section in the Yocto Project Overview
3647and Concepts Manual.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003648
3649The following figure and list overviews the build process:
3650
3651.. image:: figures/bitbake-build-flow.png
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05003652 :width: 100%
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003653
36541. *Set up Your Host Development System to Support Development Using the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003655 Yocto Project*: See the ":doc:`start`" section for options on how to get a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003656 build host ready to use the Yocto Project.
3657
36582. *Initialize the Build Environment:* Initialize the build environment
3659 by sourcing the build environment script (i.e.
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003660 :ref:`structure-core-script`)::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003661
3662 $ source oe-init-build-env [build_dir]
3663
3664 When you use the initialization script, the OpenEmbedded build system
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003665 uses ``build`` as the default :term:`Build Directory` in your current work
3666 directory. You can use a `build_dir` argument with the script to
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003667 specify a different :term:`Build Directory`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003668
3669 .. note::
3670
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003671 A common practice is to use a different :term:`Build Directory` for
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05003672 different targets; for example, ``~/build/x86`` for a ``qemux86``
3673 target, and ``~/build/arm`` for a ``qemuarm`` target. In any
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003674 event, it's typically cleaner to locate the :term:`Build Directory`
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05003675 somewhere outside of your source directory.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003676
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050036773. *Make Sure Your* ``local.conf`` *File is Correct*: Ensure the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003678 ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file, which is found in the
3679 :term:`Build Directory`, is set up how you want it. This file defines many
3680 aspects of the build environment including the target machine architecture
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003681 through the :term:`MACHINE` variable, the packaging format used during
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003682 the build (:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`), and a centralized tarball download
3683 directory through the :term:`DL_DIR` variable.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003684
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050036854. *Build the Image:* Build the image using the ``bitbake`` command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003686
3687 $ bitbake target
3688
3689 .. note::
3690
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003691 For information on BitBake, see the :doc:`bitbake:index`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003692
3693 The target is the name of the recipe you want to build. Common
3694 targets are the images in ``meta/recipes-core/images``,
3695 ``meta/recipes-sato/images``, and so forth all found in the
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05003696 :term:`Source Directory`. Alternatively, the target
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003697 can be the name of a recipe for a specific piece of software such as
3698 BusyBox. For more details about the images the OpenEmbedded build
3699 system supports, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003700 ":ref:`ref-manual/images:Images`" chapter in the Yocto
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003701 Project Reference Manual.
3702
3703 As an example, the following command builds the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003704 ``core-image-minimal`` image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003705
3706 $ bitbake core-image-minimal
3707
3708 Once an
3709 image has been built, it often needs to be installed. The images and
3710 kernels built by the OpenEmbedded build system are placed in the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003711 :term:`Build Directory` in ``tmp/deploy/images``. For information on how to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003712 run pre-built images such as ``qemux86`` and ``qemuarm``, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06003713 :doc:`/sdk-manual/index` manual. For
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003714 information about how to install these images, see the documentation
3715 for your particular board or machine.
3716
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003717Building Images for Multiple Targets Using Multiple Configurations
3718------------------------------------------------------------------
3719
3720You can use a single ``bitbake`` command to build multiple images or
3721packages for different targets where each image or package requires a
3722different configuration (multiple configuration builds). The builds, in
3723this scenario, are sometimes referred to as "multiconfigs", and this
3724section uses that term throughout.
3725
3726This section describes how to set up for multiple configuration builds
3727and how to account for cross-build dependencies between the
3728multiconfigs.
3729
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003730Setting Up and Running a Multiple Configuration Build
3731~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
3732
3733To accomplish a multiple configuration build, you must define each
3734target's configuration separately using a parallel configuration file in
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003735the :term:`Build Directory` or configuration directory within a layer, and you
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003736must follow a required file hierarchy. Additionally, you must enable the
3737multiple configuration builds in your ``local.conf`` file.
3738
3739Follow these steps to set up and execute multiple configuration builds:
3740
3741- *Create Separate Configuration Files*: You need to create a single
3742 configuration file for each build target (each multiconfig).
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003743 The configuration definitions are implementation dependent but often
3744 each configuration file will define the machine and the
3745 temporary directory BitBake uses for the build. Whether the same
3746 temporary directory (:term:`TMPDIR`) can be shared will depend on what is
3747 similar and what is different between the configurations. Multiple MACHINE
3748 targets can share the same (:term:`TMPDIR`) as long as the rest of the
3749 configuration is the same, multiple DISTRO settings would need separate
3750 (:term:`TMPDIR`) directories.
3751
3752 For example, consider a scenario with two different multiconfigs for the same
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003753 :term:`MACHINE`: "qemux86" built
3754 for two distributions such as "poky" and "poky-lsb". In this case,
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003755 you would need to use the different :term:`TMPDIR`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003756
3757 Here is an example showing the minimal statements needed in a
3758 configuration file for a "qemux86" target whose temporary build
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003759 directory is ``tmpmultix86``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003760
3761 MACHINE = "qemux86"
3762 TMPDIR = "${TOPDIR}/tmpmultix86"
3763
3764 The location for these multiconfig configuration files is specific.
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05003765 They must reside in the current :term:`Build Directory` in a sub-directory of
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003766 ``conf`` named ``multiconfig`` or within a layer's ``conf`` directory
3767 under a directory named ``multiconfig``. Following is an example that defines
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003768 two configuration files for the "x86" and "arm" multiconfigs:
3769
3770 .. image:: figures/multiconfig_files.png
3771 :align: center
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05003772 :width: 50%
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003773
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05003774 The usual :term:`BBPATH` search path is used to locate multiconfig files in
3775 a similar way to other conf files.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003776
3777- *Add the BitBake Multi-configuration Variable to the Local
3778 Configuration File*: Use the
3779 :term:`BBMULTICONFIG`
3780 variable in your ``conf/local.conf`` configuration file to specify
3781 each multiconfig. Continuing with the example from the previous
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003782 figure, the :term:`BBMULTICONFIG` variable needs to enable two
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003783 multiconfigs: "x86" and "arm" by specifying each configuration file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003784
3785 BBMULTICONFIG = "x86 arm"
3786
3787 .. note::
3788
3789 A "default" configuration already exists by definition. This
3790 configuration is named: "" (i.e. empty string) and is defined by
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003791 the variables coming from your ``local.conf``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003792 file. Consequently, the previous example actually adds two
3793 additional configurations to your build: "arm" and "x86" along
3794 with "".
3795
3796- *Launch BitBake*: Use the following BitBake command form to launch
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003797 the multiple configuration build::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003798
3799 $ bitbake [mc:multiconfigname:]target [[[mc:multiconfigname:]target] ... ]
3800
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003801 For the example in this section, the following command applies::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003802
3803 $ bitbake mc:x86:core-image-minimal mc:arm:core-image-sato mc::core-image-base
3804
3805 The previous BitBake command builds a ``core-image-minimal`` image
3806 that is configured through the ``x86.conf`` configuration file, a
3807 ``core-image-sato`` image that is configured through the ``arm.conf``
3808 configuration file and a ``core-image-base`` that is configured
3809 through your ``local.conf`` configuration file.
3810
3811.. note::
3812
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003813 Support for multiple configuration builds in the Yocto Project &DISTRO;
3814 (&DISTRO_NAME;) Release does not include Shared State (sstate)
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003815 optimizations. Consequently, if a build uses the same object twice
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05003816 in, for example, two different :term:`TMPDIR`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003817 directories, the build either loads from an existing sstate cache for
3818 that build at the start or builds the object fresh.
3819
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003820Enabling Multiple Configuration Build Dependencies
3821~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
3822
3823Sometimes dependencies can exist between targets (multiconfigs) in a
3824multiple configuration build. For example, suppose that in order to
3825build a ``core-image-sato`` image for an "x86" multiconfig, the root
3826filesystem of an "arm" multiconfig must exist. This dependency is
3827essentially that the
3828:ref:`ref-tasks-image` task in the
3829``core-image-sato`` recipe depends on the completion of the
3830:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task of the
3831``core-image-minimal`` recipe.
3832
3833To enable dependencies in a multiple configuration build, you must
3834declare the dependencies in the recipe using the following statement
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003835form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003836
3837 task_or_package[mcdepends] = "mc:from_multiconfig:to_multiconfig:recipe_name:task_on_which_to_depend"
3838
3839To better show how to use this statement, consider the example scenario
3840from the first paragraph of this section. The following statement needs
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003841to be added to the recipe that builds the ``core-image-sato`` image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003842
3843 do_image[mcdepends] = "mc:x86:arm:core-image-minimal:do_rootfs"
3844
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05003845In this example, the `from_multiconfig` is "x86". The `to_multiconfig` is "arm". The
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003846task on which the :ref:`ref-tasks-image` task in the recipe depends is the
3847:ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task from the ``core-image-minimal`` recipe associated
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003848with the "arm" multiconfig.
3849
3850Once you set up this dependency, you can build the "x86" multiconfig
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003851using a BitBake command as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003852
3853 $ bitbake mc:x86:core-image-sato
3854
3855This command executes all the tasks needed to create the
3856``core-image-sato`` image for the "x86" multiconfig. Because of the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003857dependency, BitBake also executes through the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task for the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003858"arm" multiconfig build.
3859
3860Having a recipe depend on the root filesystem of another build might not
3861seem that useful. Consider this change to the statement in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05003862``core-image-sato`` recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003863
3864 do_image[mcdepends] = "mc:x86:arm:core-image-minimal:do_image"
3865
3866In this case, BitBake must
3867create the ``core-image-minimal`` image for the "arm" build since the
3868"x86" build depends on it.
3869
3870Because "x86" and "arm" are enabled for multiple configuration builds
3871and have separate configuration files, BitBake places the artifacts for
3872each build in the respective temporary build directories (i.e.
3873:term:`TMPDIR`).
3874
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003875Building an Initial RAM Filesystem (Initramfs) Image
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003876----------------------------------------------------
3877
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003878An initial RAM filesystem (:term:`Initramfs`) image provides a temporary root
3879filesystem used for early system initialization, typically providing tools and
3880loading modules needed to locate and mount the final root filesystem.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003881
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003882Follow these steps to create an :term:`Initramfs` image:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003883
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -050038841. *Create the Initramfs Image Recipe:* You can reference the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003885 ``core-image-minimal-initramfs.bb`` recipe found in the
3886 ``meta/recipes-core`` directory of the :term:`Source Directory`
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003887 as an example from which to work.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003888
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -050038892. *Decide if You Need to Bundle the Initramfs Image Into the Kernel
3890 Image:* If you want the :term:`Initramfs` image that is built to be bundled
3891 in with the kernel image, set the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE`
3892 variable to ``"1"`` in your ``local.conf`` configuration file and set the
3893 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` variable in the recipe that builds the kernel image.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003894
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003895 Setting the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` flag causes the :term:`Initramfs`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003896 image to be unpacked into the ``${B}/usr/`` directory. The unpacked
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003897 :term:`Initramfs` image is then passed to the kernel's ``Makefile`` using the
3898 :term:`CONFIG_INITRAMFS_SOURCE` variable, allowing the :term:`Initramfs`
3899 image to be built into the kernel normally.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003900
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -050039013. *Optionally Add Items to the Initramfs Image Through the Initramfs
3902 Image Recipe:* If you add items to the :term:`Initramfs` image by way of its
3903 recipe, you should use :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` rather than
3904 :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`. :term:`PACKAGE_INSTALL` gives more direct control of
3905 what is added to the image as compared to the defaults you might not
3906 necessarily want that are set by the :ref:`image <ref-classes-image>`
3907 or :ref:`core-image <ref-classes-core-image>` classes.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003908
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -050039094. *Build the Kernel Image and the Initramfs Image:* Build your kernel
3910 image using BitBake. Because the :term:`Initramfs` image recipe is a
3911 dependency of the kernel image, the :term:`Initramfs` image is built as well
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003912 and bundled with the kernel image if you used the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003913 :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE_BUNDLE` variable described earlier.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003914
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003915Bundling an Initramfs Image From a Separate Multiconfig
3916~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
3917
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003918There may be a case where we want to build an :term:`Initramfs` image which does not
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003919inherit the same distro policy as our main image, for example, we may want
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003920our main image to use ``TCLIBC="glibc"``, but to use ``TCLIBC="musl"`` in our :term:`Initramfs`
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003921image to keep a smaller footprint. However, by performing the steps mentioned
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003922above the :term:`Initramfs` image will inherit ``TCLIBC="glibc"`` without allowing us
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003923to override it.
3924
3925To achieve this, you need to perform some additional steps:
3926
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -050039271. *Create a multiconfig for your Initramfs image:* You can perform the steps
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003928 on ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:building images for multiple targets using multiple configurations`" to create a separate multiconfig.
3929 For the sake of simplicity let's assume such multiconfig is called: ``initramfscfg.conf`` and
3930 contains the variables::
3931
3932 TMPDIR="${TOPDIR}/tmp-initramfscfg"
3933 TCLIBC="musl"
3934
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -050039352. *Set additional Initramfs variables on your main configuration:*
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003936 Additionally, on your main configuration (``local.conf``) you need to set the
3937 variables::
3938
3939 INITRAMFS_MULTICONFIG = "initramfscfg"
3940 INITRAMFS_DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE = "${TOPDIR}/tmp-initramfscfg/deploy/images/${MACHINE}"
3941
3942 The variables :term:`INITRAMFS_MULTICONFIG` and :term:`INITRAMFS_DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`
3943 are used to create a multiconfig dependency from the kernel to the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE`
3944 to be built coming from the ``initramfscfg`` multiconfig, and to let the
3945 buildsystem know where the :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` will be located.
3946
3947 Building a system with such configuration will build the kernel using the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003948 main configuration but the :ref:`ref-tasks-bundle_initramfs` task will grab the
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003949 selected :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE` from :term:`INITRAMFS_DEPLOY_DIR_IMAGE`
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05003950 instead, resulting in a musl based :term:`Initramfs` image bundled in the kernel
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00003951 but a glibc based main image.
3952
3953 The same is applicable to avoid inheriting :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` on :term:`INITRAMFS_IMAGE`
3954 or to build a different :term:`DISTRO` for it such as ``poky-tiny``.
3955
3956
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003957Building a Tiny System
3958----------------------
3959
3960Very small distributions have some significant advantages such as
3961requiring less on-die or in-package memory (cheaper), better performance
3962through efficient cache usage, lower power requirements due to less
3963memory, faster boot times, and reduced development overhead. Some
3964real-world examples where a very small distribution gives you distinct
3965advantages are digital cameras, medical devices, and small headless
3966systems.
3967
3968This section presents information that shows you how you can trim your
3969distribution to even smaller sizes than the ``poky-tiny`` distribution,
3970which is around 5 Mbytes, that can be built out-of-the-box using the
3971Yocto Project.
3972
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003973Tiny System Overview
3974~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
3975
3976The following list presents the overall steps you need to consider and
3977perform to create distributions with smaller root filesystems, achieve
3978faster boot times, maintain your critical functionality, and avoid
3979initial RAM disks:
3980
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003981- :ref:`Determine your goals and guiding principles
3982 <dev-manual/common-tasks:goals and guiding principles>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003983
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003984- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:understand what contributes to your image size`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003985
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003986- :ref:`Reduce the size of the root filesystem
3987 <dev-manual/common-tasks:trim the root filesystem>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003988
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003989- :ref:`Reduce the size of the kernel <dev-manual/common-tasks:trim the kernel>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003990
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003991- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:remove package management requirements`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003992
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003993- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:look for other ways to minimize size`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003994
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05003995- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:iterate on the process`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05003996
3997Goals and Guiding Principles
3998~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
3999
4000Before you can reach your destination, you need to know where you are
4001going. Here is an example list that you can use as a guide when creating
4002very small distributions:
4003
4004- Determine how much space you need (e.g. a kernel that is 1 Mbyte or
4005 less and a root filesystem that is 3 Mbytes or less).
4006
4007- Find the areas that are currently taking 90% of the space and
4008 concentrate on reducing those areas.
4009
4010- Do not create any difficult "hacks" to achieve your goals.
4011
4012- Leverage the device-specific options.
4013
4014- Work in a separate layer so that you keep changes isolated. For
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05004015 information on how to create layers, see the
4016 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:understanding and creating layers`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004017
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004018Understand What Contributes to Your Image Size
4019~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4020
4021It is easiest to have something to start with when creating your own
4022distribution. You can use the Yocto Project out-of-the-box to create the
4023``poky-tiny`` distribution. Ultimately, you will want to make changes in
4024your own distribution that are likely modeled after ``poky-tiny``.
4025
4026.. note::
4027
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004028 To use ``poky-tiny`` in your build, set the :term:`DISTRO` variable in your
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004029 ``local.conf`` file to "poky-tiny" as described in the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06004030 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:creating your own distribution`"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004031 section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004032
4033Understanding some memory concepts will help you reduce the system size.
4034Memory consists of static, dynamic, and temporary memory. Static memory
4035is the TEXT (code), DATA (initialized data in the code), and BSS
4036(uninitialized data) sections. Dynamic memory represents memory that is
4037allocated at runtime: stacks, hash tables, and so forth. Temporary
4038memory is recovered after the boot process. This memory consists of
4039memory used for decompressing the kernel and for the ``__init__``
4040functions.
4041
4042To help you see where you currently are with kernel and root filesystem
4043sizes, you can use two tools found in the :term:`Source Directory`
4044in the
4045``scripts/tiny/`` directory:
4046
4047- ``ksize.py``: Reports component sizes for the kernel build objects.
4048
4049- ``dirsize.py``: Reports component sizes for the root filesystem.
4050
4051This next tool and command help you organize configuration fragments and
4052view file dependencies in a human-readable form:
4053
4054- ``merge_config.sh``: Helps you manage configuration files and
4055 fragments within the kernel. With this tool, you can merge individual
4056 configuration fragments together. The tool allows you to make
4057 overrides and warns you of any missing configuration options. The
4058 tool is ideal for allowing you to iterate on configurations, create
4059 minimal configurations, and create configuration files for different
4060 machines without having to duplicate your process.
4061
4062 The ``merge_config.sh`` script is part of the Linux Yocto kernel Git
4063 repositories (i.e. ``linux-yocto-3.14``, ``linux-yocto-3.10``,
4064 ``linux-yocto-3.8``, and so forth) in the ``scripts/kconfig``
4065 directory.
4066
4067 For more information on configuration fragments, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06004068 ":ref:`kernel-dev/common:creating configuration fragments`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004069 section in the Yocto Project Linux Kernel Development Manual.
4070
4071- ``bitbake -u taskexp -g bitbake_target``: Using the BitBake command
4072 with these options brings up a Dependency Explorer from which you can
4073 view file dependencies. Understanding these dependencies allows you
4074 to make informed decisions when cutting out various pieces of the
4075 kernel and root filesystem.
4076
4077Trim the Root Filesystem
4078~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4079
4080The root filesystem is made up of packages for booting, libraries, and
4081applications. To change things, you can configure how the packaging
4082happens, which changes the way you build them. You can also modify the
4083filesystem itself or select a different filesystem.
4084
4085First, find out what is hogging your root filesystem by running the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004086``dirsize.py`` script from your root directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004087
4088 $ cd root-directory-of-image
4089 $ dirsize.py 100000 > dirsize-100k.log
4090 $ cat dirsize-100k.log
4091
4092You can apply a filter to the script to ignore files
4093under a certain size. The previous example filters out any files below
4094100 Kbytes. The sizes reported by the tool are uncompressed, and thus
4095will be smaller by a relatively constant factor in a compressed root
4096filesystem. When you examine your log file, you can focus on areas of
4097the root filesystem that take up large amounts of memory.
4098
4099You need to be sure that what you eliminate does not cripple the
4100functionality you need. One way to see how packages relate to each other
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004101is by using the Dependency Explorer UI with the BitBake command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004102
4103 $ cd image-directory
4104 $ bitbake -u taskexp -g image
4105
4106Use the interface to
4107select potential packages you wish to eliminate and see their dependency
4108relationships.
4109
4110When deciding how to reduce the size, get rid of packages that result in
4111minimal impact on the feature set. For example, you might not need a VGA
4112display. Or, you might be able to get by with ``devtmpfs`` and ``mdev``
4113instead of ``udev``.
4114
4115Use your ``local.conf`` file to make changes. For example, to eliminate
4116``udev`` and ``glib``, set the following in the local configuration
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004117file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004118
4119 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = ""
4120
4121Finally, you should consider exactly the type of root filesystem you
4122need to meet your needs while also reducing its size. For example,
4123consider ``cramfs``, ``squashfs``, ``ubifs``, ``ext2``, or an
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05004124:term:`Initramfs` using ``initramfs``. Be aware that ``ext3`` requires a 1
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004125Mbyte journal. If you are okay with running read-only, you do not need
4126this journal.
4127
4128.. note::
4129
4130 After each round of elimination, you need to rebuild your system and
4131 then use the tools to see the effects of your reductions.
4132
4133Trim the Kernel
4134~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4135
4136The kernel is built by including policies for hardware-independent
4137aspects. What subsystems do you enable? For what architecture are you
4138building? Which drivers do you build by default?
4139
4140.. note::
4141
4142 You can modify the kernel source if you want to help with boot time.
4143
4144Run the ``ksize.py`` script from the top-level Linux build directory to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004145get an idea of what is making up the kernel::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004146
4147 $ cd top-level-linux-build-directory
4148 $ ksize.py > ksize.log
4149 $ cat ksize.log
4150
4151When you examine the log, you will see how much space is taken up with
4152the built-in ``.o`` files for drivers, networking, core kernel files,
4153filesystem, sound, and so forth. The sizes reported by the tool are
4154uncompressed, and thus will be smaller by a relatively constant factor
4155in a compressed kernel image. Look to reduce the areas that are large
4156and taking up around the "90% rule."
4157
4158To examine, or drill down, into any particular area, use the ``-d``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004159option with the script::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004160
4161 $ ksize.py -d > ksize.log
4162
4163Using this option
4164breaks out the individual file information for each area of the kernel
4165(e.g. drivers, networking, and so forth).
4166
4167Use your log file to see what you can eliminate from the kernel based on
4168features you can let go. For example, if you are not going to need
4169sound, you do not need any drivers that support sound.
4170
4171After figuring out what to eliminate, you need to reconfigure the kernel
4172to reflect those changes during the next build. You could run
4173``menuconfig`` and make all your changes at once. However, that makes it
4174difficult to see the effects of your individual eliminations and also
4175makes it difficult to replicate the changes for perhaps another target
4176device. A better method is to start with no configurations using
4177``allnoconfig``, create configuration fragments for individual changes,
4178and then manage the fragments into a single configuration file using
4179``merge_config.sh``. The tool makes it easy for you to iterate using the
4180configuration change and build cycle.
4181
4182Each time you make configuration changes, you need to rebuild the kernel
4183and check to see what impact your changes had on the overall size.
4184
4185Remove Package Management Requirements
4186~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4187
4188Packaging requirements add size to the image. One way to reduce the size
4189of the image is to remove all the packaging requirements from the image.
4190This reduction includes both removing the package manager and its unique
4191dependencies as well as removing the package management data itself.
4192
4193To eliminate all the packaging requirements for an image, be sure that
4194"package-management" is not part of your
4195:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`
4196statement for the image. When you remove this feature, you are removing
4197the package manager as well as its dependencies from the root
4198filesystem.
4199
4200Look for Other Ways to Minimize Size
4201~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4202
4203Depending on your particular circumstances, other areas that you can
4204trim likely exist. The key to finding these areas is through tools and
4205methods described here combined with experimentation and iteration. Here
4206are a couple of areas to experiment with:
4207
4208- ``glibc``: In general, follow this process:
4209
4210 1. Remove ``glibc`` features from
4211 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
4212 that you think you do not need.
4213
4214 2. Build your distribution.
4215
4216 3. If the build fails due to missing symbols in a package, determine
4217 if you can reconfigure the package to not need those features. For
4218 example, change the configuration to not support wide character
4219 support as is done for ``ncurses``. Or, if support for those
4220 characters is needed, determine what ``glibc`` features provide
4221 the support and restore the configuration.
4222
4223 4. Rebuild and repeat the process.
4224
4225- ``busybox``: For BusyBox, use a process similar as described for
4226 ``glibc``. A difference is you will need to boot the resulting system
4227 to see if you are able to do everything you expect from the running
4228 system. You need to be sure to integrate configuration fragments into
4229 Busybox because BusyBox handles its own core features and then allows
4230 you to add configuration fragments on top.
4231
4232Iterate on the Process
4233~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4234
4235If you have not reached your goals on system size, you need to iterate
4236on the process. The process is the same. Use the tools and see just what
4237is taking up 90% of the root filesystem and the kernel. Decide what you
4238can eliminate without limiting your device beyond what you need.
4239
4240Depending on your system, a good place to look might be Busybox, which
4241provides a stripped down version of Unix tools in a single, executable
4242file. You might be able to drop virtual terminal services or perhaps
4243ipv6.
4244
4245Building Images for More than One Machine
4246-----------------------------------------
4247
4248A common scenario developers face is creating images for several
4249different machines that use the same software environment. In this
4250situation, it is tempting to set the tunings and optimization flags for
4251each build specifically for the targeted hardware (i.e. "maxing out" the
4252tunings). Doing so can considerably add to build times and package feed
4253maintenance collectively for the machines. For example, selecting tunes
4254that are extremely specific to a CPU core used in a system might enable
4255some micro optimizations in GCC for that particular system but would
4256otherwise not gain you much of a performance difference across the other
4257systems as compared to using a more general tuning across all the builds
4258(e.g. setting :term:`DEFAULTTUNE`
4259specifically for each machine's build). Rather than "max out" each
4260build's tunings, you can take steps that cause the OpenEmbedded build
4261system to reuse software across the various machines where it makes
4262sense.
4263
4264If build speed and package feed maintenance are considerations, you
4265should consider the points in this section that can help you optimize
4266your tunings to best consider build times and package feed maintenance.
4267
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05004268- *Share the :term:`Build Directory`:* If at all possible, share the
4269 :term:`TMPDIR` across builds. The Yocto Project supports switching between
4270 different :term:`MACHINE` values in the same :term:`TMPDIR`. This practice
4271 is well supported and regularly used by developers when building for
4272 multiple machines. When you use the same :term:`TMPDIR` for multiple
4273 machine builds, the OpenEmbedded build system can reuse the existing native
4274 and often cross-recipes for multiple machines. Thus, build time decreases.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004275
4276 .. note::
4277
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004278 If :term:`DISTRO` settings change or fundamental configuration settings
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004279 such as the filesystem layout, you need to work with a clean :term:`TMPDIR`.
4280 Sharing :term:`TMPDIR` under these circumstances might work but since it is
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04004281 not guaranteed, you should use a clean :term:`TMPDIR`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004282
4283- *Enable the Appropriate Package Architecture:* By default, the
4284 OpenEmbedded build system enables three levels of package
4285 architectures: "all", "tune" or "package", and "machine". Any given
4286 recipe usually selects one of these package architectures (types) for
4287 its output. Depending for what a given recipe creates packages,
4288 making sure you enable the appropriate package architecture can
4289 directly impact the build time.
4290
4291 A recipe that just generates scripts can enable "all" architecture
4292 because there are no binaries to build. To specifically enable "all"
4293 architecture, be sure your recipe inherits the
4294 :ref:`allarch <ref-classes-allarch>` class.
4295 This class is useful for "all" architectures because it configures
4296 many variables so packages can be used across multiple architectures.
4297
4298 If your recipe needs to generate packages that are machine-specific
4299 or when one of the build or runtime dependencies is already
4300 machine-architecture dependent, which makes your recipe also
4301 machine-architecture dependent, make sure your recipe enables the
4302 "machine" package architecture through the
4303 :term:`MACHINE_ARCH`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004304 variable::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004305
4306 PACKAGE_ARCH = "${MACHINE_ARCH}"
4307
4308 When you do not
4309 specifically enable a package architecture through the
4310 :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH`, The
4311 OpenEmbedded build system defaults to the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004312 :term:`TUNE_PKGARCH` setting::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004313
4314 PACKAGE_ARCH = "${TUNE_PKGARCH}"
4315
4316- *Choose a Generic Tuning File if Possible:* Some tunes are more
4317 generic and can run on multiple targets (e.g. an ``armv5`` set of
4318 packages could run on ``armv6`` and ``armv7`` processors in most
4319 cases). Similarly, ``i486`` binaries could work on ``i586`` and
4320 higher processors. You should realize, however, that advances on
4321 newer processor versions would not be used.
4322
4323 If you select the same tune for several different machines, the
4324 OpenEmbedded build system reuses software previously built, thus
4325 speeding up the overall build time. Realize that even though a new
4326 sysroot for each machine is generated, the software is not recompiled
4327 and only one package feed exists.
4328
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004329- *Manage Granular Level Packaging:* Sometimes there are cases where
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004330 injecting another level of package architecture beyond the three
4331 higher levels noted earlier can be useful. For example, consider how
4332 NXP (formerly Freescale) allows for the easy reuse of binary packages
4333 in their layer
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06004334 :yocto_git:`meta-freescale </meta-freescale/>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004335 In this example, the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06004336 :yocto_git:`fsl-dynamic-packagearch </meta-freescale/tree/classes/fsl-dynamic-packagearch.bbclass>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004337 class shares GPU packages for i.MX53 boards because all boards share
4338 the AMD GPU. The i.MX6-based boards can do the same because all
4339 boards share the Vivante GPU. This class inspects the BitBake
4340 datastore to identify if the package provides or depends on one of
4341 the sub-architecture values. If so, the class sets the
4342 :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` value
4343 based on the ``MACHINE_SUBARCH`` value. If the package does not
4344 provide or depend on one of the sub-architecture values but it
4345 matches a value in the machine-specific filter, it sets
4346 :term:`MACHINE_ARCH`. This
4347 behavior reduces the number of packages built and saves build time by
4348 reusing binaries.
4349
4350- *Use Tools to Debug Issues:* Sometimes you can run into situations
4351 where software is being rebuilt when you think it should not be. For
4352 example, the OpenEmbedded build system might not be using shared
4353 state between machines when you think it should be. These types of
4354 situations are usually due to references to machine-specific
4355 variables such as :term:`MACHINE`,
4356 :term:`SERIAL_CONSOLES`,
4357 :term:`XSERVER`,
4358 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES`,
4359 and so forth in code that is supposed to only be tune-specific or
4360 when the recipe depends
4361 (:term:`DEPENDS`,
4362 :term:`RDEPENDS`,
4363 :term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
4364 :term:`RSUGGESTS`, and so forth)
4365 on some other recipe that already has
4366 :term:`PACKAGE_ARCH` defined
4367 as "${MACHINE_ARCH}".
4368
4369 .. note::
4370
4371 Patches to fix any issues identified are most welcome as these
4372 issues occasionally do occur.
4373
4374 For such cases, you can use some tools to help you sort out the
4375 situation:
4376
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004377 - ``state-diff-machines.sh``*:* You can find this tool in the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004378 ``scripts`` directory of the Source Repositories. See the comments
4379 in the script for information on how to use the tool.
4380
4381 - *BitBake's "-S printdiff" Option:* Using this option causes
4382 BitBake to try to establish the closest signature match it can
4383 (e.g. in the shared state cache) and then run ``bitbake-diffsigs``
4384 over the matches to determine the stamps and delta where these two
4385 stamp trees diverge.
4386
4387Building Software from an External Source
4388-----------------------------------------
4389
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05004390By default, the OpenEmbedded build system uses the :term:`Build Directory`
4391when building source code. The build process involves fetching the source
4392files, unpacking them, and then patching them if necessary before the build
4393takes place.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004394
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004395There are situations where you might want to build software from source
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004396files that are external to and thus outside of the OpenEmbedded build
4397system. For example, suppose you have a project that includes a new BSP
4398with a heavily customized kernel. And, you want to minimize exposing the
4399build system to the development team so that they can focus on their
4400project and maintain everyone's workflow as much as possible. In this
4401case, you want a kernel source directory on the development machine
4402where the development occurs. You want the recipe's
4403:term:`SRC_URI` variable to point to
4404the external directory and use it as is, not copy it.
4405
4406To build from software that comes from an external source, all you need
4407to do is inherit the
4408:ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>` class
4409and then set the
4410:term:`EXTERNALSRC` variable to
4411point to your external source code. Here are the statements to put in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004412your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004413
4414 INHERIT += "externalsrc"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004415 EXTERNALSRC:pn-myrecipe = "path-to-your-source-tree"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004416
4417This next example shows how to accomplish the same thing by setting
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004418:term:`EXTERNALSRC` in the recipe itself or in the recipe's append file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004419
4420 EXTERNALSRC = "path"
4421 EXTERNALSRC_BUILD = "path"
4422
4423.. note::
4424
4425 In order for these settings to take effect, you must globally or
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004426 locally inherit the :ref:`externalsrc <ref-classes-externalsrc>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004427 class.
4428
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00004429By default, :ref:`ref-classes-externalsrc` builds the source code in a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004430directory separate from the external source directory as specified by
4431:term:`EXTERNALSRC`. If you need
4432to have the source built in the same directory in which it resides, or
4433some other nominated directory, you can set
4434:term:`EXTERNALSRC_BUILD`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004435to point to that directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004436
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004437 EXTERNALSRC_BUILD:pn-myrecipe = "path-to-your-source-tree"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004438
4439Replicating a Build Offline
4440---------------------------
4441
4442It can be useful to take a "snapshot" of upstream sources used in a
4443build and then use that "snapshot" later to replicate the build offline.
4444To do so, you need to first prepare and populate your downloads
4445directory your "snapshot" of files. Once your downloads directory is
4446ready, you can use it at any time and from any machine to replicate your
4447build.
4448
4449Follow these steps to populate your Downloads directory:
4450
44511. *Create a Clean Downloads Directory:* Start with an empty downloads
4452 directory (:term:`DL_DIR`). You
4453 start with an empty downloads directory by either removing the files
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004454 in the existing directory or by setting :term:`DL_DIR` to point to either
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004455 an empty location or one that does not yet exist.
4456
44572. *Generate Tarballs of the Source Git Repositories:* Edit your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004458 ``local.conf`` configuration file as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004459
4460 DL_DIR = "/home/your-download-dir/"
4461 BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1"
4462
4463 During
4464 the fetch process in the next step, BitBake gathers the source files
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004465 and creates tarballs in the directory pointed to by :term:`DL_DIR`. See
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004466 the
4467 :term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS`
4468 variable for more information.
4469
44703. *Populate Your Downloads Directory Without Building:* Use BitBake to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004471 fetch your sources but inhibit the build::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004472
4473 $ bitbake target --runonly=fetch
4474
4475 The downloads directory (i.e. ``${DL_DIR}``) now has
4476 a "snapshot" of the source files in the form of tarballs, which can
4477 be used for the build.
4478
44794. *Optionally Remove Any Git or other SCM Subdirectories From the
4480 Downloads Directory:* If you want, you can clean up your downloads
4481 directory by removing any Git or other Source Control Management
4482 (SCM) subdirectories such as ``${DL_DIR}/git2/*``. The tarballs
4483 already contain these subdirectories.
4484
4485Once your downloads directory has everything it needs regarding source
4486files, you can create your "own-mirror" and build your target.
4487Understand that you can use the files to build the target offline from
4488any machine and at any time.
4489
4490Follow these steps to build your target using the files in the downloads
4491directory:
4492
44931. *Using Local Files Only:* Inside your ``local.conf`` file, add the
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004494 :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_URL` variable, inherit the
4495 :ref:`own-mirrors <ref-classes-own-mirrors>` class, and use the
4496 :term:`BB_NO_NETWORK` variable to your ``local.conf``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004497 ::
4498
4499 SOURCE_MIRROR_URL ?= "file:///home/your-download-dir/"
4500 INHERIT += "own-mirrors"
4501 BB_NO_NETWORK = "1"
4502
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004503 The :term:`SOURCE_MIRROR_URL` and :ref:`own-mirrors <ref-classes-own-mirrors>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004504 class set up the system to use the downloads directory as your "own
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004505 mirror". Using the :term:`BB_NO_NETWORK` variable makes sure that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004506 BitBake's fetching process in step 3 stays local, which means files
4507 from your "own-mirror" are used.
4508
45092. *Start With a Clean Build:* You can start with a clean build by
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05004510 removing the ``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}`` directory or using a new
4511 :term:`Build Directory`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004512
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050045133. *Build Your Target:* Use BitBake to build your target::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004514
4515 $ bitbake target
4516
4517 The build completes using the known local "snapshot" of source
4518 files from your mirror. The resulting tarballs for your "snapshot" of
4519 source files are in the downloads directory.
4520
4521 .. note::
4522
4523 The offline build does not work if recipes attempt to find the
4524 latest version of software by setting
4525 :term:`SRCREV` to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004526 ``${``\ :term:`AUTOREV`\ ``}``::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004527
4528 SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}"
4529
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004530 When a recipe sets :term:`SRCREV` to
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05004531 ``${``\ :term:`AUTOREV`\ ``}``, the build system accesses the network in an
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004532 attempt to determine the latest version of software from the SCM.
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004533 Typically, recipes that use :term:`AUTOREV` are custom or modified
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004534 recipes. Recipes that reside in public repositories usually do not
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004535 use :term:`AUTOREV`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004536
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004537 If you do have recipes that use :term:`AUTOREV`, you can take steps to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004538 still use the recipes in an offline build. Do the following:
4539
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05004540 1. Use a configuration generated by enabling :ref:`build
4541 history <dev-manual/common-tasks:maintaining build output quality>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004542
4543 2. Use the ``buildhistory-collect-srcrevs`` command to collect the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004544 stored :term:`SRCREV` values from the build's history. For more
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05004545 information on collecting these values, see the
4546 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:build history package information`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004547 section.
4548
4549 3. Once you have the correct source revisions, you can modify
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05004550 those recipes to set :term:`SRCREV` to specific versions of the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004551 software.
4552
4553Speeding Up a Build
4554===================
4555
4556Build time can be an issue. By default, the build system uses simple
4557controls to try and maximize build efficiency. In general, the default
4558settings for all the following variables result in the most efficient
4559build times when dealing with single socket systems (i.e. a single CPU).
4560If you have multiple CPUs, you might try increasing the default values
4561to gain more speed. See the descriptions in the glossary for each
4562variable for more information:
4563
4564- :term:`BB_NUMBER_THREADS`:
4565 The maximum number of threads BitBake simultaneously executes.
4566
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -05004567- :term:`BB_NUMBER_PARSE_THREADS`:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004568 The number of threads BitBake uses during parsing.
4569
4570- :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE`: Extra
4571 options passed to the ``make`` command during the
4572 :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task in
4573 order to specify parallel compilation on the local build host.
4574
4575- :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST`:
4576 Extra options passed to the ``make`` command during the
4577 :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task in
4578 order to specify parallel installation on the local build host.
4579
4580As mentioned, these variables all scale to the number of processor cores
4581available on the build system. For single socket systems, this
4582auto-scaling ensures that the build system fundamentally takes advantage
4583of potential parallel operations during the build based on the build
4584machine's capabilities.
4585
4586Following are additional factors that can affect build speed:
4587
4588- File system type: The file system type that the build is being
4589 performed on can also influence performance. Using ``ext4`` is
4590 recommended as compared to ``ext2`` and ``ext3`` due to ``ext4``
4591 improved features such as extents.
4592
4593- Disabling the updating of access time using ``noatime``: The
4594 ``noatime`` mount option prevents the build system from updating file
4595 and directory access times.
4596
4597- Setting a longer commit: Using the "commit=" mount option increases
4598 the interval in seconds between disk cache writes. Changing this
4599 interval from the five second default to something longer increases
4600 the risk of data loss but decreases the need to write to the disk,
4601 thus increasing the build performance.
4602
4603- Choosing the packaging backend: Of the available packaging backends,
4604 IPK is the fastest. Additionally, selecting a singular packaging
4605 backend also helps.
4606
4607- Using ``tmpfs`` for :term:`TMPDIR`
4608 as a temporary file system: While this can help speed up the build,
4609 the benefits are limited due to the compiler using ``-pipe``. The
4610 build system goes to some lengths to avoid ``sync()`` calls into the
4611 file system on the principle that if there was a significant failure,
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05004612 the :term:`Build Directory` contents could easily be rebuilt.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004613
4614- Inheriting the
4615 :ref:`rm_work <ref-classes-rm-work>` class:
4616 Inheriting this class has shown to speed up builds due to
4617 significantly lower amounts of data stored in the data cache as well
4618 as on disk. Inheriting this class also makes cleanup of
4619 :term:`TMPDIR` faster, at the
4620 expense of being easily able to dive into the source code. File
4621 system maintainers have recommended that the fastest way to clean up
4622 large numbers of files is to reformat partitions rather than delete
4623 files due to the linear nature of partitions. This, of course,
4624 assumes you structure the disk partitions and file systems in a way
4625 that this is practical.
4626
4627Aside from the previous list, you should keep some trade offs in mind
4628that can help you speed up the build:
4629
4630- Remove items from
4631 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
4632 that you might not need.
4633
4634- Exclude debug symbols and other debug information: If you do not need
4635 these symbols and other debug information, disabling the ``*-dbg``
4636 package generation can speed up the build. You can disable this
4637 generation by setting the
4638 :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT`
4639 variable to "1".
4640
4641- Disable static library generation for recipes derived from
4642 ``autoconf`` or ``libtool``: Following is an example showing how to
4643 disable static libraries and still provide an override to handle
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004644 exceptions::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004645
4646 STATICLIBCONF = "--disable-static"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004647 STATICLIBCONF:sqlite3-native = ""
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004648 EXTRA_OECONF += "${STATICLIBCONF}"
4649
4650 .. note::
4651
4652 - Some recipes need static libraries in order to work correctly
4653 (e.g. ``pseudo-native`` needs ``sqlite3-native``). Overrides,
4654 as in the previous example, account for these kinds of
4655 exceptions.
4656
4657 - Some packages have packaging code that assumes the presence of
4658 the static libraries. If so, you might need to exclude them as
4659 well.
4660
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004661Working With Libraries
4662======================
4663
4664Libraries are an integral part of your system. This section describes
4665some common practices you might find helpful when working with libraries
4666to build your system:
4667
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05004668- :ref:`How to include static library files
4669 <dev-manual/common-tasks:including static library files>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004670
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05004671- :ref:`How to use the Multilib feature to combine multiple versions of
4672 library files into a single image
4673 <dev-manual/common-tasks:combining multiple versions of library files into one image>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004674
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05004675- :ref:`How to install multiple versions of the same library in parallel on
4676 the same system
4677 <dev-manual/common-tasks:installing multiple versions of the same library>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004678
4679Including Static Library Files
4680------------------------------
4681
4682If you are building a library and the library offers static linking, you
4683can control which static library files (``*.a`` files) get included in
4684the built library.
4685
4686The :term:`PACKAGES` and
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004687:term:`FILES:* <FILES>` variables in the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004688``meta/conf/bitbake.conf`` configuration file define how files installed
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05004689by the :ref:`ref-tasks-install` task are packaged. By default, the :term:`PACKAGES`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004690variable includes ``${PN}-staticdev``, which represents all static
4691library files.
4692
4693.. note::
4694
4695 Some previously released versions of the Yocto Project defined the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004696 static library files through ``${PN}-dev``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004697
4698Following is part of the BitBake configuration file, where you can see
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004699how the static library files are defined::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004700
4701 PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN ?= ""
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004702 PACKAGES = "${PN}-src ${PN}-dbg ${PN}-staticdev ${PN}-dev ${PN}-doc ${PN}-locale ${PACKAGE_BEFORE_PN} ${PN}"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004703 PACKAGES_DYNAMIC = "^${PN}-locale-.*"
4704 FILES = ""
4705
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004706 FILES:${PN} = "${bindir}/* ${sbindir}/* ${libexecdir}/* ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBS} \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004707 ${sysconfdir} ${sharedstatedir} ${localstatedir} \
4708 ${base_bindir}/* ${base_sbindir}/* \
4709 ${base_libdir}/*${SOLIBS} \
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004710 ${base_prefix}/lib/udev ${prefix}/lib/udev \
4711 ${base_libdir}/udev ${libdir}/udev \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004712 ${datadir}/${BPN} ${libdir}/${BPN}/* \
4713 ${datadir}/pixmaps ${datadir}/applications \
4714 ${datadir}/idl ${datadir}/omf ${datadir}/sounds \
4715 ${libdir}/bonobo/servers"
4716
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004717 FILES:${PN}-bin = "${bindir}/* ${sbindir}/*"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004718
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004719 FILES:${PN}-doc = "${docdir} ${mandir} ${infodir} ${datadir}/gtk-doc \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004720 ${datadir}/gnome/help"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004721 SECTION:${PN}-doc = "doc"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004722
4723 FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?= "${base_libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV}"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004724 FILES:${PN}-dev = "${includedir} ${FILES_SOLIBSDEV} ${libdir}/*.la \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004725 ${libdir}/*.o ${libdir}/pkgconfig ${datadir}/pkgconfig \
4726 ${datadir}/aclocal ${base_libdir}/*.o \
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004727 ${libdir}/${BPN}/*.la ${base_libdir}/*.la \
4728 ${libdir}/cmake ${datadir}/cmake"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004729 SECTION:${PN}-dev = "devel"
4730 ALLOW_EMPTY:${PN}-dev = "1"
4731 RDEPENDS:${PN}-dev = "${PN} (= ${EXTENDPKGV})"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004732
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004733 FILES:${PN}-staticdev = "${libdir}/*.a ${base_libdir}/*.a ${libdir}/${BPN}/*.a"
4734 SECTION:${PN}-staticdev = "devel"
4735 RDEPENDS:${PN}-staticdev = "${PN}-dev (= ${EXTENDPKGV})"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004736
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004737Combining Multiple Versions of Library Files into One Image
4738-----------------------------------------------------------
4739
4740The build system offers the ability to build libraries with different
4741target optimizations or architecture formats and combine these together
4742into one system image. You can link different binaries in the image
4743against the different libraries as needed for specific use cases. This
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004744feature is called "Multilib".
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004745
4746An example would be where you have most of a system compiled in 32-bit
4747mode using 32-bit libraries, but you have something large, like a
4748database engine, that needs to be a 64-bit application and uses 64-bit
4749libraries. Multilib allows you to get the best of both 32-bit and 64-bit
4750libraries.
4751
4752While the Multilib feature is most commonly used for 32 and 64-bit
4753differences, the approach the build system uses facilitates different
4754target optimizations. You could compile some binaries to use one set of
4755libraries and other binaries to use a different set of libraries. The
4756libraries could differ in architecture, compiler options, or other
4757optimizations.
4758
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004759There are several examples in the ``meta-skeleton`` layer found in the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004760:term:`Source Directory`:
4761
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004762- :oe_git:`conf/multilib-example.conf </openembedded-core/tree/meta-skeleton/conf/multilib-example.conf>`
4763 configuration file.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004764
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004765- :oe_git:`conf/multilib-example2.conf </openembedded-core/tree/meta-skeleton/conf/multilib-example2.conf>`
4766 configuration file.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004767
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004768- :oe_git:`recipes-multilib/images/core-image-multilib-example.bb </openembedded-core/tree/meta-skeleton/recipes-multilib/images/core-image-multilib-example.bb>`
4769 recipe
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004770
4771Preparing to Use Multilib
4772~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4773
4774User-specific requirements drive the Multilib feature. Consequently,
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004775there is no one "out-of-the-box" configuration that would
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004776meet your needs.
4777
4778In order to enable Multilib, you first need to ensure your recipe is
4779extended to support multiple libraries. Many standard recipes are
4780already extended and support multiple libraries. You can check in the
4781``meta/conf/multilib.conf`` configuration file in the
4782:term:`Source Directory` to see how this is
4783done using the
4784:term:`BBCLASSEXTEND` variable.
4785Eventually, all recipes will be covered and this list will not be
4786needed.
4787
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004788For the most part, the :ref:`Multilib <ref-classes-multilib*>`
4789class extension works automatically to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004790extend the package name from ``${PN}`` to ``${MLPREFIX}${PN}``, where
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04004791:term:`MLPREFIX` is the particular multilib (e.g. "lib32-" or "lib64-").
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004792Standard variables such as
4793:term:`DEPENDS`,
4794:term:`RDEPENDS`,
4795:term:`RPROVIDES`,
4796:term:`RRECOMMENDS`,
4797:term:`PACKAGES`, and
4798:term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` are
4799automatically extended by the system. If you are extending any manual
4800code in the recipe, you can use the ``${MLPREFIX}`` variable to ensure
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00004801those names are extended correctly.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004802
4803Using Multilib
4804~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4805
4806After you have set up the recipes, you need to define the actual
4807combination of multiple libraries you want to build. You accomplish this
4808through your ``local.conf`` configuration file in the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05004809:term:`Build Directory`. An example configuration would be as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004810
4811 MACHINE = "qemux86-64"
4812 require conf/multilib.conf
4813 MULTILIBS = "multilib:lib32"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004814 DEFAULTTUNE:virtclass-multilib-lib32 = "x86"
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05004815 IMAGE_INSTALL:append = " lib32-glib-2.0"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004816
4817This example enables an additional library named
4818``lib32`` alongside the normal target packages. When combining these
4819"lib32" alternatives, the example uses "x86" for tuning. For information
4820on this particular tuning, see
4821``meta/conf/machine/include/ia32/arch-ia32.inc``.
4822
4823The example then includes ``lib32-glib-2.0`` in all the images, which
4824illustrates one method of including a multiple library dependency. You
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004825can use a normal image build to include this dependency, for example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004826
4827 $ bitbake core-image-sato
4828
4829You can also build Multilib packages
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004830specifically with a command like this::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004831
4832 $ bitbake lib32-glib-2.0
4833
4834Additional Implementation Details
4835~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
4836
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004837There are generic implementation details as well as details that are specific to
4838package management systems. Following are implementation details
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004839that exist regardless of the package management system:
4840
4841- The typical convention used for the class extension code as used by
4842 Multilib assumes that all package names specified in
4843 :term:`PACKAGES` that contain
4844 ``${PN}`` have ``${PN}`` at the start of the name. When that
4845 convention is not followed and ``${PN}`` appears at the middle or the
4846 end of a name, problems occur.
4847
4848- The :term:`TARGET_VENDOR`
4849 value under Multilib will be extended to "-vendormlmultilib" (e.g.
4850 "-pokymllib32" for a "lib32" Multilib with Poky). The reason for this
4851 slightly unwieldy contraction is that any "-" characters in the
4852 vendor string presently break Autoconf's ``config.sub``, and other
4853 separators are problematic for different reasons.
4854
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004855Here are the implementation details for the RPM Package Management System:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004856
4857- A unique architecture is defined for the Multilib packages, along
4858 with creating a unique deploy folder under ``tmp/deploy/rpm`` in the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05004859 :term:`Build Directory`. For example, consider ``lib32`` in a
4860 ``qemux86-64`` image. The possible architectures in the system are "all",
4861 "qemux86_64", "lib32:qemux86_64", and "lib32:x86".
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004862
4863- The ``${MLPREFIX}`` variable is stripped from ``${PN}`` during RPM
4864 packaging. The naming for a normal RPM package and a Multilib RPM
4865 package in a ``qemux86-64`` system resolves to something similar to
4866 ``bash-4.1-r2.x86_64.rpm`` and ``bash-4.1.r2.lib32_x86.rpm``,
4867 respectively.
4868
4869- When installing a Multilib image, the RPM backend first installs the
4870 base image and then installs the Multilib libraries.
4871
4872- The build system relies on RPM to resolve the identical files in the
4873 two (or more) Multilib packages.
4874
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004875Here are the implementation details for the IPK Package Management System:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004876
4877- The ``${MLPREFIX}`` is not stripped from ``${PN}`` during IPK
4878 packaging. The naming for a normal RPM package and a Multilib IPK
4879 package in a ``qemux86-64`` system resolves to something like
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05004880 ``bash_4.1-r2.x86_64.ipk`` and ``lib32-bash_4.1-rw:x86.ipk``,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004881 respectively.
4882
4883- The IPK deploy folder is not modified with ``${MLPREFIX}`` because
4884 packages with and without the Multilib feature can exist in the same
4885 folder due to the ``${PN}`` differences.
4886
4887- IPK defines a sanity check for Multilib installation using certain
4888 rules for file comparison, overridden, etc.
4889
4890Installing Multiple Versions of the Same Library
4891------------------------------------------------
4892
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07004893There are be situations where you need to install and use multiple versions
4894of the same library on the same system at the same time. This
4895almost always happens when a library API changes and you have
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004896multiple pieces of software that depend on the separate versions of the
4897library. To accommodate these situations, you can install multiple
4898versions of the same library in parallel on the same system.
4899
4900The process is straightforward as long as the libraries use proper
4901versioning. With properly versioned libraries, all you need to do to
4902individually specify the libraries is create separate, appropriately
4903named recipes where the :term:`PN` part of
4904the name includes a portion that differentiates each library version
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004905(e.g. the major part of the version number). Thus, instead of having a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004906single recipe that loads one version of a library (e.g. ``clutter``),
4907you provide multiple recipes that result in different versions of the
4908libraries you want. As an example, the following two recipes would allow
4909the two separate versions of the ``clutter`` library to co-exist on the
4910same system:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05004911
4912.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004913
4914 clutter-1.6_1.6.20.bb
4915 clutter-1.8_1.8.4.bb
4916
4917Additionally, if
4918you have other recipes that depend on a given library, you need to use
4919the :term:`DEPENDS` variable to
4920create the dependency. Continuing with the same example, if you want to
4921have a recipe depend on the 1.8 version of the ``clutter`` library, use
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05004922the following in your recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05004923
4924 DEPENDS = "clutter-1.8"
4925
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00004926Working with Pre-Built Libraries
4927================================
4928
4929Introduction
4930-------------
4931
4932Some library vendors do not release source code for their software but do
4933release pre-built binaries. When shared libraries are built, they should
4934be versioned (see `this article
4935<https://tldp.org/HOWTO/Program-Library-HOWTO/shared-libraries.html>`__
4936for some background), but sometimes this is not done.
4937
4938To summarize, a versioned library must meet two conditions:
4939
4940#. The filename must have the version appended, for example: ``libfoo.so.1.2.3``.
4941#. The library must have the ELF tag ``SONAME`` set to the major version
4942 of the library, for example: ``libfoo.so.1``. You can check this by
4943 running ``readelf -d filename | grep SONAME``.
4944
4945This section shows how to deal with both versioned and unversioned
4946pre-built libraries.
4947
4948Versioned Libraries
4949-------------------
4950
4951In this example we work with pre-built libraries for the FT4222H USB I/O chip.
4952Libraries are built for several target architecture variants and packaged in
4953an archive as follows::
4954
4955 ├── build-arm-hisiv300
4956 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4957 ├── build-arm-v5-sf
4958 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4959 ├── build-arm-v6-hf
4960 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4961 ├── build-arm-v7-hf
4962 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4963 ├── build-arm-v8
4964 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4965 ├── build-i386
4966 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4967 ├── build-i486
4968 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4969 ├── build-mips-eglibc-hf
4970 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4971 ├── build-pentium
4972 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4973 ├── build-x86_64
4974 │   └── libft4222.so.1.4.4.44
4975 ├── examples
4976 │   ├── get-version.c
4977 │   ├── i2cm.c
4978 │   ├── spim.c
4979 │   └── spis.c
4980 ├── ftd2xx.h
4981 ├── install4222.sh
4982 ├── libft4222.h
4983 ├── ReadMe.txt
4984 └── WinTypes.h
4985
4986To write a recipe to use such a library in your system:
4987
4988- The vendor will probably have a proprietary licence, so set
4989 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` in your recipe.
4990- The vendor provides a tarball containing libraries so set :term:`SRC_URI`
4991 appropriately.
4992- Set :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` so that the recipe cannot be used with an
4993 unsupported architecture. In the following example, we only support the 32
4994 and 64 bit variants of the ``x86`` architecture.
4995- As the vendor provides versioned libraries, we can use ``oe_soinstall``
4996 from :ref:`ref-classes-utils` to install the shared library and create
4997 symbolic links. If the vendor does not do this, we need to follow the
4998 non-versioned library guidelines in the next section.
4999- As the vendor likely used :term:`LDFLAGS` different from those in your Yocto
5000 Project build, disable the corresponding checks by adding ``ldflags``
5001 to :term:`INSANE_SKIP`.
5002- The vendor will typically ship release builds without debugging symbols.
5003 Avoid errors by preventing the packaging task from stripping out the symbols
5004 and adding them to a separate debug package. This is done by setting the
5005 ``INHIBIT_`` flags shown below.
5006
5007The complete recipe would look like this::
5008
5009 SUMMARY = "FTDI FT4222H Library"
5010 SECTION = "libs"
5011 LICENSE_FLAGS = "ftdi"
5012 LICENSE = "CLOSED"
5013
5014 COMPATIBLE_HOST = "(i.86|x86_64).*-linux"
5015
5016 # Sources available in a .tgz file in .zip archive
5017 # at https://ftdichip.com/wp-content/uploads/2021/01/libft4222-linux-1.4.4.44.zip
5018 # Found on https://ftdichip.com/software-examples/ft4222h-software-examples/
5019 # Since dealing with this particular type of archive is out of topic here,
5020 # we use a local link.
5021 SRC_URI = "file://libft4222-linux-${PV}.tgz"
5022
5023 S = "${WORKDIR}"
5024
5025 ARCH_DIR:x86-64 = "build-x86_64"
5026 ARCH_DIR:i586 = "build-i386"
5027 ARCH_DIR:i686 = "build-i386"
5028
5029 INSANE_SKIP:${PN} = "ldflags"
5030 INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP = "1"
5031 INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP = "1"
5032 INHIBIT_PACKAGE_DEBUG_SPLIT = "1"
5033
5034 do_install () {
5035 install -m 0755 -d ${D}${libdir}
5036 oe_soinstall ${S}/${ARCH_DIR}/libft4222.so.${PV} ${D}${libdir}
5037 install -d ${D}${includedir}
5038 install -m 0755 ${S}/*.h ${D}${includedir}
5039 }
5040
5041If the precompiled binaries are not statically linked and have dependencies on
5042other libraries, then by adding those libraries to :term:`DEPENDS`, the linking
5043can be examined and the appropriate :term:`RDEPENDS` automatically added.
5044
5045Non-Versioned Libraries
5046-----------------------
5047
5048Some Background
5049~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5050
5051Libraries in Linux systems are generally versioned so that it is possible
5052to have multiple versions of the same library installed, which eases upgrades
5053and support for older software. For example, suppose that in a versioned
5054library, an actual library is called ``libfoo.so.1.2``, a symbolic link named
5055``libfoo.so.1`` points to ``libfoo.so.1.2``, and a symbolic link named
5056``libfoo.so`` points to ``libfoo.so.1.2``. Given these conditions, when you
5057link a binary against a library, you typically provide the unversioned file
5058name (i.e. ``-lfoo`` to the linker). However, the linker follows the symbolic
5059link and actually links against the versioned filename. The unversioned symbolic
5060link is only used at development time. Consequently, the library is packaged
5061along with the headers in the development package ``${PN}-dev`` along with the
5062actual library and versioned symbolic links in ``${PN}``. Because versioned
5063libraries are far more common than unversioned libraries, the default packaging
5064rules assume versioned libraries.
5065
5066Yocto Library Packaging Overview
5067~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5068
5069It follows that packaging an unversioned library requires a bit of work in the
5070recipe. By default, ``libfoo.so`` gets packaged into ``${PN}-dev``, which
5071triggers a QA warning that a non-symlink library is in a ``-dev`` package,
5072and binaries in the same recipe link to the library in ``${PN}-dev``,
5073which triggers more QA warnings. To solve this problem, you need to package the
5074unversioned library into ``${PN}`` where it belongs. The following are the abridged
5075default :term:`FILES` variables in ``bitbake.conf``::
5076
5077 SOLIBS = ".so.*"
5078 SOLIBSDEV = ".so"
5079 FILES_${PN} = "... ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBS} ..."
5080 FILES_SOLIBSDEV ?= "... ${libdir}/lib*${SOLIBSDEV} ..."
5081 FILES_${PN}-dev = "... ${FILES_SOLIBSDEV} ..."
5082
5083:term:`SOLIBS` defines a pattern that matches real shared object libraries.
5084:term:`SOLIBSDEV` matches the development form (unversioned symlink). These two
5085variables are then used in ``FILES:${PN}`` and ``FILES:${PN}-dev``, which puts
5086the real libraries into ``${PN}`` and the unversioned symbolic link into ``${PN}-dev``.
5087To package unversioned libraries, you need to modify the variables in the recipe
5088as follows::
5089
5090 SOLIBS = ".so"
5091 FILES_SOLIBSDEV = ""
5092
5093The modifications cause the ``.so`` file to be the real library
5094and unset :term:`FILES_SOLIBSDEV` so that no libraries get packaged into
5095``${PN}-dev``. The changes are required because unless :term:`PACKAGES` is changed,
5096``${PN}-dev`` collects files before `${PN}`. ``${PN}-dev`` must not collect any of
5097the files you want in ``${PN}``.
5098
5099Finally, loadable modules, essentially unversioned libraries that are linked
5100at runtime using ``dlopen()`` instead of at build time, should generally be
5101installed in a private directory. However, if they are installed in ``${libdir}``,
5102then the modules can be treated as unversioned libraries.
5103
5104Example
5105~~~~~~~
5106
5107The example below installs an unversioned x86-64 pre-built library named
5108``libfoo.so``. The :term:`COMPATIBLE_HOST` variable limits recipes to the
5109x86-64 architecture while the :term:`INSANE_SKIP`, :term:`INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP`
5110and :term:`INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP` variables are all set as in the above
5111versioned library example. The "magic" is setting the :term:`SOLIBS` and
5112:term:`FILES_SOLIBSDEV` variables as explained above::
5113
5114 SUMMARY = "libfoo sample recipe"
5115 SECTION = "libs"
5116 LICENSE = "CLOSED"
5117
5118 SRC_URI = "file://libfoo.so"
5119
5120 COMPATIBLE_HOST = "x86_64.*-linux"
5121
5122 INSANE_SKIP:${PN} = "ldflags"
5123 INHIBIT_PACKAGE_STRIP = "1"
5124 INHIBIT_SYSROOT_STRIP = "1"
5125 SOLIBS = ".so"
5126 FILES_SOLIBSDEV = ""
5127
5128 do_install () {
5129 install -d ${D}${libdir}
5130 install -m 0755 ${WORKDIR}/libfoo.so ${D}${libdir}
5131 }
5132
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005133Using x32 psABI
5134===============
5135
5136x32 processor-specific Application Binary Interface (`x32
5137psABI <https://software.intel.com/en-us/node/628948>`__) is a native
513832-bit processor-specific ABI for Intel 64 (x86-64) architectures. An
5139ABI defines the calling conventions between functions in a processing
5140environment. The interface determines what registers are used and what
5141the sizes are for various C data types.
5142
5143Some processing environments prefer using 32-bit applications even when
5144running on Intel 64-bit platforms. Consider the i386 psABI, which is a
5145very old 32-bit ABI for Intel 64-bit platforms. The i386 psABI does not
5146provide efficient use and access of the Intel 64-bit processor
5147resources, leaving the system underutilized. Now consider the x86_64
5148psABI. This ABI is newer and uses 64-bits for data sizes and program
5149pointers. The extra bits increase the footprint size of the programs,
5150libraries, and also increases the memory and file system size
5151requirements. Executing under the x32 psABI enables user programs to
5152utilize CPU and system resources more efficiently while keeping the
5153memory footprint of the applications low. Extra bits are used for
5154registers but not for addressing mechanisms.
5155
5156The Yocto Project supports the final specifications of x32 psABI as
5157follows:
5158
5159- You can create packages and images in x32 psABI format on x86_64
5160 architecture targets.
5161
5162- You can successfully build recipes with the x32 toolchain.
5163
5164- You can create and boot ``core-image-minimal`` and
5165 ``core-image-sato`` images.
5166
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07005167- There is RPM Package Manager (RPM) support for x32 binaries.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005168
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07005169- There is support for large images.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005170
5171To use the x32 psABI, you need to edit your ``conf/local.conf``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005172configuration file as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005173
5174 MACHINE = "qemux86-64"
5175 DEFAULTTUNE = "x86-64-x32"
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05005176 baselib = "${@d.getVar('BASE_LIB:tune-' + (d.getVar('DEFAULTTUNE') \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005177 or 'INVALID')) or 'lib'}"
5178
5179Once you have set
5180up your configuration file, use BitBake to build an image that supports
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005181the x32 psABI. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005182
5183 $ bitbake core-image-sato
5184
5185Enabling GObject Introspection Support
5186======================================
5187
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005188`GObject introspection <https://gi.readthedocs.io/en/latest/>`__
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005189is the standard mechanism for accessing GObject-based software from
5190runtime environments. GObject is a feature of the GLib library that
5191provides an object framework for the GNOME desktop and related software.
5192GObject Introspection adds information to GObject that allows objects
5193created within it to be represented across different programming
5194languages. If you want to construct GStreamer pipelines using Python, or
5195control UPnP infrastructure using Javascript and GUPnP, GObject
5196introspection is the only way to do it.
5197
5198This section describes the Yocto Project support for generating and
5199packaging GObject introspection data. GObject introspection data is a
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005200description of the API provided by libraries built on top of the GLib
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005201framework, and, in particular, that framework's GObject mechanism.
5202GObject Introspection Repository (GIR) files go to ``-dev`` packages,
5203``typelib`` files go to main packages as they are packaged together with
5204libraries that are introspected.
5205
5206The data is generated when building such a library, by linking the
5207library with a small executable binary that asks the library to describe
5208itself, and then executing the binary and processing its output.
5209
5210Generating this data in a cross-compilation environment is difficult
5211because the library is produced for the target architecture, but its
5212code needs to be executed on the build host. This problem is solved with
5213the OpenEmbedded build system by running the code through QEMU, which
5214allows precisely that. Unfortunately, QEMU does not always work
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05005215perfectly as mentioned in the ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:known issues`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005216section.
5217
5218Enabling the Generation of Introspection Data
5219---------------------------------------------
5220
5221Enabling the generation of introspection data (GIR files) in your
5222library package involves the following:
5223
52241. Inherit the
5225 :ref:`gobject-introspection <ref-classes-gobject-introspection>`
5226 class.
5227
52282. Make sure introspection is not disabled anywhere in the recipe or
5229 from anything the recipe includes. Also, make sure that
5230 "gobject-introspection-data" is not in
5231 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`
5232 and that "qemu-usermode" is not in
5233 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`.
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07005234 In either of these conditions, nothing will happen.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005235
52363. Try to build the recipe. If you encounter build errors that look like
5237 something is unable to find ``.so`` libraries, check where these
5238 libraries are located in the source tree and add the following to the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005239 recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005240
5241 GIR_EXTRA_LIBS_PATH = "${B}/something/.libs"
5242
5243 .. note::
5244
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005245 See recipes in the ``oe-core`` repository that use that
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005246 :term:`GIR_EXTRA_LIBS_PATH` variable as an example.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005247
52484. Look for any other errors, which probably mean that introspection
5249 support in a package is not entirely standard, and thus breaks down
5250 in a cross-compilation environment. For such cases, custom-made fixes
5251 are needed. A good place to ask and receive help in these cases is
5252 the :ref:`Yocto Project mailing
5253 lists <resources-mailinglist>`.
5254
5255.. note::
5256
5257 Using a library that no longer builds against the latest Yocto
5258 Project release and prints introspection related errors is a good
5259 candidate for the previous procedure.
5260
5261Disabling the Generation of Introspection Data
5262----------------------------------------------
5263
5264You might find that you do not want to generate introspection data. Or,
5265perhaps QEMU does not work on your build host and target architecture
5266combination. If so, you can use either of the following methods to
5267disable GIR file generations:
5268
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005269- Add the following to your distro configuration::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005270
5271 DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED = "gobject-introspection-data"
5272
5273 Adding this statement disables generating introspection data using
5274 QEMU but will still enable building introspection tools and libraries
5275 (i.e. building them does not require the use of QEMU).
5276
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005277- Add the following to your machine configuration::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005278
5279 MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED = "qemu-usermode"
5280
5281 Adding this statement disables the use of QEMU when building packages for your
5282 machine. Currently, this feature is used only by introspection
5283 recipes and has the same effect as the previously described option.
5284
5285 .. note::
5286
5287 Future releases of the Yocto Project might have other features
5288 affected by this option.
5289
5290If you disable introspection data, you can still obtain it through other
5291means such as copying the data from a suitable sysroot, or by generating
5292it on the target hardware. The OpenEmbedded build system does not
5293currently provide specific support for these techniques.
5294
5295Testing that Introspection Works in an Image
5296--------------------------------------------
5297
5298Use the following procedure to test if generating introspection data is
5299working in an image:
5300
53011. Make sure that "gobject-introspection-data" is not in
5302 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`
5303 and that "qemu-usermode" is not in
5304 :term:`MACHINE_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`.
5305
53062. Build ``core-image-sato``.
5307
53083. Launch a Terminal and then start Python in the terminal.
5309
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050053104. Enter the following in the terminal::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005311
5312 >>> from gi.repository import GLib
5313 >>> GLib.get_host_name()
5314
53155. For something a little more advanced, enter the following see:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005316 https://python-gtk-3-tutorial.readthedocs.io/en/latest/introduction.html
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005317
5318Known Issues
5319------------
5320
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07005321Here are know issues in GObject Introspection Support:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005322
5323- ``qemu-ppc64`` immediately crashes. Consequently, you cannot build
5324 introspection data on that architecture.
5325
5326- x32 is not supported by QEMU. Consequently, introspection data is
5327 disabled.
5328
5329- musl causes transient GLib binaries to crash on assertion failures.
5330 Consequently, generating introspection data is disabled.
5331
5332- Because QEMU is not able to run the binaries correctly, introspection
5333 is disabled for some specific packages under specific architectures
5334 (e.g. ``gcr``, ``libsecret``, and ``webkit``).
5335
5336- QEMU usermode might not work properly when running 64-bit binaries
5337 under 32-bit host machines. In particular, "qemumips64" is known to
5338 not work under i686.
5339
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005340Optionally Using an External Toolchain
5341======================================
5342
5343You might want to use an external toolchain as part of your development.
5344If this is the case, the fundamental steps you need to accomplish are as
5345follows:
5346
5347- Understand where the installed toolchain resides. For cases where you
5348 need to build the external toolchain, you would need to take separate
5349 steps to build and install the toolchain.
5350
5351- Make sure you add the layer that contains the toolchain to your
5352 ``bblayers.conf`` file through the
5353 :term:`BBLAYERS` variable.
5354
5355- Set the ``EXTERNAL_TOOLCHAIN`` variable in your ``local.conf`` file
5356 to the location in which you installed the toolchain.
5357
5358A good example of an external toolchain used with the Yocto Project is
5359Mentor Graphics Sourcery G++ Toolchain. You can see information on how
5360to use that particular layer in the ``README`` file at
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005361https://github.com/MentorEmbedded/meta-sourcery/. You can find
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005362further information by reading about the
5363:term:`TCMODE` variable in the Yocto
5364Project Reference Manual's variable glossary.
5365
5366Creating Partitioned Images Using Wic
5367=====================================
5368
5369Creating an image for a particular hardware target using the
5370OpenEmbedded build system does not necessarily mean you can boot that
5371image as is on your device. Physical devices accept and boot images in
5372various ways depending on the specifics of the device. Usually,
5373information about the hardware can tell you what image format the device
5374requires. Should your device require multiple partitions on an SD card,
5375flash, or an HDD, you can use the OpenEmbedded Image Creator, Wic, to
5376create the properly partitioned image.
5377
5378The ``wic`` command generates partitioned images from existing
5379OpenEmbedded build artifacts. Image generation is driven by partitioning
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05005380commands contained in an OpenEmbedded kickstart file (``.wks``)
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005381specified either directly on the command line or as one of a selection
5382of canned kickstart files as shown with the ``wic list images`` command
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05005383in the
5384":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:generate an image using an existing kickstart file`"
5385section. When you apply the command to a given set of build artifacts, the
5386result is an image or set of images that can be directly written onto media and
5387used on a particular system.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005388
5389.. note::
5390
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005391 For a kickstart file reference, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06005392 ":ref:`ref-manual/kickstart:openembedded kickstart (\`\`.wks\`\`) reference`"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005393 Chapter in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005394
5395The ``wic`` command and the infrastructure it is based on is by
5396definition incomplete. The purpose of the command is to allow the
5397generation of customized images, and as such, was designed to be
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05005398completely extensible through a plugin interface. See the
5399":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:using the wic plugin interface`" section
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005400for information on these plugins.
5401
5402This section provides some background information on Wic, describes what
5403you need to have in place to run the tool, provides instruction on how
5404to use the Wic utility, provides information on using the Wic plugins
5405interface, and provides several examples that show how to use Wic.
5406
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005407Background
5408----------
5409
5410This section provides some background on the Wic utility. While none of
5411this information is required to use Wic, you might find it interesting.
5412
5413- The name "Wic" is derived from OpenEmbedded Image Creator (oeic). The
5414 "oe" diphthong in "oeic" was promoted to the letter "w", because
5415 "oeic" is both difficult to remember and to pronounce.
5416
5417- Wic is loosely based on the Meego Image Creator (``mic``) framework.
5418 The Wic implementation has been heavily modified to make direct use
5419 of OpenEmbedded build artifacts instead of package installation and
5420 configuration, which are already incorporated within the OpenEmbedded
5421 artifacts.
5422
5423- Wic is a completely independent standalone utility that initially
5424 provides easier-to-use and more flexible replacements for an existing
5425 functionality in OE-Core's
5426 :ref:`image-live <ref-classes-image-live>`
5427 class. The difference between Wic and those examples is that with Wic
5428 the functionality of those scripts is implemented by a
5429 general-purpose partitioning language, which is based on Redhat
5430 kickstart syntax.
5431
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005432Requirements
5433------------
5434
5435In order to use the Wic utility with the OpenEmbedded Build system, your
5436system needs to meet the following requirements:
5437
5438- The Linux distribution on your development host must support the
5439 Yocto Project. See the ":ref:`detailed-supported-distros`"
5440 section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual for the list of
5441 distributions that support the Yocto Project.
5442
5443- The standard system utilities, such as ``cp``, must be installed on
5444 your development host system.
5445
5446- You must have sourced the build environment setup script (i.e.
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05005447 :ref:`structure-core-script`) found in the :term:`Build Directory`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005448
5449- You need to have the build artifacts already available, which
5450 typically means that you must have already created an image using the
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05005451 OpenEmbedded build system (e.g. ``core-image-minimal``). While it
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005452 might seem redundant to generate an image in order to create an image
5453 using Wic, the current version of Wic requires the artifacts in the
5454 form generated by the OpenEmbedded build system.
5455
5456- You must build several native tools, which are built to run on the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005457 build system::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005458
5459 $ bitbake parted-native dosfstools-native mtools-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005460
5461- Include "wic" as part of the
5462 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`
5463 variable.
5464
5465- Include the name of the :ref:`wic kickstart file <openembedded-kickstart-wks-reference>`
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05005466 as part of the :term:`WKS_FILE` variable. If multiple candidate files can
5467 be provided by different layers, specify all the possible names through the
5468 :term:`WKS_FILES` variable instead.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005469
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005470Getting Help
5471------------
5472
5473You can get general help for the ``wic`` command by entering the ``wic``
5474command by itself or by entering the command with a help argument as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005475follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005476
5477 $ wic -h
5478 $ wic --help
5479 $ wic help
5480
5481Currently, Wic supports seven commands: ``cp``, ``create``, ``help``,
5482``list``, ``ls``, ``rm``, and ``write``. You can get help for all these
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005483commands except "help" by using the following form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005484
5485 $ wic help command
5486
5487For example, the following command returns help for the ``write``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005488command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005489
5490 $ wic help write
5491
5492Wic supports help for three topics: ``overview``, ``plugins``, and
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005493``kickstart``. You can get help for any topic using the following form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005494
5495 $ wic help topic
5496
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005497For example, the following returns overview help for Wic::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005498
5499 $ wic help overview
5500
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07005501There is one additional level of help for Wic. You can get help on
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005502individual images through the ``list`` command. You can use the ``list``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005503command to return the available Wic images as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005504
5505 $ wic list images
5506 genericx86 Create an EFI disk image for genericx86*
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005507 edgerouter Create SD card image for Edgerouter
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05005508 beaglebone-yocto Create SD card image for Beaglebone
5509 qemux86-directdisk Create a qemu machine 'pcbios' direct disk image
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005510 systemd-bootdisk Create an EFI disk image with systemd-boot
5511 mkhybridiso Create a hybrid ISO image
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05005512 mkefidisk Create an EFI disk image
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005513 sdimage-bootpart Create SD card image with a boot partition
5514 directdisk-multi-rootfs Create multi rootfs image using rootfs plugin
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05005515 directdisk Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005516 directdisk-bootloader-config Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image with custom bootloader config
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05005517 qemuriscv Create qcow2 image for RISC-V QEMU machines
5518 directdisk-gpt Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image
5519 efi-bootdisk
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005520
5521Once you know the list of available
5522Wic images, you can use ``help`` with the command to get help on a
5523particular image. For example, the following command returns help on the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005524"beaglebone-yocto" image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005525
5526 $ wic list beaglebone-yocto help
5527
5528 Creates a partitioned SD card image for Beaglebone.
5529 Boot files are located in the first vfat partition.
5530
5531Operational Modes
5532-----------------
5533
5534You can use Wic in two different modes, depending on how much control
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05005535you need for specifying the OpenEmbedded build artifacts that are used
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005536for creating the image: Raw and Cooked:
5537
5538- *Raw Mode:* You explicitly specify build artifacts through Wic
5539 command-line arguments.
5540
5541- *Cooked Mode:* The current
5542 :term:`MACHINE` setting and image
5543 name are used to automatically locate and provide the build
5544 artifacts. You just supply a kickstart file and the name of the image
5545 from which to use artifacts.
5546
5547Regardless of the mode you use, you need to have the build artifacts
5548ready and available.
5549
5550Raw Mode
5551~~~~~~~~
5552
5553Running Wic in raw mode allows you to specify all the partitions through
5554the ``wic`` command line. The primary use for raw mode is if you have
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05005555built your kernel outside of the Yocto Project :term:`Build Directory`.
5556In other words, you can point to arbitrary kernel, root filesystem locations,
5557and so forth. Contrast this behavior with cooked mode where Wic looks in the
5558:term:`Build Directory` (e.g. ``tmp/deploy/images/``\ machine).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005559
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005560The general form of the ``wic`` command in raw mode is::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005561
5562 $ wic create wks_file options ...
5563
5564 Where:
5565
5566 wks_file:
5567 An OpenEmbedded kickstart file. You can provide
5568 your own custom file or use a file from a set of
5569 existing files as described by further options.
5570
5571 optional arguments:
5572 -h, --help show this help message and exit
5573 -o OUTDIR, --outdir OUTDIR
5574 name of directory to create image in
5575 -e IMAGE_NAME, --image-name IMAGE_NAME
5576 name of the image to use the artifacts from e.g. core-
5577 image-sato
5578 -r ROOTFS_DIR, --rootfs-dir ROOTFS_DIR
5579 path to the /rootfs dir to use as the .wks rootfs
5580 source
5581 -b BOOTIMG_DIR, --bootimg-dir BOOTIMG_DIR
5582 path to the dir containing the boot artifacts (e.g.
5583 /EFI or /syslinux dirs) to use as the .wks bootimg
5584 source
5585 -k KERNEL_DIR, --kernel-dir KERNEL_DIR
5586 path to the dir containing the kernel to use in the
5587 .wks bootimg
5588 -n NATIVE_SYSROOT, --native-sysroot NATIVE_SYSROOT
5589 path to the native sysroot containing the tools to use
5590 to build the image
5591 -s, --skip-build-check
5592 skip the build check
5593 -f, --build-rootfs build rootfs
5594 -c {gzip,bzip2,xz}, --compress-with {gzip,bzip2,xz}
5595 compress image with specified compressor
5596 -m, --bmap generate .bmap
5597 --no-fstab-update Do not change fstab file.
5598 -v VARS_DIR, --vars VARS_DIR
5599 directory with <image>.env files that store bitbake
5600 variables
5601 -D, --debug output debug information
5602
5603.. note::
5604
5605 You do not need root privileges to run Wic. In fact, you should not
5606 run as root when using the utility.
5607
5608Cooked Mode
5609~~~~~~~~~~~
5610
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05005611Running Wic in cooked mode leverages off artifacts in the
5612:term:`Build Directory`. In other words, you do not have to specify kernel or
5613root filesystem locations as part of the command. All you need to provide is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005614a kickstart file and the name of the image from which to use artifacts
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05005615by using the "-e" option. Wic looks in the :term:`Build Directory` (e.g.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005616``tmp/deploy/images/``\ machine) for artifacts.
5617
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005618The general form of the ``wic`` command using Cooked Mode is as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005619
5620 $ wic create wks_file -e IMAGE_NAME
5621
5622 Where:
5623
5624 wks_file:
5625 An OpenEmbedded kickstart file. You can provide
5626 your own custom file or use a file from a set of
5627 existing files provided with the Yocto Project
5628 release.
5629
5630 required argument:
5631 -e IMAGE_NAME, --image-name IMAGE_NAME
5632 name of the image to use the artifacts from e.g. core-
5633 image-sato
5634
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005635Using an Existing Kickstart File
5636--------------------------------
5637
5638If you do not want to create your own kickstart file, you can use an
5639existing file provided by the Wic installation. As shipped, kickstart
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06005640files can be found in the :ref:`overview-manual/development-environment:yocto project source repositories` in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005641following two locations::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005642
5643 poky/meta-yocto-bsp/wic
5644 poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks
5645
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005646Use the following command to list the available kickstart files::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005647
5648 $ wic list images
5649 genericx86 Create an EFI disk image for genericx86*
5650 beaglebone-yocto Create SD card image for Beaglebone
5651 edgerouter Create SD card image for Edgerouter
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05005652 qemux86-directdisk Create a QEMU machine 'pcbios' direct disk image
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005653 directdisk-gpt Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image
5654 mkefidisk Create an EFI disk image
5655 directdisk Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image
5656 systemd-bootdisk Create an EFI disk image with systemd-boot
5657 mkhybridiso Create a hybrid ISO image
5658 sdimage-bootpart Create SD card image with a boot partition
5659 directdisk-multi-rootfs Create multi rootfs image using rootfs plugin
5660 directdisk-bootloader-config Create a 'pcbios' direct disk image with custom bootloader config
5661
5662When you use an existing file, you
5663do not have to use the ``.wks`` extension. Here is an example in Raw
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005664Mode that uses the ``directdisk`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005665
5666 $ wic create directdisk -r rootfs_dir -b bootimg_dir \
5667 -k kernel_dir -n native_sysroot
5668
5669Here are the actual partition language commands used in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005670``genericx86.wks`` file to generate an image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005671
5672 # short-description: Create an EFI disk image for genericx86*
5673 # long-description: Creates a partitioned EFI disk image for genericx86* machines
5674 part /boot --source bootimg-efi --sourceparams="loader=grub-efi" --ondisk sda --label msdos --active --align 1024
5675 part / --source rootfs --ondisk sda --fstype=ext4 --label platform --align 1024 --use-uuid
5676 part swap --ondisk sda --size 44 --label swap1 --fstype=swap
5677
5678 bootloader --ptable gpt --timeout=5 --append="rootfstype=ext4 console=ttyS0,115200 console=tty0"
5679
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005680Using the Wic Plugin Interface
5681------------------------------
5682
5683You can extend and specialize Wic functionality by using Wic plugins.
5684This section explains the Wic plugin interface.
5685
5686.. note::
5687
5688 Wic plugins consist of "source" and "imager" plugins. Imager plugins
5689 are beyond the scope of this section.
5690
5691Source plugins provide a mechanism to customize partition content during
5692the Wic image generation process. You can use source plugins to map
5693values that you specify using ``--source`` commands in kickstart files
5694(i.e. ``*.wks``) to a plugin implementation used to populate a given
5695partition.
5696
5697.. note::
5698
5699 If you use plugins that have build-time dependencies (e.g. native
5700 tools, bootloaders, and so forth) when building a Wic image, you need
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005701 to specify those dependencies using the :term:`WKS_FILE_DEPENDS`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005702 variable.
5703
5704Source plugins are subclasses defined in plugin files. As shipped, the
5705Yocto Project provides several plugin files. You can see the source
5706plugin files that ship with the Yocto Project
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06005707:yocto_git:`here </poky/tree/scripts/lib/wic/plugins/source>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005708Each of these plugin files contains source plugins that are designed to
5709populate a specific Wic image partition.
5710
5711Source plugins are subclasses of the ``SourcePlugin`` class, which is
5712defined in the ``poky/scripts/lib/wic/pluginbase.py`` file. For example,
5713the ``BootimgEFIPlugin`` source plugin found in the ``bootimg-efi.py``
5714file is a subclass of the ``SourcePlugin`` class, which is found in the
5715``pluginbase.py`` file.
5716
5717You can also implement source plugins in a layer outside of the Source
5718Repositories (external layer). To do so, be sure that your plugin files
5719are located in a directory whose path is
5720``scripts/lib/wic/plugins/source/`` within your external layer. When the
5721plugin files are located there, the source plugins they contain are made
5722available to Wic.
5723
5724When the Wic implementation needs to invoke a partition-specific
5725implementation, it looks for the plugin with the same name as the
5726``--source`` parameter used in the kickstart file given to that
5727partition. For example, if the partition is set up using the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005728command in a kickstart file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005729
5730 part /boot --source bootimg-pcbios --ondisk sda --label boot --active --align 1024
5731
5732The methods defined as class
5733members of the matching source plugin (i.e. ``bootimg-pcbios``) in the
5734``bootimg-pcbios.py`` plugin file are used.
5735
5736To be more concrete, here is the corresponding plugin definition from
5737the ``bootimg-pcbios.py`` file for the previous command along with an
5738example method called by the Wic implementation when it needs to prepare
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005739a partition using an implementation-specific function::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005740
5741 .
5742 .
5743 .
5744 class BootimgPcbiosPlugin(SourcePlugin):
5745 """
5746 Create MBR boot partition and install syslinux on it.
5747 """
5748
5749 name = 'bootimg-pcbios'
5750 .
5751 .
5752 .
5753 @classmethod
5754 def do_prepare_partition(cls, part, source_params, creator, cr_workdir,
5755 oe_builddir, bootimg_dir, kernel_dir,
5756 rootfs_dir, native_sysroot):
5757 """
5758 Called to do the actual content population for a partition i.e. it
5759 'prepares' the partition to be incorporated into the image.
5760 In this case, prepare content for legacy bios boot partition.
5761 """
5762 .
5763 .
5764 .
5765
5766If a
5767subclass (plugin) itself does not implement a particular function, Wic
5768locates and uses the default version in the superclass. It is for this
5769reason that all source plugins are derived from the ``SourcePlugin``
5770class.
5771
5772The ``SourcePlugin`` class defined in the ``pluginbase.py`` file defines
5773a set of methods that source plugins can implement or override. Any
5774plugins (subclass of ``SourcePlugin``) that do not implement a
5775particular method inherit the implementation of the method from the
5776``SourcePlugin`` class. For more information, see the ``SourcePlugin``
5777class in the ``pluginbase.py`` file for details:
5778
5779The following list describes the methods implemented in the
5780``SourcePlugin`` class:
5781
5782- ``do_prepare_partition()``: Called to populate a partition with
5783 actual content. In other words, the method prepares the final
5784 partition image that is incorporated into the disk image.
5785
5786- ``do_configure_partition()``: Called before
5787 ``do_prepare_partition()`` to create custom configuration files for a
5788 partition (e.g. syslinux or grub configuration files).
5789
5790- ``do_install_disk()``: Called after all partitions have been
5791 prepared and assembled into a disk image. This method provides a hook
5792 to allow finalization of a disk image (e.g. writing an MBR).
5793
5794- ``do_stage_partition()``: Special content-staging hook called
5795 before ``do_prepare_partition()``. This method is normally empty.
5796
5797 Typically, a partition just uses the passed-in parameters (e.g. the
5798 unmodified value of ``bootimg_dir``). However, in some cases, things
5799 might need to be more tailored. As an example, certain files might
5800 additionally need to be taken from ``bootimg_dir + /boot``. This hook
5801 allows those files to be staged in a customized fashion.
5802
5803 .. note::
5804
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005805 ``get_bitbake_var()`` allows you to access non-standard variables that
5806 you might want to use for this behavior.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005807
5808You can extend the source plugin mechanism. To add more hooks, create
5809more source plugin methods within ``SourcePlugin`` and the corresponding
5810derived subclasses. The code that calls the plugin methods uses the
5811``plugin.get_source_plugin_methods()`` function to find the method or
5812methods needed by the call. Retrieval of those methods is accomplished
5813by filling up a dict with keys that contain the method names of
5814interest. On success, these will be filled in with the actual methods.
5815See the Wic implementation for examples and details.
5816
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005817Wic Examples
5818------------
5819
5820This section provides several examples that show how to use the Wic
5821utility. All the examples assume the list of requirements in the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05005822":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:requirements`" section have been met. The
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005823examples assume the previously generated image is
5824``core-image-minimal``.
5825
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005826Generate an Image using an Existing Kickstart File
5827~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5828
5829This example runs in Cooked Mode and uses the ``mkefidisk`` kickstart
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005830file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005831
5832 $ wic create mkefidisk -e core-image-minimal
5833 INFO: Building wic-tools...
5834 .
5835 .
5836 .
5837 INFO: The new image(s) can be found here:
5838 ./mkefidisk-201804191017-sda.direct
5839
5840 The following build artifacts were used to create the image(s):
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005841 ROOTFS_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
5842 BOOTIMG_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
5843 KERNEL_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/qemux86
5844 NATIVE_SYSROOT: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/i586-oe-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005845
5846 INFO: The image(s) were created using OE kickstart file:
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005847 /home/stephano/yocto/openembedded-core/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/mkefidisk.wks
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005848
5849The previous example shows the easiest way to create an image by running
5850in cooked mode and supplying a kickstart file and the "-e" option to
5851point to the existing build artifacts. Your ``local.conf`` file needs to
5852have the :term:`MACHINE` variable set
5853to the machine you are using, which is "qemux86" in this example.
5854
5855Once the image builds, the output provides image location, artifact use,
5856and kickstart file information.
5857
5858.. note::
5859
5860 You should always verify the details provided in the output to make
5861 sure that the image was indeed created exactly as expected.
5862
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05005863Continuing with the example, you can now write the image from the
5864:term:`Build Directory` onto a USB stick, or whatever media for which you
5865built your image, and boot from the media. You can write the image by using
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005866``bmaptool`` or ``dd``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005867
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05005868 $ oe-run-native bmap-tools-native bmaptool copy mkefidisk-201804191017-sda.direct /dev/sdX
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005869
5870or ::
5871
5872 $ sudo dd if=mkefidisk-201804191017-sda.direct of=/dev/sdX
5873
5874.. note::
5875
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005876 For more information on how to use the ``bmaptool``
5877 to flash a device with an image, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06005878 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:flashing images using \`\`bmaptool\`\``"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05005879 section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005880
5881Using a Modified Kickstart File
5882~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5883
5884Because partitioned image creation is driven by the kickstart file, it
5885is easy to affect image creation by changing the parameters in the file.
5886This next example demonstrates that through modification of the
5887``directdisk-gpt`` kickstart file.
5888
5889As mentioned earlier, you can use the command ``wic list images`` to
5890show the list of existing kickstart files. The directory in which the
5891``directdisk-gpt.wks`` file resides is
5892``scripts/lib/image/canned-wks/``, which is located in the
5893:term:`Source Directory` (e.g. ``poky``).
5894Because available files reside in this directory, you can create and add
5895your own custom files to the directory. Subsequent use of the
5896``wic list images`` command would then include your kickstart files.
5897
5898In this example, the existing ``directdisk-gpt`` file already does most
5899of what is needed. However, for the hardware in this example, the image
5900will need to boot from ``sdb`` instead of ``sda``, which is what the
5901``directdisk-gpt`` kickstart file uses.
5902
5903The example begins by making a copy of the ``directdisk-gpt.wks`` file
5904in the ``scripts/lib/image/canned-wks`` directory and then by changing
5905the lines that specify the target disk from which to boot.
5906::
5907
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005908 $ cp /home/stephano/yocto/poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/directdisk-gpt.wks \
5909 /home/stephano/yocto/poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/directdisksdb-gpt.wks
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005910
5911Next, the example modifies the ``directdisksdb-gpt.wks`` file and
5912changes all instances of "``--ondisk sda``" to "``--ondisk sdb``". The
5913example changes the following two lines and leaves the remaining lines
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005914untouched::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005915
5916 part /boot --source bootimg-pcbios --ondisk sdb --label boot --active --align 1024
5917 part / --source rootfs --ondisk sdb --fstype=ext4 --label platform --align 1024 --use-uuid
5918
5919Once the lines are changed, the
5920example generates the ``directdisksdb-gpt`` image. The command points
5921the process at the ``core-image-minimal`` artifacts for the Next Unit of
5922Computing (nuc) :term:`MACHINE` the
5923``local.conf``.
5924::
5925
5926 $ wic create directdisksdb-gpt -e core-image-minimal
5927 INFO: Building wic-tools...
5928 .
5929 .
5930 .
5931 Initialising tasks: 100% |#######################################| Time: 0:00:01
5932 NOTE: Executing SetScene Tasks
5933 NOTE: Executing RunQueue Tasks
5934 NOTE: Tasks Summary: Attempted 1161 tasks of which 1157 didn't need to be rerun and all succeeded.
5935 INFO: Creating image(s)...
5936
5937 INFO: The new image(s) can be found here:
5938 ./directdisksdb-gpt-201710090938-sdb.direct
5939
5940 The following build artifacts were used to create the image(s):
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005941 ROOTFS_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
5942 BOOTIMG_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
5943 KERNEL_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/qemux86
5944 NATIVE_SYSROOT: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/i586-oe-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005945
5946 INFO: The image(s) were created using OE kickstart file:
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005947 /home/stephano/yocto/poky/scripts/lib/wic/canned-wks/directdisksdb-gpt.wks
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005948
5949Continuing with the example, you can now directly ``dd`` the image to a
5950USB stick, or whatever media for which you built your image, and boot
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005951the resulting media::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005952
5953 $ sudo dd if=directdisksdb-gpt-201710090938-sdb.direct of=/dev/sdb
5954 140966+0 records in
5955 140966+0 records out
5956 72174592 bytes (72 MB, 69 MiB) copied, 78.0282 s, 925 kB/s
5957 $ sudo eject /dev/sdb
5958
5959Using a Modified Kickstart File and Running in Raw Mode
5960~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5961
5962This next example manually specifies each build artifact (runs in Raw
5963Mode) and uses a modified kickstart file. The example also uses the
5964``-o`` option to cause Wic to create the output somewhere other than the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05005965default output directory, which is the current directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005966
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005967 $ wic create test.wks -o /home/stephano/testwic \
5968 --rootfs-dir /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs \
5969 --bootimg-dir /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share \
5970 --kernel-dir /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp/deploy/images/qemux86 \
5971 --native-sysroot /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005972
5973 INFO: Creating image(s)...
5974
5975 INFO: The new image(s) can be found here:
5976 /home/stephano/testwic/test-201710091445-sdb.direct
5977
5978 The following build artifacts were used to create the image(s):
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005979 ROOTFS_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/rootfs
5980 BOOTIMG_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/qemux86-oe-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot/usr/share
5981 KERNEL_DIR: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/deploy/images/qemux86
5982 NATIVE_SYSROOT: /home/stephano/yocto/build/tmp-glibc/work/i586-oe-linux/wic-tools/1.0-r0/recipe-sysroot-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005983
5984 INFO: The image(s) were created using OE kickstart file:
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00005985 test.wks
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05005986
5987For this example,
5988:term:`MACHINE` did not have to be
5989specified in the ``local.conf`` file since the artifact is manually
5990specified.
5991
5992Using Wic to Manipulate an Image
5993~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
5994
5995Wic image manipulation allows you to shorten turnaround time during
5996image development. For example, you can use Wic to delete the kernel
5997partition of a Wic image and then insert a newly built kernel. This
5998saves you time from having to rebuild the entire image each time you
5999modify the kernel.
6000
6001.. note::
6002
6003 In order to use Wic to manipulate a Wic image as in this example,
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006004 your development machine must have the ``mtools`` package installed.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006005
6006The following example examines the contents of the Wic image, deletes
6007the existing kernel, and then inserts a new kernel:
6008
60091. *List the Partitions:* Use the ``wic ls`` command to list all the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006010 partitions in the Wic image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006011
6012 $ wic ls tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic
6013 Num Start End Size Fstype
6014 1 1048576 25041919 23993344 fat16
6015 2 25165824 72157183 46991360 ext4
6016
6017 The previous output shows two partitions in the
6018 ``core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic`` image.
6019
60202. *Examine a Particular Partition:* Use the ``wic ls`` command again
6021 but in a different form to examine a particular partition.
6022
6023 .. note::
6024
6025 You can get command usage on any Wic command using the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006026 form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006027
6028 $ wic help command
6029
6030
6031 For example, the following command shows you the various ways to
6032 use the
6033 wic ls
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006034 command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006035
6036 $ wic help ls
6037
6038
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006039 The following command shows what is in partition one::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006040
6041 $ wic ls tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic:1
6042 Volume in drive : is boot
6043 Volume Serial Number is E894-1809
6044 Directory for ::/
6045
6046 libcom32 c32 186500 2017-10-09 16:06
6047 libutil c32 24148 2017-10-09 16:06
6048 syslinux cfg 220 2017-10-09 16:06
6049 vesamenu c32 27104 2017-10-09 16:06
6050 vmlinuz 6904608 2017-10-09 16:06
6051 5 files 7 142 580 bytes
6052 16 582 656 bytes free
6053
6054 The previous output shows five files, with the
6055 ``vmlinuz`` being the kernel.
6056
6057 .. note::
6058
6059 If you see the following error, you need to update or create a
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006060 ``~/.mtoolsrc`` file and be sure to have the line "mtools_skip_check=1"
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006061 in the file. Then, run the Wic command again::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006062
6063 ERROR: _exec_cmd: /usr/bin/mdir -i /tmp/wic-parttfokuwra ::/ returned '1' instead of 0
6064 output: Total number of sectors (47824) not a multiple of sectors per track (32)!
6065 Add mtools_skip_check=1 to your .mtoolsrc file to skip this test
6066
6067
60683. *Remove the Old Kernel:* Use the ``wic rm`` command to remove the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006069 ``vmlinuz`` file (kernel)::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006070
6071 $ wic rm tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic:1/vmlinuz
6072
60734. *Add In the New Kernel:* Use the ``wic cp`` command to add the
6074 updated kernel to the Wic image. Depending on how you built your
6075 kernel, it could be in different places. If you used ``devtool`` and
6076 an SDK to build your kernel, it resides in the ``tmp/work`` directory
6077 of the extensible SDK. If you used ``make`` to build the kernel, the
6078 kernel will be in the ``workspace/sources`` area.
6079
6080 The following example assumes ``devtool`` was used to build the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006081 kernel::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006082
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -05006083 $ wic cp poky_sdk/tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/linux-yocto/4.12.12+git999-r0/linux-yocto-4.12.12+git999/arch/x86/boot/bzImage \
6084 poky/build/tmp/deploy/images/qemux86/core-image-minimal-qemux86.wic:1/vmlinuz
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006085
6086 Once the new kernel is added back into the image, you can use the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006087 ``dd`` command or :ref:`bmaptool
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006088 <dev-manual/common-tasks:flashing images using \`\`bmaptool\`\`>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006089 to flash your wic image onto an SD card or USB stick and test your
6090 target.
6091
6092 .. note::
6093
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006094 Using ``bmaptool`` is generally 10 to 20 times faster than using ``dd``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006095
6096Flashing Images Using ``bmaptool``
6097==================================
6098
6099A fast and easy way to flash an image to a bootable device is to use
6100Bmaptool, which is integrated into the OpenEmbedded build system.
6101Bmaptool is a generic tool that creates a file's block map (bmap) and
6102then uses that map to copy the file. As compared to traditional tools
6103such as dd or cp, Bmaptool can copy (or flash) large files like raw
6104system image files much faster.
6105
6106.. note::
6107
6108 - If you are using Ubuntu or Debian distributions, you can install
6109 the ``bmap-tools`` package using the following command and then
6110 use the tool without specifying ``PATH`` even from the root
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006111 account::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006112
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05006113 $ sudo apt install bmap-tools
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006114
6115 - If you are unable to install the ``bmap-tools`` package, you will
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006116 need to build Bmaptool before using it. Use the following command::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006117
6118 $ bitbake bmap-tools-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006119
6120Following, is an example that shows how to flash a Wic image. Realize
6121that while this example uses a Wic image, you can use Bmaptool to flash
6122any type of image. Use these steps to flash an image using Bmaptool:
6123
61241. *Update your local.conf File:* You need to have the following set
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006125 in your ``local.conf`` file before building your image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006126
6127 IMAGE_FSTYPES += "wic wic.bmap"
6128
61292. *Get Your Image:* Either have your image ready (pre-built with the
6130 :term:`IMAGE_FSTYPES`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006131 setting previously mentioned) or take the step to build the image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006132
6133 $ bitbake image
6134
61353. *Flash the Device:* Flash the device with the image by using Bmaptool
6136 depending on your particular setup. The following commands assume the
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05006137 image resides in the :term:`Build Directory`'s ``deploy/images/`` area:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006138
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006139 - If you have write access to the media, use this command form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006140
6141 $ oe-run-native bmap-tools-native bmaptool copy build-directory/tmp/deploy/images/machine/image.wic /dev/sdX
6142
6143 - If you do not have write access to the media, set your permissions
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006144 first and then use the same command form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006145
6146 $ sudo chmod 666 /dev/sdX
6147 $ oe-run-native bmap-tools-native bmaptool copy build-directory/tmp/deploy/images/machine/image.wic /dev/sdX
6148
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006149For help on the ``bmaptool`` command, use the following command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006150
6151 $ bmaptool --help
6152
6153Making Images More Secure
6154=========================
6155
6156Security is of increasing concern for embedded devices. Consider the
6157issues and problems discussed in just this sampling of work found across
6158the Internet:
6159
6160- *"*\ `Security Risks of Embedded
6161 Systems <https://www.schneier.com/blog/archives/2014/01/security_risks_9.html>`__\ *"*
6162 by Bruce Schneier
6163
6164- *"*\ `Internet Census
6165 2012 <http://census2012.sourceforge.net/paper.html>`__\ *"* by Carna
6166 Botnet
6167
6168- *"*\ `Security Issues for Embedded
Andrew Geisslerd1e89492021-02-12 15:35:20 -06006169 Devices <https://elinux.org/images/6/6f/Security-issues.pdf>`__\ *"*
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006170 by Jake Edge
6171
6172When securing your image is of concern, there are steps, tools, and
6173variables that you can consider to help you reach the security goals you
6174need for your particular device. Not all situations are identical when
6175it comes to making an image secure. Consequently, this section provides
6176some guidance and suggestions for consideration when you want to make
6177your image more secure.
6178
6179.. note::
6180
6181 Because the security requirements and risks are different for every
6182 type of device, this section cannot provide a complete reference on
6183 securing your custom OS. It is strongly recommended that you also
6184 consult other sources of information on embedded Linux system
6185 hardening and on security.
6186
6187General Considerations
6188----------------------
6189
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07006190There are general considerations that help you create more secure images.
6191You should consider the following suggestions to make your device
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006192more secure:
6193
6194- Scan additional code you are adding to the system (e.g. application
6195 code) by using static analysis tools. Look for buffer overflows and
6196 other potential security problems.
6197
6198- Pay particular attention to the security for any web-based
6199 administration interface.
6200
6201 Web interfaces typically need to perform administrative functions and
6202 tend to need to run with elevated privileges. Thus, the consequences
6203 resulting from the interface's security becoming compromised can be
6204 serious. Look for common web vulnerabilities such as
6205 cross-site-scripting (XSS), unvalidated inputs, and so forth.
6206
6207 As with system passwords, the default credentials for accessing a
6208 web-based interface should not be the same across all devices. This
6209 is particularly true if the interface is enabled by default as it can
6210 be assumed that many end-users will not change the credentials.
6211
6212- Ensure you can update the software on the device to mitigate
6213 vulnerabilities discovered in the future. This consideration
6214 especially applies when your device is network-enabled.
6215
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05006216- Regularly scan and apply fixes for CVE security issues affecting
6217 all software components in the product, see ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:checking for vulnerabilities`".
6218
6219- Regularly update your version of Poky and OE-Core from their upstream
6220 developers, e.g. to apply updates and security fixes from stable
6221 and LTS branches.
6222
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006223- Ensure you remove or disable debugging functionality before producing
6224 the final image. For information on how to do this, see the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006225 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:considerations specific to the openembedded build system`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006226 section.
6227
6228- Ensure you have no network services listening that are not needed.
6229
6230- Remove any software from the image that is not needed.
6231
6232- Enable hardware support for secure boot functionality when your
6233 device supports this functionality.
6234
6235Security Flags
6236--------------
6237
6238The Yocto Project has security flags that you can enable that help make
6239your build output more secure. The security flags are in the
6240``meta/conf/distro/include/security_flags.inc`` file in your
6241:term:`Source Directory` (e.g. ``poky``).
6242
6243.. note::
6244
6245 Depending on the recipe, certain security flags are enabled and
6246 disabled by default.
6247
6248Use the following line in your ``local.conf`` file or in your custom
6249distribution configuration file to enable the security compiler and
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006250linker flags for your build::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006251
6252 require conf/distro/include/security_flags.inc
6253
6254Considerations Specific to the OpenEmbedded Build System
6255--------------------------------------------------------
6256
6257You can take some steps that are specific to the OpenEmbedded build
6258system to make your images more secure:
6259
6260- Ensure "debug-tweaks" is not one of your selected
6261 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`.
6262 When creating a new project, the default is to provide you with an
6263 initial ``local.conf`` file that enables this feature using the
6264 :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006265 variable with the line::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006266
6267 EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES = "debug-tweaks"
6268
6269 To disable that feature, simply comment out that line in your
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006270 ``local.conf`` file, or make sure :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` does not contain
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006271 "debug-tweaks" before producing your final image. Among other things,
6272 leaving this in place sets the root password as blank, which makes
6273 logging in for debugging or inspection easy during development but
6274 also means anyone can easily log in during production.
6275
6276- It is possible to set a root password for the image and also to set
6277 passwords for any extra users you might add (e.g. administrative or
6278 service type users). When you set up passwords for multiple images or
6279 users, you should not duplicate passwords.
6280
6281 To set up passwords, use the
6282 :ref:`extrausers <ref-classes-extrausers>`
6283 class, which is the preferred method. For an example on how to set up
6284 both root and user passwords, see the
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00006285 ":ref:`ref-classes-extrausers`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006286
6287 .. note::
6288
6289 When adding extra user accounts or setting a root password, be
6290 cautious about setting the same password on every device. If you
6291 do this, and the password you have set is exposed, then every
6292 device is now potentially compromised. If you need this access but
6293 want to ensure security, consider setting a different, random
6294 password for each device. Typically, you do this as a separate
6295 step after you deploy the image onto the device.
6296
6297- Consider enabling a Mandatory Access Control (MAC) framework such as
6298 SMACK or SELinux and tuning it appropriately for your device's usage.
6299 You can find more information in the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006300 :yocto_git:`meta-selinux </meta-selinux/>` layer.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006301
6302Tools for Hardening Your Image
6303------------------------------
6304
6305The Yocto Project provides tools for making your image more secure. You
6306can find these tools in the ``meta-security`` layer of the
6307:yocto_git:`Yocto Project Source Repositories <>`.
6308
6309Creating Your Own Distribution
6310==============================
6311
6312When you build an image using the Yocto Project and do not alter any
6313distribution :term:`Metadata`, you are
6314creating a Poky distribution. If you wish to gain more control over
6315package alternative selections, compile-time options, and other
6316low-level configurations, you can create your own distribution.
6317
6318To create your own distribution, the basic steps consist of creating
6319your own distribution layer, creating your own distribution
6320configuration file, and then adding any needed code and Metadata to the
6321layer. The following steps provide some more detail:
6322
6323- *Create a layer for your new distro:* Create your distribution layer
6324 so that you can keep your Metadata and code for the distribution
6325 separate. It is strongly recommended that you create and use your own
6326 layer for configuration and code. Using your own layer as compared to
6327 just placing configurations in a ``local.conf`` configuration file
6328 makes it easier to reproduce the same build configuration when using
6329 multiple build machines. See the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006330 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:creating a general layer using the \`\`bitbake-layers\`\` script`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006331 section for information on how to quickly set up a layer.
6332
6333- *Create the distribution configuration file:* The distribution
6334 configuration file needs to be created in the ``conf/distro``
6335 directory of your layer. You need to name it using your distribution
6336 name (e.g. ``mydistro.conf``).
6337
6338 .. note::
6339
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006340 The :term:`DISTRO` variable in your ``local.conf`` file determines the
6341 name of your distribution.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006342
6343 You can split out parts of your configuration file into include files
6344 and then "require" them from within your distribution configuration
6345 file. Be sure to place the include files in the
6346 ``conf/distro/include`` directory of your layer. A common example
6347 usage of include files would be to separate out the selection of
6348 desired version and revisions for individual recipes.
6349
6350 Your configuration file needs to set the following required
6351 variables:
6352
6353 - :term:`DISTRO_NAME`
6354
6355 - :term:`DISTRO_VERSION`
6356
6357 These following variables are optional and you typically set them
6358 from the distribution configuration file:
6359
6360 - :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
6361
6362 - :term:`DISTRO_EXTRA_RDEPENDS`
6363
6364 - :term:`DISTRO_EXTRA_RRECOMMENDS`
6365
6366 - :term:`TCLIBC`
6367
6368 .. tip::
6369
6370 If you want to base your distribution configuration file on the
6371 very basic configuration from OE-Core, you can use
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006372 ``conf/distro/defaultsetup.conf`` as a reference and just include
6373 variables that differ as compared to ``defaultsetup.conf``.
6374 Alternatively, you can create a distribution configuration file
6375 from scratch using the ``defaultsetup.conf`` file or configuration files
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00006376 from another distribution such as Poky as a reference.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006377
6378- *Provide miscellaneous variables:* Be sure to define any other
6379 variables for which you want to create a default or enforce as part
6380 of the distribution configuration. You can include nearly any
6381 variable from the ``local.conf`` file. The variables you use are not
6382 limited to the list in the previous bulleted item.
6383
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05006384- *Point to Your distribution configuration file:* In your ``local.conf``
6385 file in the :term:`Build Directory`, set your :term:`DISTRO` variable to
6386 point to your distribution's configuration file. For example, if your
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006387 distribution's configuration file is named ``mydistro.conf``, then
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006388 you point to it as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006389
6390 DISTRO = "mydistro"
6391
6392- *Add more to the layer if necessary:* Use your layer to hold other
6393 information needed for the distribution:
6394
6395 - Add recipes for installing distro-specific configuration files
6396 that are not already installed by another recipe. If you have
6397 distro-specific configuration files that are included by an
6398 existing recipe, you should add an append file (``.bbappend``) for
6399 those. For general information and recommendations on how to add
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006400 recipes to your layer, see the
6401 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:creating your own layer`" and
6402 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:following best practices when creating layers`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006403 sections.
6404
6405 - Add any image recipes that are specific to your distribution.
6406
6407 - Add a ``psplash`` append file for a branded splash screen. For
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006408 information on append files, see the
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05006409 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:appending other layers metadata with your layer`"
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006410 section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006411
6412 - Add any other append files to make custom changes that are
6413 specific to individual recipes.
6414
6415Creating a Custom Template Configuration Directory
6416==================================================
6417
6418If you are producing your own customized version of the build system for
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05006419use by other users, you might want to provide a custom build configuration
6420that includes all the necessary settings and layers (i.e. ``local.conf`` and
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05006421``bblayers.conf`` that are created in a new :term:`Build Directory`) and a custom
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05006422message that is shown when setting up the build. This can be done by
6423creating one or more template configuration directories in your
6424custom distribution layer.
6425
6426This can be done by using ``bitbake-layers save-build-conf``::
6427
6428 $ bitbake-layers save-build-conf ../../meta-alex/ test-1
6429 NOTE: Starting bitbake server...
6430 NOTE: Configuration template placed into /srv/work/alex/meta-alex/conf/templates/test-1
6431 Please review the files in there, and particularly provide a configuration description in /srv/work/alex/meta-alex/conf/templates/test-1/conf-notes.txt
6432 You can try out the configuration with
6433 TEMPLATECONF=/srv/work/alex/meta-alex/conf/templates/test-1 . /srv/work/alex/poky/oe-init-build-env build-try-test-1
6434
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05006435The above command takes the config files from the currently active :term:`Build Directory` under ``conf``,
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05006436replaces site-specific paths in ``bblayers.conf`` with ``##OECORE##``-relative paths, and copies
6437the config files into a specified layer under a specified template name.
6438
6439To use those saved templates as a starting point for a build, users should point
6440to one of them with :term:`TEMPLATECONF` environment variable::
6441
6442 TEMPLATECONF=/srv/work/alex/meta-alex/conf/templates/test-1 . /srv/work/alex/poky/oe-init-build-env build-try-test-1
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006443
6444The OpenEmbedded build system uses the environment variable
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05006445:term:`TEMPLATECONF` to locate the directory from which it gathers
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006446configuration information that ultimately ends up in the
6447:term:`Build Directory` ``conf`` directory.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006448
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05006449If :term:`TEMPLATECONF` is not set, the default value is obtained
6450from ``.templateconf`` file that is read from the same directory as
6451``oe-init-build-env`` script. For the Poky reference distribution this
6452would be::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006453
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05006454 TEMPLATECONF=${TEMPLATECONF:-meta-poky/conf/templates/default}
6455
6456If you look at a configuration template directory, you will
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006457see the ``bblayers.conf.sample``, ``local.conf.sample``, and
6458``conf-notes.txt`` files. The build system uses these files to form the
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -05006459respective ``bblayers.conf`` file, ``local.conf`` file, and show
6460users a note about the build they're setting up
6461when running the ``oe-init-build-env`` setup script. These can be
6462edited further if needed to improve or change the build configurations
6463available to the users.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006464
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00006465Conserving Disk Space
6466=====================
6467
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006468Conserving Disk Space During Builds
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00006469-----------------------------------
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006470
6471To help conserve disk space during builds, you can add the following
6472statement to your project's ``local.conf`` configuration file found in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006473the :term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006474
6475 INHERIT += "rm_work"
6476
6477Adding this statement deletes the work directory used for
6478building a recipe once the recipe is built. For more information on
6479"rm_work", see the
6480:ref:`rm_work <ref-classes-rm-work>` class in the
6481Yocto Project Reference Manual.
6482
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00006483Purging Duplicate Shared State Cache Files
6484-------------------------------------------
6485
6486After multiple build iterations, the Shared State (sstate) cache can contain
6487duplicate cache files for a given package, while only the most recent one
6488is likely to be reusable. The following command purges all but the
6489newest sstate cache file for each package::
6490
6491 sstate-cache-management.sh --remove-duplicated --cache-dir=build/sstate-cache
6492
6493This command will ask you to confirm the deletions it identifies.
6494
Patrick Williams92b42cb2022-09-03 06:53:57 -05006495.. note::
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00006496
6497 The duplicated sstate cache files of one package must have the same
6498 architecture, which means that sstate cache files with multiple
6499 architectures are not considered as duplicate.
6500
6501Run ``sstate-cache-management.sh`` for more details about this script.
6502
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006503Working with Packages
6504=====================
6505
6506This section describes a few tasks that involve packages:
6507
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006508- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:excluding packages from an image`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006509
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006510- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:incrementing a package version`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006511
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006512- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:handling optional module packaging`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006513
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006514- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:using runtime package management`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006515
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006516- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:generating and using signed packages`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006517
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006518- :ref:`Setting up and running package test
6519 (ptest) <dev-manual/common-tasks:testing packages with ptest>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006520
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006521- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:creating node package manager (npm) packages`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006522
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006523- :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:adding custom metadata to packages`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006524
6525Excluding Packages from an Image
6526--------------------------------
6527
6528You might find it necessary to prevent specific packages from being
6529installed into an image. If so, you can use several variables to direct
6530the build system to essentially ignore installing recommended packages
6531or to not install a package at all.
6532
6533The following list introduces variables you can use to prevent packages
6534from being installed into your image. Each of these variables only works
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07006535with IPK and RPM package types, not for Debian packages.
6536Also, you can use these variables from your ``local.conf`` file
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006537or attach them to a specific image recipe by using a recipe name
6538override. For more detail on the variables, see the descriptions in the
6539Yocto Project Reference Manual's glossary chapter.
6540
6541- :term:`BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS`:
6542 Use this variable to specify "recommended-only" packages that you do
6543 not want installed.
6544
6545- :term:`NO_RECOMMENDATIONS`:
6546 Use this variable to prevent all "recommended-only" packages from
6547 being installed.
6548
6549- :term:`PACKAGE_EXCLUDE`:
6550 Use this variable to prevent specific packages from being installed
6551 regardless of whether they are "recommended-only" or not. You need to
6552 realize that the build process could fail with an error when you
6553 prevent the installation of a package whose presence is required by
6554 an installed package.
6555
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006556Incrementing a Package Version
6557------------------------------
6558
6559This section provides some background on how binary package versioning
6560is accomplished and presents some of the services, variables, and
6561terminology involved.
6562
6563In order to understand binary package versioning, you need to consider
6564the following:
6565
6566- Binary Package: The binary package that is eventually built and
6567 installed into an image.
6568
6569- Binary Package Version: The binary package version is composed of two
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05006570 components --- a version and a revision.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006571
6572 .. note::
6573
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006574 Technically, a third component, the "epoch" (i.e. :term:`PE`) is involved
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006575 but this discussion for the most part ignores :term:`PE`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006576
6577 The version and revision are taken from the
6578 :term:`PV` and
6579 :term:`PR` variables, respectively.
6580
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006581- :term:`PV`: The recipe version. :term:`PV` represents the version of the
6582 software being packaged. Do not confuse :term:`PV` with the binary
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006583 package version.
6584
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04006585- :term:`PR`: The recipe revision.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006586
6587- :term:`SRCPV`: The OpenEmbedded
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006588 build system uses this string to help define the value of :term:`PV` when
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006589 the source code revision needs to be included in it.
6590
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006591- :yocto_wiki:`PR Service </PR_Service>`: A
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006592 network-based service that helps automate keeping package feeds
6593 compatible with existing package manager applications such as RPM,
6594 APT, and OPKG.
6595
6596Whenever the binary package content changes, the binary package version
6597must change. Changing the binary package version is accomplished by
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006598changing or "bumping" the :term:`PR` and/or :term:`PV` values. Increasing these
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006599values occurs one of two ways:
6600
6601- Automatically using a Package Revision Service (PR Service).
6602
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006603- Manually incrementing the :term:`PR` and/or :term:`PV` variables.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006604
6605Given a primary challenge of any build system and its users is how to
6606maintain a package feed that is compatible with existing package manager
6607applications such as RPM, APT, and OPKG, using an automated system is
6608much preferred over a manual system. In either system, the main
6609requirement is that binary package version numbering increases in a
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07006610linear fashion and that there is a number of version components that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006611support that linear progression. For information on how to ensure
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006612package revisioning remains linear, see the
6613":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:automatically incrementing a package version number`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006614section.
6615
6616The following three sections provide related information on the PR
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006617Service, the manual method for "bumping" :term:`PR` and/or :term:`PV`, and on
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006618how to ensure binary package revisioning remains linear.
6619
6620Working With a PR Service
6621~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6622
6623As mentioned, attempting to maintain revision numbers in the
6624:term:`Metadata` is error prone, inaccurate,
6625and causes problems for people submitting recipes. Conversely, the PR
6626Service automatically generates increasing numbers, particularly the
6627revision field, which removes the human element.
6628
6629.. note::
6630
6631 For additional information on using a PR Service, you can see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006632 :yocto_wiki:`PR Service </PR_Service>` wiki page.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006633
6634The Yocto Project uses variables in order of decreasing priority to
6635facilitate revision numbering (i.e.
6636:term:`PE`,
6637:term:`PV`, and
6638:term:`PR` for epoch, version, and
6639revision, respectively). The values are highly dependent on the policies
6640and procedures of a given distribution and package feed.
6641
6642Because the OpenEmbedded build system uses
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006643":ref:`signatures <overview-manual/concepts:checksums (signatures)>`", which are
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006644unique to a given build, the build system knows when to rebuild
6645packages. All the inputs into a given task are represented by a
6646signature, which can trigger a rebuild when different. Thus, the build
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006647system itself does not rely on the :term:`PR`, :term:`PV`, and :term:`PE` numbers to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006648trigger a rebuild. The signatures, however, can be used to generate
6649these values.
6650
6651The PR Service works with both ``OEBasic`` and ``OEBasicHash``
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006652generators. The value of :term:`PR` bumps when the checksum changes and the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006653different generator mechanisms change signatures under different
6654circumstances.
6655
6656As implemented, the build system includes values from the PR Service
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006657into the :term:`PR` field as an addition using the form "``.x``" so ``r0``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006658becomes ``r0.1``, ``r0.2`` and so forth. This scheme allows existing
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006659:term:`PR` values to be used for whatever reasons, which include manual
6660:term:`PR` bumps, should it be necessary.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006661
6662By default, the PR Service is not enabled or running. Thus, the packages
6663generated are just "self consistent". The build system adds and removes
6664packages and there are no guarantees about upgrade paths but images will
6665be consistent and correct with the latest changes.
6666
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05006667The simplest form for a PR Service is for a single host development system
6668that builds the package feed (building system). For this scenario, you can
6669enable a local PR Service by setting :term:`PRSERV_HOST` in your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006670``local.conf`` file in the :term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006671
6672 PRSERV_HOST = "localhost:0"
6673
6674Once the service is started, packages will automatically
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006675get increasing :term:`PR` values and BitBake takes care of starting and
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006676stopping the server.
6677
6678If you have a more complex setup where multiple host development systems
6679work against a common, shared package feed, you have a single PR Service
6680running and it is connected to each building system. For this scenario,
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006681you need to start the PR Service using the ``bitbake-prserv`` command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006682
6683 bitbake-prserv --host ip --port port --start
6684
6685In addition to
6686hand-starting the service, you need to update the ``local.conf`` file of
6687each building system as described earlier so each system points to the
6688server and port.
6689
6690It is also recommended you use build history, which adds some sanity
6691checks to binary package versions, in conjunction with the server that
6692is running the PR Service. To enable build history, add the following to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006693each building system's ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006694
6695 # It is recommended to activate "buildhistory" for testing the PR service
6696 INHERIT += "buildhistory"
6697 BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1"
6698
6699For information on build
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006700history, see the
6701":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:maintaining build output quality`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006702
6703.. note::
6704
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006705 The OpenEmbedded build system does not maintain :term:`PR` information as
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006706 part of the shared state (sstate) packages. If you maintain an sstate
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05006707 feed, it's expected that either all your building systems that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006708 contribute to the sstate feed use a shared PR Service, or you do not
6709 run a PR Service on any of your building systems. Having some systems
6710 use a PR Service while others do not leads to obvious problems.
6711
6712 For more information on shared state, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006713 ":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:shared state cache`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006714 section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
6715
6716Manually Bumping PR
6717~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6718
6719The alternative to setting up a PR Service is to manually "bump" the
6720:term:`PR` variable.
6721
6722If a committed change results in changing the package output, then the
6723value of the PR variable needs to be increased (or "bumped") as part of
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006724that commit. For new recipes you should add the :term:`PR` variable and set
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006725its initial value equal to "r0", which is the default. Even though the
6726default value is "r0", the practice of adding it to a new recipe makes
6727it harder to forget to bump the variable when you make changes to the
6728recipe in future.
6729
6730If you are sharing a common ``.inc`` file with multiple recipes, you can
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006731also use the :term:`INC_PR` variable to ensure that the recipes sharing the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006732``.inc`` file are rebuilt when the ``.inc`` file itself is changed. The
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006733``.inc`` file must set :term:`INC_PR` (initially to "r0"), and all recipes
6734referring to it should set :term:`PR` to "${INC_PR}.0" initially,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006735incrementing the last number when the recipe is changed. If the ``.inc``
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006736file is changed then its :term:`INC_PR` should be incremented.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006737
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006738When upgrading the version of a binary package, assuming the :term:`PV`
6739changes, the :term:`PR` variable should be reset to "r0" (or "${INC_PR}.0"
6740if you are using :term:`INC_PR`).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006741
6742Usually, version increases occur only to binary packages. However, if
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006743for some reason :term:`PV` changes but does not increase, you can increase
6744the :term:`PE` variable (Package Epoch). The :term:`PE` variable defaults to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006745"0".
6746
6747Binary package version numbering strives to follow the `Debian Version
6748Field Policy
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006749Guidelines <https://www.debian.org/doc/debian-policy/ch-controlfields.html>`__.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006750These guidelines define how versions are compared and what "increasing"
6751a version means.
6752
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006753Automatically Incrementing a Package Version Number
6754~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6755
6756When fetching a repository, BitBake uses the
6757:term:`SRCREV` variable to determine
6758the specific source code revision from which to build. You set the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006759:term:`SRCREV` variable to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006760:term:`AUTOREV` to cause the
6761OpenEmbedded build system to automatically use the latest revision of
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006762the software::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006763
6764 SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}"
6765
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006766Furthermore, you need to reference :term:`SRCPV` in :term:`PV` in order to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006767automatically update the version whenever the revision of the source
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006768code changes. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006769
6770 PV = "1.0+git${SRCPV}"
6771
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006772The OpenEmbedded build system substitutes :term:`SRCPV` with the following:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006773
6774.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006775
6776 AUTOINC+source_code_revision
6777
6778The build system replaces the ``AUTOINC``
6779with a number. The number used depends on the state of the PR Service:
6780
6781- If PR Service is enabled, the build system increments the number,
6782 which is similar to the behavior of
6783 :term:`PR`. This behavior results in
6784 linearly increasing package versions, which is desirable. Here is an
6785 example:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006786
6787 .. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006788
6789 hello-world-git_0.0+git0+b6558dd387-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
6790 hello-world-git_0.0+git1+dd2f5c3565-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
6791
6792- If PR Service is not enabled, the build system replaces the
6793 ``AUTOINC`` placeholder with zero (i.e. "0"). This results in
6794 changing the package version since the source revision is included.
6795 However, package versions are not increased linearly. Here is an
6796 example:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006797
6798 .. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006799
6800 hello-world-git_0.0+git0+b6558dd387-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
6801 hello-world-git_0.0+git0+dd2f5c3565-r0.0_armv7a-neon.ipk
6802
6803In summary, the OpenEmbedded build system does not track the history of
6804binary package versions for this purpose. ``AUTOINC``, in this case, is
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006805comparable to :term:`PR`. If PR server is not enabled, ``AUTOINC`` in the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006806package version is simply replaced by "0". If PR server is enabled, the
6807build system keeps track of the package versions and bumps the number
6808when the package revision changes.
6809
6810Handling Optional Module Packaging
6811----------------------------------
6812
6813Many pieces of software split functionality into optional modules (or
6814plugins) and the plugins that are built might depend on configuration
6815options. To avoid having to duplicate the logic that determines what
6816modules are available in your recipe or to avoid having to package each
6817module by hand, the OpenEmbedded build system provides functionality to
6818handle module packaging dynamically.
6819
6820To handle optional module packaging, you need to do two things:
6821
6822- Ensure the module packaging is actually done.
6823
6824- Ensure that any dependencies on optional modules from other recipes
6825 are satisfied by your recipe.
6826
6827Making Sure the Packaging is Done
6828~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6829
6830To ensure the module packaging actually gets done, you use the
6831``do_split_packages`` function within the ``populate_packages`` Python
6832function in your recipe. The ``do_split_packages`` function searches for
6833a pattern of files or directories under a specified path and creates a
6834package for each one it finds by appending to the
6835:term:`PACKAGES` variable and
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05006836setting the appropriate values for ``FILES:packagename``,
6837``RDEPENDS:packagename``, ``DESCRIPTION:packagename``, and so forth.
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006838Here is an example from the ``lighttpd`` recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006839
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05006840 python populate_packages:prepend () {
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006841 lighttpd_libdir = d.expand('${libdir}')
6842 do_split_packages(d, lighttpd_libdir, '^mod_(.*).so$',
6843 'lighttpd-module-%s', 'Lighttpd module for %s',
6844 extra_depends='')
6845 }
6846
6847The previous example specifies a number of things in the call to
6848``do_split_packages``.
6849
6850- A directory within the files installed by your recipe through
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05006851 :ref:`ref-tasks-install` in which to search.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006852
6853- A regular expression used to match module files in that directory. In
6854 the example, note the parentheses () that mark the part of the
6855 expression from which the module name should be derived.
6856
6857- A pattern to use for the package names.
6858
6859- A description for each package.
6860
6861- An empty string for ``extra_depends``, which disables the default
6862 dependency on the main ``lighttpd`` package. Thus, if a file in
6863 ``${libdir}`` called ``mod_alias.so`` is found, a package called
6864 ``lighttpd-module-alias`` is created for it and the
6865 :term:`DESCRIPTION` is set to
6866 "Lighttpd module for alias".
6867
6868Often, packaging modules is as simple as the previous example. However,
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07006869there are more advanced options that you can use within
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006870``do_split_packages`` to modify its behavior. And, if you need to, you
6871can add more logic by specifying a hook function that is called for each
6872package. It is also perfectly acceptable to call ``do_split_packages``
6873multiple times if you have more than one set of modules to package.
6874
6875For more examples that show how to use ``do_split_packages``, see the
6876``connman.inc`` file in the ``meta/recipes-connectivity/connman/``
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06006877directory of the ``poky`` :ref:`source repository <overview-manual/development-environment:yocto project source repositories>`. You can
Patrick Williams975a06f2022-10-21 14:42:47 -05006878also find examples in ``meta/classes-recipe/kernel.bbclass``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006879
6880Following is a reference that shows ``do_split_packages`` mandatory and
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006881optional arguments::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006882
6883 Mandatory arguments
6884
6885 root
6886 The path in which to search
6887 file_regex
6888 Regular expression to match searched files.
6889 Use parentheses () to mark the part of this
6890 expression that should be used to derive the
6891 module name (to be substituted where %s is
6892 used in other function arguments as noted below)
6893 output_pattern
6894 Pattern to use for the package names. Must
6895 include %s.
6896 description
6897 Description to set for each package. Must
6898 include %s.
6899
6900 Optional arguments
6901
6902 postinst
6903 Postinstall script to use for all packages
6904 (as a string)
6905 recursive
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05006906 True to perform a recursive search --- default
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006907 False
6908 hook
6909 A hook function to be called for every match.
6910 The function will be called with the following
6911 arguments (in the order listed):
6912
6913 f
6914 Full path to the file/directory match
6915 pkg
6916 The package name
6917 file_regex
6918 As above
6919 output_pattern
6920 As above
6921 modulename
6922 The module name derived using file_regex
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05006923 extra_depends
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006924 Extra runtime dependencies (RDEPENDS) to be
6925 set for all packages. The default value of None
6926 causes a dependency on the main package
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05006927 (${PN}) --- if you do not want this, pass empty
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006928 string '' for this parameter.
6929 aux_files_pattern
6930 Extra item(s) to be added to FILES for each
6931 package. Can be a single string item or a list
6932 of strings for multiple items. Must include %s.
6933 postrm
6934 postrm script to use for all packages (as a
6935 string)
6936 allow_dirs
6937 True to allow directories to be matched -
6938 default False
6939 prepend
6940 If True, prepend created packages to PACKAGES
6941 instead of the default False which appends them
6942 match_path
6943 match file_regex on the whole relative path to
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05006944 the root rather than just the filename
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006945 aux_files_pattern_verbatim
6946 Extra item(s) to be added to FILES for each
6947 package, using the actual derived module name
6948 rather than converting it to something legal
6949 for a package name. Can be a single string item
6950 or a list of strings for multiple items. Must
6951 include %s.
6952 allow_links
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05006953 True to allow symlinks to be matched --- default
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006954 False
6955 summary
6956 Summary to set for each package. Must include %s;
6957 defaults to description if not set.
6958
6959
6960
6961Satisfying Dependencies
6962~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
6963
6964The second part for handling optional module packaging is to ensure that
6965any dependencies on optional modules from other recipes are satisfied by
6966your recipe. You can be sure these dependencies are satisfied by using
6967the :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC`
6968variable. Here is an example that continues with the ``lighttpd`` recipe
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05006969shown earlier::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006970
6971 PACKAGES_DYNAMIC = "lighttpd-module-.*"
6972
6973The name
6974specified in the regular expression can of course be anything. In this
6975example, it is ``lighttpd-module-`` and is specified as the prefix to
6976ensure that any :term:`RDEPENDS` and
6977:term:`RRECOMMENDS` on a package
6978name starting with the prefix are satisfied during build time. If you
6979are using ``do_split_packages`` as described in the previous section,
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05006980the value you put in :term:`PACKAGES_DYNAMIC` should correspond to the name
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05006981pattern specified in the call to ``do_split_packages``.
6982
6983Using Runtime Package Management
6984--------------------------------
6985
6986During a build, BitBake always transforms a recipe into one or more
6987packages. For example, BitBake takes the ``bash`` recipe and produces a
6988number of packages (e.g. ``bash``, ``bash-bashbug``,
6989``bash-completion``, ``bash-completion-dbg``, ``bash-completion-dev``,
6990``bash-completion-extra``, ``bash-dbg``, and so forth). Not all
6991generated packages are included in an image.
6992
6993In several situations, you might need to update, add, remove, or query
6994the packages on a target device at runtime (i.e. without having to
6995generate a new image). Examples of such situations include:
6996
6997- You want to provide in-the-field updates to deployed devices (e.g.
6998 security updates).
6999
7000- You want to have a fast turn-around development cycle for one or more
7001 applications that run on your device.
7002
7003- You want to temporarily install the "debug" packages of various
7004 applications on your device so that debugging can be greatly improved
7005 by allowing access to symbols and source debugging.
7006
7007- You want to deploy a more minimal package selection of your device
7008 but allow in-the-field updates to add a larger selection for
7009 customization.
7010
7011In all these situations, you have something similar to a more
7012traditional Linux distribution in that in-field devices are able to
7013receive pre-compiled packages from a server for installation or update.
7014Being able to install these packages on a running, in-field device is
7015what is termed "runtime package management".
7016
7017In order to use runtime package management, you need a host or server
7018machine that serves up the pre-compiled packages plus the required
7019metadata. You also need package manipulation tools on the target. The
7020build machine is a likely candidate to act as the server. However, that
7021machine does not necessarily have to be the package server. The build
7022machine could push its artifacts to another machine that acts as the
7023server (e.g. Internet-facing). In fact, doing so is advantageous for a
7024production environment as getting the packages away from the development
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05007025system's :term:`Build Directory` prevents accidental overwrites.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007026
7027A simple build that targets just one device produces more than one
7028package database. In other words, the packages produced by a build are
7029separated out into a couple of different package groupings based on
7030criteria such as the target's CPU architecture, the target board, or the
7031C library used on the target. For example, a build targeting the
7032``qemux86`` device produces the following three package databases:
7033``noarch``, ``i586``, and ``qemux86``. If you wanted your ``qemux86``
7034device to be aware of all the packages that were available to it, you
7035would need to point it to each of these databases individually. In a
7036similar way, a traditional Linux distribution usually is configured to
7037be aware of a number of software repositories from which it retrieves
7038packages.
7039
7040Using runtime package management is completely optional and not required
7041for a successful build or deployment in any way. But if you want to make
7042use of runtime package management, you need to do a couple things above
7043and beyond the basics. The remainder of this section describes what you
7044need to do.
7045
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007046Build Considerations
7047~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7048
7049This section describes build considerations of which you need to be
7050aware in order to provide support for runtime package management.
7051
7052When BitBake generates packages, it needs to know what format or formats
7053to use. In your configuration, you use the
7054:term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES`
7055variable to specify the format:
7056
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050070571. Open the ``local.conf`` file inside your :term:`Build Directory` (e.g.
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -05007058 ``poky/build/conf/local.conf``).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007059
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050070602. Select the desired package format as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007061
7062 PACKAGE_CLASSES ?= "package_packageformat"
7063
7064 where packageformat can be "ipk", "rpm",
7065 "deb", or "tar" which are the supported package formats.
7066
7067 .. note::
7068
7069 Because the Yocto Project supports four different package formats,
7070 you can set the variable with more than one argument. However, the
7071 OpenEmbedded build system only uses the first argument when
7072 creating an image or Software Development Kit (SDK).
7073
7074If you would like your image to start off with a basic package database
7075containing the packages in your current build as well as to have the
7076relevant tools available on the target for runtime package management,
7077you can include "package-management" in the
7078:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES`
7079variable. Including "package-management" in this configuration variable
7080ensures that when the image is assembled for your target, the image
7081includes the currently-known package databases as well as the
7082target-specific tools required for runtime package management to be
7083performed on the target. However, this is not strictly necessary. You
7084could start your image off without any databases but only include the
7085required on-target package tool(s). As an example, you could include
7086"opkg" in your
7087:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL` variable
7088if you are using the IPK package format. You can then initialize your
7089target's package database(s) later once your image is up and running.
7090
7091Whenever you perform any sort of build step that can potentially
7092generate a package or modify existing package, it is always a good idea
7093to re-generate the package index after the build by using the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007094command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007095
7096 $ bitbake package-index
7097
7098It might be tempting to build the
7099package and the package index at the same time with a command such as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007100the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007101
7102 $ bitbake some-package package-index
7103
7104Do not do this as
7105BitBake does not schedule the package index for after the completion of
7106the package you are building. Consequently, you cannot be sure of the
7107package index including information for the package you just built.
7108Thus, be sure to run the package update step separately after building
7109any packages.
7110
7111You can use the
7112:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`,
7113:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`,
7114and
7115:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
7116variables to pre-configure target images to use a package feed. If you
7117do not define these variables, then manual steps as described in the
7118subsequent sections are necessary to configure the target. You should
7119set these variables before building the image in order to produce a
7120correctly configured image.
7121
7122When your build is complete, your packages reside in the
7123``${TMPDIR}/deploy/packageformat`` directory. For example, if
7124``${``\ :term:`TMPDIR`\ ``}`` is
7125``tmp`` and your selected package type is RPM, then your RPM packages
7126are available in ``tmp/deploy/rpm``.
7127
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007128Host or Server Machine Setup
7129~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7130
7131Although other protocols are possible, a server using HTTP typically
7132serves packages. If you want to use HTTP, then set up and configure a
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007133web server such as Apache 2, lighttpd, or Python web server on the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007134machine serving the packages.
7135
7136To keep things simple, this section describes how to set up a
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007137Python web server to share package feeds from the developer's
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007138machine. Although this server might not be the best for a production
7139environment, the setup is simple and straight forward. Should you want
7140to use a different server more suited for production (e.g. Apache 2,
7141Lighttpd, or Nginx), take the appropriate steps to do so.
7142
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05007143From within the :term:`Build Directory` where you have built an image based on
7144your packaging choice (i.e. the :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` setting), simply start
7145the server. The following example assumes a :term:`Build Directory` of ``poky/build``
7146and a :term:`PACKAGE_CLASSES` setting of "package_rpm"::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007147
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -05007148 $ cd poky/build/tmp/deploy/rpm
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007149 $ python3 -m http.server
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007150
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007151Target Setup
7152~~~~~~~~~~~~
7153
7154Setting up the target differs depending on the package management
7155system. This section provides information for RPM, IPK, and DEB.
7156
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007157Using RPM
7158^^^^^^^^^
7159
7160The `Dandified Packaging
7161Tool <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/DNF_(software)>`__ (DNF) performs
7162runtime package management of RPM packages. In order to use DNF for
7163runtime package management, you must perform an initial setup on the
7164target machine for cases where the ``PACKAGE_FEED_*`` variables were not
7165set as part of the image that is running on the target. This means if
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05007166you built your image and did not use these variables as part of the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007167build and your image is now running on the target, you need to perform
7168the steps in this section if you want to use runtime package management.
7169
7170.. note::
7171
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007172 For information on the ``PACKAGE_FEED_*`` variables, see
7173 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`, :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`, and
7174 :term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS` in the Yocto Project Reference Manual variables
7175 glossary.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007176
7177On the target, you must inform DNF that package databases are available.
7178You do this by creating a file named
7179``/etc/yum.repos.d/oe-packages.repo`` and defining the ``oe-packages``.
7180
7181As an example, assume the target is able to use the following package
7182databases: ``all``, ``i586``, and ``qemux86`` from a server named
7183``my.server``. The specifics for setting up the web server are up to
7184you. The critical requirement is that the URIs in the target repository
7185configuration point to the correct remote location for the feeds.
7186
7187.. note::
7188
7189 For development purposes, you can point the web server to the build
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007190 system's ``deploy`` directory. However, for production use, it is better to
7191 copy the package directories to a location outside of the build area and use
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007192 that location. Doing so avoids situations where the build system
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007193 overwrites or changes the ``deploy`` directory.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007194
7195When telling DNF where to look for the package databases, you must
7196declare individual locations per architecture or a single location used
7197for all architectures. You cannot do both:
7198
7199- *Create an Explicit List of Architectures:* Define individual base
7200 URLs to identify where each package database is located:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007201
7202 .. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007203
7204 [oe-packages]
7205 baseurl=http://my.server/rpm/i586 http://my.server/rpm/qemux86 http://my.server/rpm/all
7206
7207 This example
7208 informs DNF about individual package databases for all three
7209 architectures.
7210
7211- *Create a Single (Full) Package Index:* Define a single base URL that
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007212 identifies where a full package database is located::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007213
7214 [oe-packages]
7215 baseurl=http://my.server/rpm
7216
7217 This example informs DNF about a single
7218 package database that contains all the package index information for
7219 all supported architectures.
7220
7221Once you have informed DNF where to find the package databases, you need
7222to fetch them:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007223
7224.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007225
7226 # dnf makecache
7227
7228DNF is now able to find, install, and
7229upgrade packages from the specified repository or repositories.
7230
7231.. note::
7232
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007233 See the `DNF documentation <https://dnf.readthedocs.io/en/latest/>`__ for
7234 additional information.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007235
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007236Using IPK
7237^^^^^^^^^
7238
7239The ``opkg`` application performs runtime package management of IPK
7240packages. You must perform an initial setup for ``opkg`` on the target
7241machine if the
7242:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`,
7243:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`,
7244and
7245:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
7246variables have not been set or the target image was built before the
7247variables were set.
7248
7249The ``opkg`` application uses configuration files to find available
7250package databases. Thus, you need to create a configuration file inside
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00007251the ``/etc/opkg/`` directory, which informs ``opkg`` of any repository
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007252you want to use.
7253
7254As an example, suppose you are serving packages from a ``ipk/``
7255directory containing the ``i586``, ``all``, and ``qemux86`` databases
7256through an HTTP server named ``my.server``. On the target, create a
7257configuration file (e.g. ``my_repo.conf``) inside the ``/etc/opkg/``
7258directory containing the following:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007259
7260.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007261
7262 src/gz all http://my.server/ipk/all
7263 src/gz i586 http://my.server/ipk/i586
7264 src/gz qemux86 http://my.server/ipk/qemux86
7265
7266Next, instruct ``opkg`` to fetch the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007267repository information:
7268
7269.. code-block:: none
7270
7271 # opkg update
7272
7273The ``opkg`` application is now able to find, install, and upgrade packages
7274from the specified repository.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007275
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007276Using DEB
7277^^^^^^^^^
7278
7279The ``apt`` application performs runtime package management of DEB
7280packages. This application uses a source list file to find available
7281package databases. You must perform an initial setup for ``apt`` on the
7282target machine if the
7283:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_ARCHS`,
7284:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_BASE_PATHS`,
7285and
7286:term:`PACKAGE_FEED_URIS`
7287variables have not been set or the target image was built before the
7288variables were set.
7289
7290To inform ``apt`` of the repository you want to use, you might create a
7291list file (e.g. ``my_repo.list``) inside the
7292``/etc/apt/sources.list.d/`` directory. As an example, suppose you are
7293serving packages from a ``deb/`` directory containing the ``i586``,
7294``all``, and ``qemux86`` databases through an HTTP server named
7295``my.server``. The list file should contain:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007296
7297.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007298
7299 deb http://my.server/deb/all ./
7300 deb http://my.server/deb/i586 ./
7301 deb http://my.server/deb/qemux86 ./
7302
7303Next, instruct the ``apt`` application
7304to fetch the repository information:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007305
7306.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007307
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05007308 $ sudo apt update
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007309
7310After this step,
7311``apt`` is able to find, install, and upgrade packages from the
7312specified repository.
7313
7314Generating and Using Signed Packages
7315------------------------------------
7316
7317In order to add security to RPM packages used during a build, you can
7318take steps to securely sign them. Once a signature is verified, the
7319OpenEmbedded build system can use the package in the build. If security
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00007320fails for a signed package, the build system stops the build.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007321
7322This section describes how to sign RPM packages during a build and how
7323to use signed package feeds (repositories) when doing a build.
7324
7325Signing RPM Packages
7326~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7327
7328To enable signing RPM packages, you must set up the following
7329configurations in either your ``local.config`` or ``distro.config``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007330file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007331
7332 # Inherit sign_rpm.bbclass to enable signing functionality
7333 INHERIT += " sign_rpm"
7334 # Define the GPG key that will be used for signing.
7335 RPM_GPG_NAME = "key_name"
7336 # Provide passphrase for the key
7337 RPM_GPG_PASSPHRASE = "passphrase"
7338
7339.. note::
7340
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007341 Be sure to supply appropriate values for both `key_name` and
7342 `passphrase`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007343
7344Aside from the ``RPM_GPG_NAME`` and ``RPM_GPG_PASSPHRASE`` variables in
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007345the previous example, two optional variables related to signing are available:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007346
7347- *GPG_BIN:* Specifies a ``gpg`` binary/wrapper that is executed
7348 when the package is signed.
7349
7350- *GPG_PATH:* Specifies the ``gpg`` home directory used when the
7351 package is signed.
7352
7353Processing Package Feeds
7354~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7355
7356In addition to being able to sign RPM packages, you can also enable
7357signed package feeds for IPK and RPM packages.
7358
7359The steps you need to take to enable signed package feed use are similar
7360to the steps used to sign RPM packages. You must define the following in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007361your ``local.config`` or ``distro.config`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007362
7363 INHERIT += "sign_package_feed"
7364 PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_NAME = "key_name"
7365 PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_PASSPHRASE_FILE = "path_to_file_containing_passphrase"
7366
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007367For signed package feeds, the passphrase must be specified in a separate file,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007368which is pointed to by the ``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_PASSPHRASE_FILE``
7369variable. Regarding security, keeping a plain text passphrase out of the
7370configuration is more secure.
7371
7372Aside from the ``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_NAME`` and
7373``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_PASSPHRASE_FILE`` variables, three optional variables
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007374related to signed package feeds are available:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007375
7376- *GPG_BIN* Specifies a ``gpg`` binary/wrapper that is executed
7377 when the package is signed.
7378
7379- *GPG_PATH:* Specifies the ``gpg`` home directory used when the
7380 package is signed.
7381
7382- *PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_SIGNATURE_TYPE:* Specifies the type of ``gpg``
7383 signature. This variable applies only to RPM and IPK package feeds.
7384 Allowable values for the ``PACKAGE_FEED_GPG_SIGNATURE_TYPE`` are
7385 "ASC", which is the default and specifies ascii armored, and "BIN",
7386 which specifies binary.
7387
7388Testing Packages With ptest
7389---------------------------
7390
7391A Package Test (ptest) runs tests against packages built by the
7392OpenEmbedded build system on the target machine. A ptest contains at
7393least two items: the actual test, and a shell script (``run-ptest``)
7394that starts the test. The shell script that starts the test must not
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007395contain the actual test --- the script only starts the test. On the other
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007396hand, the test can be anything from a simple shell script that runs a
7397binary and checks the output to an elaborate system of test binaries and
7398data files.
7399
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007400The test generates output in the format used by Automake::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007401
7402 result: testname
7403
7404where the result can be ``PASS``, ``FAIL``, or ``SKIP``, and
7405the testname can be any identifying string.
7406
7407For a list of Yocto Project recipes that are already enabled with ptest,
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06007408see the :yocto_wiki:`Ptest </Ptest>` wiki page.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007409
7410.. note::
7411
7412 A recipe is "ptest-enabled" if it inherits the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007413 :ref:`ptest <ref-classes-ptest>` class.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007414
7415Adding ptest to Your Build
7416~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7417
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05007418To add package testing to your build, add the :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES` and
7419:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` variables to your ``local.conf`` file, which
7420is found in the :term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007421
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007422 DISTRO_FEATURES:append = " ptest"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007423 EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES += "ptest-pkgs"
7424
7425Once your build is complete, the ptest files are installed into the
7426``/usr/lib/package/ptest`` directory within the image, where ``package``
7427is the name of the package.
7428
7429Running ptest
7430~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7431
7432The ``ptest-runner`` package installs a shell script that loops through
7433all installed ptest test suites and runs them in sequence. Consequently,
7434you might want to add this package to your image.
7435
7436Getting Your Package Ready
7437~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7438
7439In order to enable a recipe to run installed ptests on target hardware,
7440you need to prepare the recipes that build the packages you want to
7441test. Here is what you have to do for each recipe:
7442
7443- *Be sure the recipe inherits
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007444 the* :ref:`ptest <ref-classes-ptest>` *class:*
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007445 Include the following line in each recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007446
7447 inherit ptest
7448
7449- *Create run-ptest:* This script starts your test. Locate the
7450 script where you will refer to it using
7451 :term:`SRC_URI`. Here is an
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007452 example that starts a test for ``dbus``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007453
7454 #!/bin/sh
7455 cd test
7456 make -k runtest-TESTS
7457
7458- *Ensure dependencies are met:* If the test adds build or runtime
7459 dependencies that normally do not exist for the package (such as
7460 requiring "make" to run the test suite), use the
7461 :term:`DEPENDS` and
7462 :term:`RDEPENDS` variables in
7463 your recipe in order for the package to meet the dependencies. Here
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007464 is an example where the package has a runtime dependency on "make"::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007465
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007466 RDEPENDS:${PN}-ptest += "make"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007467
7468- *Add a function to build the test suite:* Not many packages support
7469 cross-compilation of their test suites. Consequently, you usually
7470 need to add a cross-compilation function to the package.
7471
7472 Many packages based on Automake compile and run the test suite by
7473 using a single command such as ``make check``. However, the host
7474 ``make check`` builds and runs on the same computer, while
7475 cross-compiling requires that the package is built on the host but
7476 executed for the target architecture (though often, as in the case
7477 for ptest, the execution occurs on the host). The built version of
7478 Automake that ships with the Yocto Project includes a patch that
7479 separates building and execution. Consequently, packages that use the
7480 unaltered, patched version of ``make check`` automatically
7481 cross-compiles.
7482
7483 Regardless, you still must add a ``do_compile_ptest`` function to
7484 build the test suite. Add a function similar to the following to your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007485 recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007486
7487 do_compile_ptest() {
7488 oe_runmake buildtest-TESTS
7489 }
7490
7491- *Ensure special configurations are set:* If the package requires
7492 special configurations prior to compiling the test code, you must
7493 insert a ``do_configure_ptest`` function into the recipe.
7494
7495- *Install the test suite:* The ``ptest`` class automatically copies
7496 the file ``run-ptest`` to the target and then runs make
7497 ``install-ptest`` to run the tests. If this is not enough, you need
7498 to create a ``do_install_ptest`` function and make sure it gets
7499 called after the "make install-ptest" completes.
7500
7501Creating Node Package Manager (NPM) Packages
7502--------------------------------------------
7503
7504`NPM <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Npm_(software)>`__ is a package
7505manager for the JavaScript programming language. The Yocto Project
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06007506supports the NPM :ref:`fetcher <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-fetching:fetchers>`. You can
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007507use this fetcher in combination with
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06007508:doc:`devtool </ref-manual/devtool-reference>` to create
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007509recipes that produce NPM packages.
7510
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007511There are two workflows that allow you to create NPM packages using
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007512``devtool``: the NPM registry modules method and the NPM project code
7513method.
7514
7515.. note::
7516
7517 While it is possible to create NPM recipes manually, using
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007518 ``devtool`` is far simpler.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007519
7520Additionally, some requirements and caveats exist.
7521
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007522Requirements and Caveats
7523~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7524
7525You need to be aware of the following before using ``devtool`` to create
7526NPM packages:
7527
7528- Of the two methods that you can use ``devtool`` to create NPM
7529 packages, the registry approach is slightly simpler. However, you
7530 might consider the project approach because you do not have to
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05007531 publish your module in the `NPM registry <https://docs.npmjs.com/misc/registry>`__,
7532 which is NPM's public registry.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007533
7534- Be familiar with
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06007535 :doc:`devtool </ref-manual/devtool-reference>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007536
7537- The NPM host tools need the native ``nodejs-npm`` package, which is
7538 part of the OpenEmbedded environment. You need to get the package by
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05007539 cloning the :oe_git:`meta-openembedded </meta-openembedded>`
7540 repository. Be sure to add the path to your local copy
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007541 to your ``bblayers.conf`` file.
7542
7543- ``devtool`` cannot detect native libraries in module dependencies.
7544 Consequently, you must manually add packages to your recipe.
7545
7546- While deploying NPM packages, ``devtool`` cannot determine which
7547 dependent packages are missing on the target (e.g. the node runtime
7548 ``nodejs``). Consequently, you need to find out what files are
7549 missing and be sure they are on the target.
7550
7551- Although you might not need NPM to run your node package, it is
7552 useful to have NPM on your target. The NPM package name is
7553 ``nodejs-npm``.
7554
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007555Using the Registry Modules Method
7556~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7557
7558This section presents an example that uses the ``cute-files`` module,
7559which is a file browser web application.
7560
7561.. note::
7562
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007563 You must know the ``cute-files`` module version.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007564
7565The first thing you need to do is use ``devtool`` and the NPM fetcher to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007566create the recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007567
7568 $ devtool add "npm://registry.npmjs.org;package=cute-files;version=1.0.2"
7569
7570The
7571``devtool add`` command runs ``recipetool create`` and uses the same
7572fetch URI to download each dependency and capture license details where
7573possible. The result is a generated recipe.
7574
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007575After running for quite a long time, in particular building the
7576``nodejs-native`` package, the command should end as follows::
7577
7578 INFO: Recipe /home/.../build/workspace/recipes/cute-files/cute-files_1.0.2.bb has been automatically created; further editing may be required to make it fully functional
7579
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007580The recipe file is fairly simple and contains every license that
7581``recipetool`` finds and includes the licenses in the recipe's
7582:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
7583variables. You need to examine the variables and look for those with
7584"unknown" in the :term:`LICENSE`
7585field. You need to track down the license information for "unknown"
7586modules and manually add the information to the recipe.
7587
7588``recipetool`` creates a "shrinkwrap" file for your recipe. Shrinkwrap
7589files capture the version of all dependent modules. Many packages do not
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007590provide shrinkwrap files but ``recipetool`` will create a shrinkwrap file as it
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007591runs.
7592
7593.. note::
7594
7595 A package is created for each sub-module. This policy is the only
7596 practical way to have the licenses for all of the dependencies
7597 represented in the license manifest of the image.
7598
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007599The ``devtool edit-recipe`` command lets you take a look at the recipe::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007600
7601 $ devtool edit-recipe cute-files
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007602 # Recipe created by recipetool
7603 # This is the basis of a recipe and may need further editing in order to be fully functional.
7604 # (Feel free to remove these comments when editing.)
7605
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007606 SUMMARY = "Turn any folder on your computer into a cute file browser, available on the local network."
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007607 # WARNING: the following LICENSE and LIC_FILES_CHKSUM values are best guesses - it is
7608 # your responsibility to verify that the values are complete and correct.
7609 #
7610 # NOTE: multiple licenses have been detected; they have been separated with &
7611 # in the LICENSE value for now since it is a reasonable assumption that all
7612 # of the licenses apply. If instead there is a choice between the multiple
7613 # licenses then you should change the value to separate the licenses with |
7614 # instead of &. If there is any doubt, check the accompanying documentation
7615 # to determine which situation is applicable.
7616
7617 SUMMARY = "Turn any folder on your computer into a cute file browser, available on the local network."
7618 LICENSE = "BSD-3-Clause & ISC & MIT"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007619 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://LICENSE;md5=71d98c0a1db42956787b1909c74a86ca \
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007620 file://node_modules/accepts/LICENSE;md5=bf1f9ad1e2e1d507aef4883fff7103de \
7621 file://node_modules/array-flatten/LICENSE;md5=44088ba57cb871a58add36ce51b8de08 \
7622 ...
7623 file://node_modules/cookie-signature/Readme.md;md5=57ae8b42de3dd0c1f22d5f4cf191e15a"
7624
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007625 SRC_URI = " \
7626 npm://registry.npmjs.org/;package=cute-files;version=${PV} \
7627 npmsw://${THISDIR}/${BPN}/npm-shrinkwrap.json \
7628 "
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007629
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007630 S = "${WORKDIR}/npm"
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007631
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -05007632 inherit npm
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007633
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007634 LICENSE:${PN} = "MIT"
7635 LICENSE:${PN}-accepts = "MIT"
7636 LICENSE:${PN}-array-flatten = "MIT"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007637 ...
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007638 LICENSE:${PN}-vary = "MIT"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007639
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007640Here are three key points in the previous example:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007641
7642- :term:`SRC_URI` uses the NPM
7643 scheme so that the NPM fetcher is used.
7644
7645- ``recipetool`` collects all the license information. If a
7646 sub-module's license is unavailable, the sub-module's name appears in
7647 the comments.
7648
7649- The ``inherit npm`` statement causes the
7650 :ref:`npm <ref-classes-npm>` class to package
7651 up all the modules.
7652
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007653You can run the following command to build the ``cute-files`` package::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007654
7655 $ devtool build cute-files
7656
7657Remember that ``nodejs`` must be installed on
7658the target before your package.
7659
7660Assuming 192.168.7.2 for the target's IP address, use the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007661command to deploy your package::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007662
7663 $ devtool deploy-target -s cute-files root@192.168.7.2
7664
7665Once the package is installed on the target, you can
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007666test the application to show the contents of any directory::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007667
7668 $ cd /usr/lib/node_modules/cute-files
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007669 $ cute-files
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007670
7671On a browser,
7672go to ``http://192.168.7.2:3000`` and you see the following:
7673
7674.. image:: figures/cute-files-npm-example.png
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05007675 :width: 100%
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007676
7677You can find the recipe in ``workspace/recipes/cute-files``. You can use
7678the recipe in any layer you choose.
7679
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007680Using the NPM Projects Code Method
7681~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
7682
7683Although it is useful to package modules already in the NPM registry,
7684adding ``node.js`` projects under development is a more common developer
7685use case.
7686
7687This section covers the NPM projects code method, which is very similar
7688to the "registry" approach described in the previous section. In the NPM
7689projects method, you provide ``devtool`` with an URL that points to the
7690source files.
7691
7692Replicating the same example, (i.e. ``cute-files``) use the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007693command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007694
7695 $ devtool add https://github.com/martinaglv/cute-files.git
7696
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007697The recipe this command generates is very similar to the recipe created in
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05007698the previous section. However, the :term:`SRC_URI` looks like the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007699
7700 SRC_URI = " \
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05007701 git://github.com/martinaglv/cute-files.git;protocol=https;branch=master \
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007702 npmsw://${THISDIR}/${BPN}/npm-shrinkwrap.json \
7703 "
7704
7705In this example,
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007706the main module is taken from the Git repository and dependencies are
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007707taken from the NPM registry. Other than those differences, the recipe is
7708basically the same between the two methods. You can build and deploy the
7709package exactly as described in the previous section that uses the
7710registry modules method.
7711
7712Adding custom metadata to packages
7713----------------------------------
7714
7715The variable
7716:term:`PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA`
7717can be used to add additional metadata to packages. This is reflected in
7718the package control/spec file. To take the ipk format for example, the
7719CONTROL file stored inside would contain the additional metadata as
7720additional lines.
7721
7722The variable can be used in multiple ways, including using suffixes to
7723set it for a specific package type and/or package. Note that the order
7724of precedence is the same as this list:
7725
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007726- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_<PKGTYPE>:<PN>``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007727
7728- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_<PKGTYPE>``
7729
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007730- ``PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA:<PN>``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007731
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05007732- :term:`PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007733
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007734`<PKGTYPE>` is a parameter and expected to be a distinct name of specific
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007735package type:
7736
7737- IPK for .ipk packages
7738
7739- DEB for .deb packages
7740
7741- RPM for .rpm packages
7742
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007743`<PN>` is a parameter and expected to be a package name.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007744
7745The variable can contain multiple [one-line] metadata fields separated
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007746by the literal sequence '\\n'. The separator can be redefined using the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007747variable flag ``separator``.
7748
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007749Here is an example that adds two custom fields for ipk
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007750packages::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007751
7752 PACKAGE_ADD_METADATA_IPK = "Vendor: CustomIpk\nGroup:Applications/Spreadsheets"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007753
7754Efficiently Fetching Source Files During a Build
7755================================================
7756
7757The OpenEmbedded build system works with source files located through
7758the :term:`SRC_URI` variable. When
7759you build something using BitBake, a big part of the operation is
7760locating and downloading all the source tarballs. For images,
7761downloading all the source for various packages can take a significant
7762amount of time.
7763
7764This section shows you how you can use mirrors to speed up fetching
7765source files and how you can pre-fetch files all of which leads to more
7766efficient use of resources and time.
7767
7768Setting up Effective Mirrors
7769----------------------------
7770
7771A good deal that goes into a Yocto Project build is simply downloading
7772all of the source tarballs. Maybe you have been working with another
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00007773build system for which you have built up a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007774sizable directory of source tarballs. Or, perhaps someone else has such
7775a directory for which you have read access. If so, you can save time by
7776adding statements to your configuration file so that the build process
7777checks local directories first for existing tarballs before checking the
7778Internet.
7779
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007780Here is an efficient way to set it up in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007781
7782 SOURCE_MIRROR_URL ?= "file:///home/you/your-download-dir/"
7783 INHERIT += "own-mirrors"
7784 BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS = "1"
7785 # BB_NO_NETWORK = "1"
7786
7787In the previous example, the
7788:term:`BB_GENERATE_MIRROR_TARBALLS`
7789variable causes the OpenEmbedded build system to generate tarballs of
7790the Git repositories and store them in the
7791:term:`DL_DIR` directory. Due to
7792performance reasons, generating and storing these tarballs is not the
7793build system's default behavior.
7794
7795You can also use the
7796:term:`PREMIRRORS` variable. For
7797an example, see the variable's glossary entry in the Yocto Project
7798Reference Manual.
7799
7800Getting Source Files and Suppressing the Build
7801----------------------------------------------
7802
7803Another technique you can use to ready yourself for a successive string
7804of build operations, is to pre-fetch all the source files without
7805actually starting a build. This technique lets you work through any
7806download issues and ultimately gathers all the source files into your
7807download directory :ref:`structure-build-downloads`,
7808which is located with :term:`DL_DIR`.
7809
7810Use the following BitBake command form to fetch all the necessary
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007811sources without starting the build::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007812
7813 $ bitbake target --runall=fetch
7814
7815This
7816variation of the BitBake command guarantees that you have all the
7817sources for that BitBake target should you disconnect from the Internet
7818and want to do the build later offline.
7819
7820Selecting an Initialization Manager
7821===================================
7822
7823By default, the Yocto Project uses SysVinit as the initialization
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07007824manager. However, there is also support for systemd, which is a full
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007825replacement for init with parallel starting of services, reduced shell
7826overhead and other features that are used by many distributions.
7827
7828Within the system, SysVinit treats system components as services. These
7829services are maintained as shell scripts stored in the ``/etc/init.d/``
7830directory. Services organize into different run levels. This
7831organization is maintained by putting links to the services in the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007832``/etc/rcN.d/`` directories, where `N/` is one of the following options:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007833"S", "0", "1", "2", "3", "4", "5", or "6".
7834
7835.. note::
7836
7837 Each runlevel has a dependency on the previous runlevel. This
7838 dependency allows the services to work properly.
7839
7840In comparison, systemd treats components as units. Using units is a
7841broader concept as compared to using a service. A unit includes several
7842different types of entities. Service is one of the types of entities.
7843The runlevel concept in SysVinit corresponds to the concept of a target
7844in systemd, where target is also a type of supported unit.
7845
7846In a SysVinit-based system, services load sequentially (i.e. one by one)
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05007847during init and parallelization is not supported. With systemd, services
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007848start in parallel. Needless to say, the method can have an impact on
7849system startup performance.
7850
7851If you want to use SysVinit, you do not have to do anything. But, if you
7852want to use systemd, you must take some steps as described in the
7853following sections.
7854
7855Using systemd Exclusively
7856-------------------------
7857
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007858Set these variables in your distribution configuration file as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007859
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007860 DISTRO_FEATURES:append = " systemd"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007861 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_init_manager = "systemd"
7862
7863You can also prevent the SysVinit distribution feature from
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007864being automatically enabled as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007865
7866 DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED = "sysvinit"
7867
7868Doing so removes any
7869redundant SysVinit scripts.
7870
7871To remove initscripts from your image altogether, set this variable
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007872also::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007873
7874 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_initscripts = ""
7875
7876For information on the backfill variable, see
7877:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES_BACKFILL_CONSIDERED`.
7878
7879Using systemd for the Main Image and Using SysVinit for the Rescue Image
7880------------------------------------------------------------------------
7881
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007882Set these variables in your distribution configuration file as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007883
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007884 DISTRO_FEATURES:append = " systemd"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007885 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_init_manager = "systemd"
7886
7887Doing so causes your main image to use the
7888``packagegroup-core-boot.bb`` recipe and systemd. The rescue/minimal
7889image cannot use this package group. However, it can install SysVinit
7890and the appropriate packages will have support for both systemd and
7891SysVinit.
7892
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00007893Using systemd-journald without a traditional syslog daemon
7894----------------------------------------------------------
7895
7896Counter-intuitively, ``systemd-journald`` is not a syslog runtime or provider,
7897and the proper way to use systemd-journald as your sole logging mechanism is to
7898effectively disable syslog entirely by setting these variables in your distribution
7899configuration file::
7900
7901 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_syslog = ""
7902 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_base-utils-syslog = ""
7903
7904Doing so will prevent ``rsyslog`` / ``busybox-syslog`` from being pulled in by
7905default, leaving only ``journald``.
7906
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007907Selecting a Device Manager
7908==========================
7909
7910The Yocto Project provides multiple ways to manage the device manager
7911(``/dev``):
7912
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05007913- Persistent and Pre-Populated ``/dev``: For this case, the ``/dev``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007914 directory is persistent and the required device nodes are created
7915 during the build.
7916
7917- Use ``devtmpfs`` with a Device Manager: For this case, the ``/dev``
7918 directory is provided by the kernel as an in-memory file system and
7919 is automatically populated by the kernel at runtime. Additional
7920 configuration of device nodes is done in user space by a device
7921 manager like ``udev`` or ``busybox-mdev``.
7922
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -05007923Using Persistent and Pre-Populated ``/dev``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007924--------------------------------------------
7925
7926To use the static method for device population, you need to set the
7927:term:`USE_DEVFS` variable to "0"
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007928as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007929
7930 USE_DEVFS = "0"
7931
7932The content of the resulting ``/dev`` directory is defined in a Device
7933Table file. The
7934:term:`IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES`
7935variable defines the Device Table to use and should be set in the
7936machine or distro configuration file. Alternatively, you can set this
7937variable in your ``local.conf`` configuration file.
7938
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05007939If you do not define the :term:`IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES` variable, the default
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007940``device_table-minimal.txt`` is used::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007941
7942 IMAGE_DEVICE_TABLES = "device_table-mymachine.txt"
7943
7944The population is handled by the ``makedevs`` utility during image
7945creation:
7946
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007947Using ``devtmpfs`` and a Device Manager
7948---------------------------------------
7949
7950To use the dynamic method for device population, you need to use (or be
7951sure to set) the :term:`USE_DEVFS`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007952variable to "1", which is the default::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007953
7954 USE_DEVFS = "1"
7955
7956With this
7957setting, the resulting ``/dev`` directory is populated by the kernel
7958using ``devtmpfs``. Make sure the corresponding kernel configuration
7959variable ``CONFIG_DEVTMPFS`` is set when building you build a Linux
7960kernel.
7961
7962All devices created by ``devtmpfs`` will be owned by ``root`` and have
7963permissions ``0600``.
7964
7965To have more control over the device nodes, you can use a device manager
7966like ``udev`` or ``busybox-mdev``. You choose the device manager by
7967defining the ``VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager`` variable in your machine or
7968distro configuration file. Alternatively, you can set this variable in
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007969your ``local.conf`` configuration file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007970
7971 VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "udev"
7972
7973 # Some alternative values
7974 # VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "busybox-mdev"
7975 # VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_dev_manager = "systemd"
7976
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007977Using an External SCM
7978=====================
7979
7980If you're working on a recipe that pulls from an external Source Code
7981Manager (SCM), it is possible to have the OpenEmbedded build system
7982notice new recipe changes added to the SCM and then build the resulting
7983packages that depend on the new recipes by using the latest versions.
7984This only works for SCMs from which it is possible to get a sensible
7985revision number for changes. Currently, you can do this with Apache
7986Subversion (SVN), Git, and Bazaar (BZR) repositories.
7987
7988To enable this behavior, the :term:`PV` of
7989the recipe needs to reference
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007990:term:`SRCPV`. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007991
7992 PV = "1.2.3+git${SRCPV}"
7993
7994Then, you can add the following to your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05007995``local.conf``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007996
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05007997 SRCREV:pn-PN = "${AUTOREV}"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05007998
7999:term:`PN` is the name of the recipe for
8000which you want to enable automatic source revision updating.
8001
8002If you do not want to update your local configuration file, you can add
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008003the following directly to the recipe to finish enabling the feature::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008004
8005 SRCREV = "${AUTOREV}"
8006
8007The Yocto Project provides a distribution named ``poky-bleeding``, whose
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008008configuration file contains the line::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008009
8010 require conf/distro/include/poky-floating-revisions.inc
8011
8012This line pulls in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008013listed include file that contains numerous lines of exactly that form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008014
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05008015 #SRCREV:pn-opkg-native ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8016 #SRCREV:pn-opkg-sdk ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8017 #SRCREV:pn-opkg ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8018 #SRCREV:pn-opkg-utils-native ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8019 #SRCREV:pn-opkg-utils ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8020 SRCREV:pn-gconf-dbus ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8021 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-common ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8022 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-config-gtk ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8023 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-desktop ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8024 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-keyboard ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8025 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-panel-2 ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8026 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-themes-extra ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8027 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-terminal ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8028 SRCREV:pn-matchbox-wm ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8029 SRCREV:pn-settings-daemon ?= "${AUTOREV}"
8030 SRCREV:pn-screenshot ?= "${AUTOREV}"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008031 . . .
8032
8033These lines allow you to
8034experiment with building a distribution that tracks the latest
8035development source for numerous packages.
8036
8037.. note::
8038
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008039 The ``poky-bleeding`` distribution is not tested on a regular basis. Keep
8040 this in mind if you use it.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008041
8042Creating a Read-Only Root Filesystem
8043====================================
8044
8045Suppose, for security reasons, you need to disable your target device's
8046root filesystem's write permissions (i.e. you need a read-only root
8047filesystem). Or, perhaps you are running the device's operating system
8048from a read-only storage device. For either case, you can customize your
8049image for that behavior.
8050
8051.. note::
8052
8053 Supporting a read-only root filesystem requires that the system and
8054 applications do not try to write to the root filesystem. You must
8055 configure all parts of the target system to write elsewhere, or to
8056 gracefully fail in the event of attempting to write to the root
8057 filesystem.
8058
8059Creating the Root Filesystem
8060----------------------------
8061
8062To create the read-only root filesystem, simply add the
8063"read-only-rootfs" feature to your image, normally in one of two ways.
8064The first way is to add the "read-only-rootfs" image feature in the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008065image's recipe file via the :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` variable::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008066
8067 IMAGE_FEATURES += "read-only-rootfs"
8068
8069As an alternative, you can add the same feature
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05008070from within your :term:`Build Directory`'s ``local.conf`` file with the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008071associated :term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES` variable, as in::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008072
8073 EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES = "read-only-rootfs"
8074
8075For more information on how to use these variables, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008076":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:Customizing Images Using Custom \`\`IMAGE_FEATURES\`\` and \`\`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES\`\``"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008077section. For information on the variables, see
8078:term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` and
8079:term:`EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES`.
8080
8081Post-Installation Scripts and Read-Only Root Filesystem
8082-------------------------------------------------------
8083
8084It is very important that you make sure all post-Installation
8085(``pkg_postinst``) scripts for packages that are installed into the
8086image can be run at the time when the root filesystem is created during
8087the build on the host system. These scripts cannot attempt to run during
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05008088the first boot on the target device. With the "read-only-rootfs" feature
8089enabled, the build system makes sure that all post-installation scripts
8090succeed at file system creation time. If any of these scripts
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008091still need to be run after the root filesystem is created, the build
8092immediately fails. These build-time checks ensure that the build fails
8093rather than the target device fails later during its initial boot
8094operation.
8095
8096Most of the common post-installation scripts generated by the build
8097system for the out-of-the-box Yocto Project are engineered so that they
8098can run during root filesystem creation (e.g. post-installation scripts
8099for caching fonts). However, if you create and add custom scripts, you
8100need to be sure they can be run during this file system creation.
8101
8102Here are some common problems that prevent post-installation scripts
8103from running during root filesystem creation:
8104
8105- *Not using $D in front of absolute paths:* The build system defines
8106 ``$``\ :term:`D` when the root
8107 filesystem is created. Furthermore, ``$D`` is blank when the script
8108 is run on the target device. This implies two purposes for ``$D``:
8109 ensuring paths are valid in both the host and target environments,
8110 and checking to determine which environment is being used as a method
8111 for taking appropriate actions.
8112
8113- *Attempting to run processes that are specific to or dependent on the
8114 target architecture:* You can work around these attempts by using
8115 native tools, which run on the host system, to accomplish the same
8116 tasks, or by alternatively running the processes under QEMU, which
8117 has the ``qemu_run_binary`` function. For more information, see the
8118 :ref:`qemu <ref-classes-qemu>` class.
8119
8120Areas With Write Access
8121-----------------------
8122
8123With the "read-only-rootfs" feature enabled, any attempt by the target
8124to write to the root filesystem at runtime fails. Consequently, you must
8125make sure that you configure processes and applications that attempt
8126these types of writes do so to directories with write access (e.g.
8127``/tmp`` or ``/var/run``).
8128
8129Maintaining Build Output Quality
8130================================
8131
8132Many factors can influence the quality of a build. For example, if you
8133upgrade a recipe to use a new version of an upstream software package or
8134you experiment with some new configuration options, subtle changes can
8135occur that you might not detect until later. Consider the case where
8136your recipe is using a newer version of an upstream package. In this
8137case, a new version of a piece of software might introduce an optional
8138dependency on another library, which is auto-detected. If that library
8139has already been built when the software is building, the software will
8140link to the built library and that library will be pulled into your
8141image along with the new software even if you did not want the library.
8142
8143The :ref:`buildhistory <ref-classes-buildhistory>`
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008144class helps you maintain the quality of your build output. You
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008145can use the class to highlight unexpected and possibly unwanted changes
8146in the build output. When you enable build history, it records
8147information about the contents of each package and image and then
8148commits that information to a local Git repository where you can examine
8149the information.
8150
8151The remainder of this section describes the following:
8152
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008153- :ref:`How you can enable and disable build history <dev-manual/common-tasks:enabling and disabling build history>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008154
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008155- :ref:`How to understand what the build history contains <dev-manual/common-tasks:understanding what the build history contains>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008156
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008157- :ref:`How to limit the information used for build history <dev-manual/common-tasks:using build history to gather image information only>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008158
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008159- :ref:`How to examine the build history from both a command-line and web interface <dev-manual/common-tasks:examining build history information>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008160
8161Enabling and Disabling Build History
8162------------------------------------
8163
8164Build history is disabled by default. To enable it, add the following
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05008165:term:`INHERIT` statement and set the :term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` variable to
8166"1" at the end of your ``conf/local.conf`` file found in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008167:term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008168
8169 INHERIT += "buildhistory"
8170 BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "1"
8171
8172Enabling build history as
8173previously described causes the OpenEmbedded build system to collect
8174build output information and commit it as a single commit to a local
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008175:ref:`overview-manual/development-environment:git` repository.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008176
8177.. note::
8178
8179 Enabling build history increases your build times slightly,
8180 particularly for images, and increases the amount of disk space used
8181 during the build.
8182
8183You can disable build history by removing the previous statements from
8184your ``conf/local.conf`` file.
8185
8186Understanding What the Build History Contains
8187---------------------------------------------
8188
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05008189Build history information is kept in ``${``\ :term:`TOPDIR`\ ``}/buildhistory``
8190in the :term:`Build Directory` as defined by the :term:`BUILDHISTORY_DIR`
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008191variable. Here is an example abbreviated listing:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008192
8193.. image:: figures/buildhistory.png
8194 :align: center
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05008195 :width: 50%
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008196
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008197At the top level, there is a ``metadata-revs`` file that lists the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008198revisions of the repositories for the enabled layers when the build was
8199produced. The rest of the data splits into separate ``packages``,
8200``images`` and ``sdk`` directories, the contents of which are described
8201as follows.
8202
8203Build History Package Information
8204~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8205
8206The history for each package contains a text file that has name-value
8207pairs with information about the package. For example,
8208``buildhistory/packages/i586-poky-linux/busybox/busybox/latest``
8209contains the following:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008210
8211.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008212
8213 PV = 1.22.1
8214 PR = r32
8215 RPROVIDES =
8216 RDEPENDS = glibc (>= 2.20) update-alternatives-opkg
8217 RRECOMMENDS = busybox-syslog busybox-udhcpc update-rc.d
8218 PKGSIZE = 540168
8219 FILES = /usr/bin/* /usr/sbin/* /usr/lib/busybox/* /usr/lib/lib*.so.* \
8220 /etc /com /var /bin/* /sbin/* /lib/*.so.* /lib/udev/rules.d \
8221 /usr/lib/udev/rules.d /usr/share/busybox /usr/lib/busybox/* \
8222 /usr/share/pixmaps /usr/share/applications /usr/share/idl \
8223 /usr/share/omf /usr/share/sounds /usr/lib/bonobo/servers
8224 FILELIST = /bin/busybox /bin/busybox.nosuid /bin/busybox.suid /bin/sh \
8225 /etc/busybox.links.nosuid /etc/busybox.links.suid
8226
8227Most of these
8228name-value pairs correspond to variables used to produce the package.
8229The exceptions are ``FILELIST``, which is the actual list of files in
8230the package, and ``PKGSIZE``, which is the total size of files in the
8231package in bytes.
8232
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008233There is also a file that corresponds to the recipe from which the package
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008234came (e.g. ``buildhistory/packages/i586-poky-linux/busybox/latest``):
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008235
8236.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008237
8238 PV = 1.22.1
8239 PR = r32
8240 DEPENDS = initscripts kern-tools-native update-rc.d-native \
8241 virtual/i586-poky-linux-compilerlibs virtual/i586-poky-linux-gcc \
8242 virtual/libc virtual/update-alternatives
8243 PACKAGES = busybox-ptest busybox-httpd busybox-udhcpd busybox-udhcpc \
8244 busybox-syslog busybox-mdev busybox-hwclock busybox-dbg \
8245 busybox-staticdev busybox-dev busybox-doc busybox-locale busybox
8246
8247Finally, for those recipes fetched from a version control system (e.g.,
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008248Git), there is a file that lists source revisions that are specified in
8249the recipe and the actual revisions used during the build. Listed
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008250and actual revisions might differ when
8251:term:`SRCREV` is set to
8252${:term:`AUTOREV`}. Here is an
8253example assuming
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008254``buildhistory/packages/qemux86-poky-linux/linux-yocto/latest_srcrev``)::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008255
8256 # SRCREV_machine = "38cd560d5022ed2dbd1ab0dca9642e47c98a0aa1"
8257 SRCREV_machine = "38cd560d5022ed2dbd1ab0dca9642e47c98a0aa1"
8258 # SRCREV_meta = "a227f20eff056e511d504b2e490f3774ab260d6f"
8259 SRCREV_meta ="a227f20eff056e511d504b2e490f3774ab260d6f"
8260
8261You can use the
8262``buildhistory-collect-srcrevs`` command with the ``-a`` option to
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008263collect the stored :term:`SRCREV` values from build history and report them
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008264in a format suitable for use in global configuration (e.g.,
8265``local.conf`` or a distro include file) to override floating
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008266:term:`AUTOREV` values to a fixed set of revisions. Here is some example
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008267output from this command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008268
8269 $ buildhistory-collect-srcrevs -a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008270 # all-poky-linux
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00008271 SRCREV:pn-ca-certificates = "07de54fdcc5806bde549e1edf60738c6bccf50e8"
8272 SRCREV:pn-update-rc.d = "8636cf478d426b568c1be11dbd9346f67e03adac"
8273 # core2-64-poky-linux
8274 SRCREV:pn-binutils = "87d4632d36323091e731eb07b8aa65f90293da66"
8275 SRCREV:pn-btrfs-tools = "8ad326b2f28c044cb6ed9016d7c3285e23b673c8"
8276 SRCREV_bzip2-tests:pn-bzip2 = "f9061c030a25de5b6829e1abf373057309c734c0"
8277 SRCREV:pn-e2fsprogs = "02540dedd3ddc52c6ae8aaa8a95ce75c3f8be1c0"
8278 SRCREV:pn-file = "504206e53a89fd6eed71aeaf878aa3512418eab1"
8279 SRCREV_glibc:pn-glibc = "24962427071fa532c3c48c918e9d64d719cc8a6c"
8280 SRCREV:pn-gnome-desktop-testing = "e346cd4ed2e2102c9b195b614f3c642d23f5f6e7"
8281 SRCREV:pn-init-system-helpers = "dbd9197569c0935029acd5c9b02b84c68fd937ee"
8282 SRCREV:pn-kmod = "b6ecfc916a17eab8f93be5b09f4e4f845aabd3d1"
8283 SRCREV:pn-libnsl2 = "82245c0c58add79a8e34ab0917358217a70e5100"
8284 SRCREV:pn-libseccomp = "57357d2741a3b3d3e8425889a6b79a130e0fa2f3"
8285 SRCREV:pn-libxcrypt = "50cf2b6dd4fdf04309445f2eec8de7051d953abf"
8286 SRCREV:pn-ncurses = "51d0fd9cc3edb975f04224f29f777f8f448e8ced"
8287 SRCREV:pn-procps = "19a508ea121c0c4ac6d0224575a036de745eaaf8"
8288 SRCREV:pn-psmisc = "5fab6b7ab385080f1db725d6803136ec1841a15f"
8289 SRCREV:pn-ptest-runner = "bcb82804daa8f725b6add259dcef2067e61a75aa"
8290 SRCREV:pn-shared-mime-info = "18e558fa1c8b90b86757ade09a4ba4d6a6cf8f70"
8291 SRCREV:pn-zstd = "e47e674cd09583ff0503f0f6defd6d23d8b718d3"
8292 # qemux86_64-poky-linux
8293 SRCREV_machine:pn-linux-yocto = "20301aeb1a64164b72bc72af58802b315e025c9c"
8294 SRCREV_meta:pn-linux-yocto = "2d38a472b21ae343707c8bd64ac68a9eaca066a0"
8295 # x86_64-linux
8296 SRCREV:pn-binutils-cross-x86_64 = "87d4632d36323091e731eb07b8aa65f90293da66"
8297 SRCREV_glibc:pn-cross-localedef-native = "24962427071fa532c3c48c918e9d64d719cc8a6c"
8298 SRCREV_localedef:pn-cross-localedef-native = "794da69788cbf9bf57b59a852f9f11307663fa87"
8299 SRCREV:pn-debianutils-native = "de14223e5bffe15e374a441302c528ffc1cbed57"
8300 SRCREV:pn-libmodulemd-native = "ee80309bc766d781a144e6879419b29f444d94eb"
8301 SRCREV:pn-virglrenderer-native = "363915595e05fb252e70d6514be2f0c0b5ca312b"
8302 SRCREV:pn-zstd-native = "e47e674cd09583ff0503f0f6defd6d23d8b718d3"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008303
8304.. note::
8305
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008306 Here are some notes on using the ``buildhistory-collect-srcrevs`` command:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008307
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008308 - By default, only values where the :term:`SRCREV` was not hardcoded
Andrew Geissler5f350902021-07-23 13:09:54 -04008309 (usually when :term:`AUTOREV` is used) are reported. Use the ``-a``
8310 option to see all :term:`SRCREV` values.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008311
8312 - The output statements might not have any effect if overrides are
8313 applied elsewhere in the build system configuration. Use the
8314 ``-f`` option to add the ``forcevariable`` override to each output
8315 line if you need to work around this restriction.
8316
8317 - The script does apply special handling when building for multiple
8318 machines. However, the script does place a comment before each set
8319 of values that specifies which triplet to which they belong as
8320 previously shown (e.g., ``i586-poky-linux``).
8321
8322Build History Image Information
8323~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8324
8325The files produced for each image are as follows:
8326
8327- ``image-files:`` A directory containing selected files from the root
8328 filesystem. The files are defined by
8329 :term:`BUILDHISTORY_IMAGE_FILES`.
8330
8331- ``build-id.txt:`` Human-readable information about the build
8332 configuration and metadata source revisions. This file contains the
8333 full build header as printed by BitBake.
8334
8335- ``*.dot:`` Dependency graphs for the image that are compatible with
8336 ``graphviz``.
8337
8338- ``files-in-image.txt:`` A list of files in the image with
8339 permissions, owner, group, size, and symlink information.
8340
8341- ``image-info.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs with
8342 information about the image. See the following listing example for
8343 more information.
8344
8345- ``installed-package-names.txt:`` A list of installed packages by name
8346 only.
8347
8348- ``installed-package-sizes.txt:`` A list of installed packages ordered
8349 by size.
8350
8351- ``installed-packages.txt:`` A list of installed packages with full
8352 package filenames.
8353
8354.. note::
8355
8356 Installed package information is able to be gathered and produced
8357 even if package management is disabled for the final image.
8358
8359Here is an example of ``image-info.txt``:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008360
8361.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008362
8363 DISTRO = poky
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00008364 DISTRO_VERSION = 3.4+snapshot-a0245d7be08f3d24ea1875e9f8872aa6bbff93be
8365 USER_CLASSES = buildstats
8366 IMAGE_CLASSES = qemuboot qemuboot license_image
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008367 IMAGE_FEATURES = debug-tweaks
8368 IMAGE_LINGUAS =
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00008369 IMAGE_INSTALL = packagegroup-core-boot speex speexdsp
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008370 BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS =
8371 NO_RECOMMENDATIONS =
8372 PACKAGE_EXCLUDE =
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +00008373 ROOTFS_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND = write_package_manifest; license_create_manifest; cve_check_write_rootfs_manifest; ssh_allow_empty_password; ssh_allow_root_login; postinst_enable_logging; rootfs_update_timestamp; write_image_test_data; empty_var_volatile; sort_passwd; rootfs_reproducible;
8374 IMAGE_POSTPROCESS_COMMAND = buildhistory_get_imageinfo ;
8375 IMAGESIZE = 9265
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008376
8377Other than ``IMAGESIZE``,
8378which is the total size of the files in the image in Kbytes, the
8379name-value pairs are variables that may have influenced the content of
8380the image. This information is often useful when you are trying to
8381determine why a change in the package or file listings has occurred.
8382
8383Using Build History to Gather Image Information Only
8384~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8385
8386As you can see, build history produces image information, including
8387dependency graphs, so you can see why something was pulled into the
8388image. If you are just interested in this information and not interested
8389in collecting specific package or SDK information, you can enable
8390writing only image information without any history by adding the
8391following to your ``conf/local.conf`` file found in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008392:term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008393
8394 INHERIT += "buildhistory"
8395 BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT = "0"
8396 BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES = "image"
8397
8398Here, you set the
8399:term:`BUILDHISTORY_FEATURES`
8400variable to use the image feature only.
8401
8402Build History SDK Information
8403~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8404
8405Build history collects similar information on the contents of SDKs (e.g.
8406``bitbake -c populate_sdk imagename``) as compared to information it
8407collects for images. Furthermore, this information differs depending on
8408whether an extensible or standard SDK is being produced.
8409
8410The following list shows the files produced for SDKs:
8411
8412- ``files-in-sdk.txt:`` A list of files in the SDK with permissions,
8413 owner, group, size, and symlink information. This list includes both
8414 the host and target parts of the SDK.
8415
8416- ``sdk-info.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs with
8417 information about the SDK. See the following listing example for more
8418 information.
8419
8420- ``sstate-task-sizes.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05008421 with information about task group sizes (e.g. :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008422 tasks have a total size). The ``sstate-task-sizes.txt`` file exists
8423 only when an extensible SDK is created.
8424
8425- ``sstate-package-sizes.txt:`` A text file containing name-value pairs
8426 with information for the shared-state packages and sizes in the SDK.
8427 The ``sstate-package-sizes.txt`` file exists only when an extensible
8428 SDK is created.
8429
8430- ``sdk-files:`` A folder that contains copies of the files mentioned
8431 in ``BUILDHISTORY_SDK_FILES`` if the files are present in the output.
8432 Additionally, the default value of ``BUILDHISTORY_SDK_FILES`` is
8433 specific to the extensible SDK although you can set it differently if
8434 you would like to pull in specific files from the standard SDK.
8435
8436 The default files are ``conf/local.conf``, ``conf/bblayers.conf``,
8437 ``conf/auto.conf``, ``conf/locked-sigs.inc``, and
8438 ``conf/devtool.conf``. Thus, for an extensible SDK, these files get
8439 copied into the ``sdk-files`` directory.
8440
8441- The following information appears under each of the ``host`` and
8442 ``target`` directories for the portions of the SDK that run on the
8443 host and on the target, respectively:
8444
8445 .. note::
8446
8447 The following files for the most part are empty when producing an
8448 extensible SDK because this type of SDK is not constructed from
8449 packages as is the standard SDK.
8450
8451 - ``depends.dot:`` Dependency graph for the SDK that is compatible
8452 with ``graphviz``.
8453
8454 - ``installed-package-names.txt:`` A list of installed packages by
8455 name only.
8456
8457 - ``installed-package-sizes.txt:`` A list of installed packages
8458 ordered by size.
8459
8460 - ``installed-packages.txt:`` A list of installed packages with full
8461 package filenames.
8462
8463Here is an example of ``sdk-info.txt``:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008464
8465.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008466
8467 DISTRO = poky
8468 DISTRO_VERSION = 1.3+snapshot-20130327
8469 SDK_NAME = poky-glibc-i686-arm
8470 SDK_VERSION = 1.3+snapshot
8471 SDKMACHINE =
8472 SDKIMAGE_FEATURES = dev-pkgs dbg-pkgs
8473 BAD_RECOMMENDATIONS =
8474 SDKSIZE = 352712
8475
8476Other than ``SDKSIZE``, which is
8477the total size of the files in the SDK in Kbytes, the name-value pairs
8478are variables that might have influenced the content of the SDK. This
8479information is often useful when you are trying to determine why a
8480change in the package or file listings has occurred.
8481
8482Examining Build History Information
8483~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8484
8485You can examine build history output from the command line or from a web
8486interface.
8487
8488To see any changes that have occurred (assuming you have
8489:term:`BUILDHISTORY_COMMIT` = "1"),
8490you can simply use any Git command that allows you to view the history
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008491of a repository. Here is one method::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008492
8493 $ git log -p
8494
8495You need to realize,
8496however, that this method does show changes that are not significant
8497(e.g. a package's size changing by a few bytes).
8498
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008499There is a command-line tool called ``buildhistory-diff``, though,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008500that queries the Git repository and prints just the differences that
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008501might be significant in human-readable form. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008502
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -05008503 $ poky/poky/scripts/buildhistory-diff . HEAD^
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008504 Changes to images/qemux86_64/glibc/core-image-minimal (files-in-image.txt):
8505 /etc/anotherpkg.conf was added
8506 /sbin/anotherpkg was added
8507 * (installed-package-names.txt):
8508 * anotherpkg was added
8509 Changes to images/qemux86_64/glibc/core-image-minimal (installed-package-names.txt):
8510 anotherpkg was added
8511 packages/qemux86_64-poky-linux/v86d: PACKAGES: added "v86d-extras"
8512 * PR changed from "r0" to "r1"
8513 * PV changed from "0.1.10" to "0.1.12"
8514 packages/qemux86_64-poky-linux/v86d/v86d: PKGSIZE changed from 110579 to 144381 (+30%)
8515 * PR changed from "r0" to "r1"
8516 * PV changed from "0.1.10" to "0.1.12"
8517
8518.. note::
8519
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008520 The ``buildhistory-diff`` tool requires the ``GitPython``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008521 package. Be sure to install it using Pip3 as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008522
8523 $ pip3 install GitPython --user
8524
8525
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008526 Alternatively, you can install ``python3-git`` using the appropriate
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05008527 distribution package manager (e.g. ``apt``, ``dnf``, or ``zipper``).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008528
8529To see changes to the build history using a web interface, follow the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008530instruction in the ``README`` file
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008531:yocto_git:`here </buildhistory-web/>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008532
8533Here is a sample screenshot of the interface:
8534
8535.. image:: figures/buildhistory-web.png
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05008536 :width: 100%
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008537
8538Performing Automated Runtime Testing
8539====================================
8540
8541The OpenEmbedded build system makes available a series of automated
8542tests for images to verify runtime functionality. You can run these
8543tests on either QEMU or actual target hardware. Tests are written in
8544Python making use of the ``unittest`` module, and the majority of them
8545run commands on the target system over SSH. This section describes how
8546you set up the environment to use these tests, run available tests, and
8547write and add your own tests.
8548
8549For information on the test and QA infrastructure available within the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06008550Yocto Project, see the ":ref:`ref-manual/release-process:testing and quality assurance`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008551section in the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
8552
8553Enabling Tests
8554--------------
8555
8556Depending on whether you are planning to run tests using QEMU or on the
8557hardware, you have to take different steps to enable the tests. See the
8558following subsections for information on how to enable both types of
8559tests.
8560
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008561Enabling Runtime Tests on QEMU
8562~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8563
8564In order to run tests, you need to do the following:
8565
8566- *Set up to avoid interaction with sudo for networking:* To
8567 accomplish this, you must do one of the following:
8568
8569 - Add ``NOPASSWD`` for your user in ``/etc/sudoers`` either for all
8570 commands or just for ``runqemu-ifup``. You must provide the full
8571 path as that can change if you are using multiple clones of the
8572 source repository.
8573
8574 .. note::
8575
8576 On some distributions, you also need to comment out "Defaults
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008577 requiretty" in ``/etc/sudoers``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008578
8579 - Manually configure a tap interface for your system.
8580
8581 - Run as root the script in ``scripts/runqemu-gen-tapdevs``, which
8582 should generate a list of tap devices. This is the option
8583 typically chosen for Autobuilder-type environments.
8584
8585 .. note::
8586
8587 - Be sure to use an absolute path when calling this script
8588 with sudo.
8589
8590 - The package recipe ``qemu-helper-native`` is required to run
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008591 this script. Build the package using the following command::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008592
8593 $ bitbake qemu-helper-native
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008594
8595- *Set the DISPLAY variable:* You need to set this variable so that
8596 you have an X server available (e.g. start ``vncserver`` for a
8597 headless machine).
8598
8599- *Be sure your host's firewall accepts incoming connections from
8600 192.168.7.0/24:* Some of the tests (in particular DNF tests) start an
8601 HTTP server on a random high number port, which is used to serve
8602 files to the target. The DNF module serves
8603 ``${WORKDIR}/oe-rootfs-repo`` so it can run DNF channel commands.
8604 That means your host's firewall must accept incoming connections from
8605 192.168.7.0/24, which is the default IP range used for tap devices by
8606 ``runqemu``.
8607
8608- *Be sure your host has the correct packages installed:* Depending
8609 your host's distribution, you need to have the following packages
8610 installed:
8611
8612 - Ubuntu and Debian: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute2``
8613
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05008614 - openSUSE: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute2``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008615
8616 - Fedora: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute``
8617
8618 - CentOS: ``sysstat`` and ``iproute``
8619
8620Once you start running the tests, the following happens:
8621
86221. A copy of the root filesystem is written to ``${WORKDIR}/testimage``.
8623
86242. The image is booted under QEMU using the standard ``runqemu`` script.
8625
86263. A default timeout of 500 seconds occurs to allow for the boot process
8627 to reach the login prompt. You can change the timeout period by
8628 setting
8629 :term:`TEST_QEMUBOOT_TIMEOUT`
8630 in the ``local.conf`` file.
8631
86324. Once the boot process is reached and the login prompt appears, the
8633 tests run. The full boot log is written to
8634 ``${WORKDIR}/testimage/qemu_boot_log``.
8635
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050086365. Each test module loads in the order found in :term:`TEST_SUITES`. You can
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008637 find the full output of the commands run over SSH in
8638 ``${WORKDIR}/testimgage/ssh_target_log``.
8639
86406. If no failures occur, the task running the tests ends successfully.
8641 You can find the output from the ``unittest`` in the task log at
8642 ``${WORKDIR}/temp/log.do_testimage``.
8643
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008644Enabling Runtime Tests on Hardware
8645~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8646
8647The OpenEmbedded build system can run tests on real hardware, and for
8648certain devices it can also deploy the image to be tested onto the
8649device beforehand.
8650
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00008651For automated deployment, a "controller image" is installed onto the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008652hardware once as part of setup. Then, each time tests are to be run, the
8653following occurs:
8654
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000086551. The controller image is booted into and used to write the image to be
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008656 tested to a second partition.
8657
86582. The device is then rebooted using an external script that you need to
8659 provide.
8660
86613. The device boots into the image to be tested.
8662
8663When running tests (independent of whether the image has been deployed
8664automatically or not), the device is expected to be connected to a
8665network on a pre-determined IP address. You can either use static IP
8666addresses written into the image, or set the image to use DHCP and have
8667your DHCP server on the test network assign a known IP address based on
8668the MAC address of the device.
8669
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008670In order to run tests on hardware, you need to set :term:`TEST_TARGET` to an
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008671appropriate value. For QEMU, you do not have to change anything, the
8672default value is "qemu". For running tests on hardware, the following
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008673options are available:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008674
8675- *"simpleremote":* Choose "simpleremote" if you are going to run tests
8676 on a target system that is already running the image to be tested and
8677 is available on the network. You can use "simpleremote" in
8678 conjunction with either real hardware or an image running within a
8679 separately started QEMU or any other virtual machine manager.
8680
8681- *"SystemdbootTarget":* Choose "SystemdbootTarget" if your hardware is
8682 an EFI-based machine with ``systemd-boot`` as bootloader and
8683 ``core-image-testmaster`` (or something similar) is installed. Also,
8684 your hardware under test must be in a DHCP-enabled network that gives
8685 it the same IP address for each reboot.
8686
8687 If you choose "SystemdbootTarget", there are additional requirements
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05008688 and considerations. See the
8689 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:selecting systemdboottarget`" section, which
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008690 follows, for more information.
8691
8692- *"BeagleBoneTarget":* Choose "BeagleBoneTarget" if you are deploying
8693 images and running tests on the BeagleBone "Black" or original
8694 "White" hardware. For information on how to use these tests, see the
8695 comments at the top of the BeagleBoneTarget
8696 ``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/beaglebonetarget.py`` file.
8697
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008698- *"EdgeRouterTarget":* Choose "EdgeRouterTarget" if you are deploying
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008699 images and running tests on the Ubiquiti Networks EdgeRouter Lite.
8700 For information on how to use these tests, see the comments at the
8701 top of the EdgeRouterTarget
8702 ``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/edgeroutertarget.py`` file.
8703
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008704- *"GrubTarget":* Choose "GrubTarget" if you are deploying images and running
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008705 tests on any generic PC that boots using GRUB. For information on how
8706 to use these tests, see the comments at the top of the GrubTarget
8707 ``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/grubtarget.py`` file.
8708
8709- *"your-target":* Create your own custom target if you want to run
8710 tests when you are deploying images and running tests on a custom
8711 machine within your BSP layer. To do this, you need to add a Python
8712 unit that defines the target class under ``lib/oeqa/controllers/``
8713 within your layer. You must also provide an empty ``__init__.py``.
8714 For examples, see files in ``meta-yocto-bsp/lib/oeqa/controllers/``.
8715
8716Selecting SystemdbootTarget
8717~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8718
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008719If you did not set :term:`TEST_TARGET` to "SystemdbootTarget", then you do
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008720not need any information in this section. You can skip down to the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05008721":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:running tests`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008722
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008723If you did set :term:`TEST_TARGET` to "SystemdbootTarget", you also need to
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00008724perform a one-time setup of your controller image by doing the following:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008725
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050087261. *Set EFI_PROVIDER:* Be sure that :term:`EFI_PROVIDER` is as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008727
8728 EFI_PROVIDER = "systemd-boot"
8729
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000087302. *Build the controller image:* Build the ``core-image-testmaster`` image.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008731 The ``core-image-testmaster`` recipe is provided as an example for a
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00008732 "controller" image and you can customize the image recipe as you would
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008733 any other recipe.
8734
8735 Here are the image recipe requirements:
8736
8737 - Inherits ``core-image`` so that kernel modules are installed.
8738
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05008739 - Installs normal linux utilities not BusyBox ones (e.g. ``bash``,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008740 ``coreutils``, ``tar``, ``gzip``, and ``kmod``).
8741
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05008742 - Uses a custom :term:`Initramfs` image with a custom
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008743 installer. A normal image that you can install usually creates a
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00008744 single root filesystem partition. This image uses another installer that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008745 creates a specific partition layout. Not all Board Support
8746 Packages (BSPs) can use an installer. For such cases, you need to
8747 manually create the following partition layout on the target:
8748
8749 - First partition mounted under ``/boot``, labeled "boot".
8750
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00008751 - The main root filesystem partition where this image gets installed,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008752 which is mounted under ``/``.
8753
8754 - Another partition labeled "testrootfs" where test images get
8755 deployed.
8756
87573. *Install image:* Install the image that you just built on the target
8758 system.
8759
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008760The final thing you need to do when setting :term:`TEST_TARGET` to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008761"SystemdbootTarget" is to set up the test image:
8762
87631. *Set up your local.conf file:* Make sure you have the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008764 statements in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008765
8766 IMAGE_FSTYPES += "tar.gz"
8767 INHERIT += "testimage"
8768 TEST_TARGET = "SystemdbootTarget"
8769 TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.2.3"
8770
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050087712. *Build your test image:* Use BitBake to build the image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008772
8773 $ bitbake core-image-sato
8774
8775Power Control
8776~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8777
8778For most hardware targets other than "simpleremote", you can control
8779power:
8780
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008781- You can use :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD` together with
8782 :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS` as a command that runs on the host
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008783 and does power cycling. The test code passes one argument to that
8784 command: off, on or cycle (off then on). Here is an example that
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008785 could appear in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008786
8787 TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD = "powercontrol.exp test 10.11.12.1 nuc1"
8788
8789 In this example, the expect
8790 script does the following:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008791
8792 .. code-block:: shell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008793
8794 ssh test@10.11.12.1 "pyctl nuc1 arg"
8795
8796 It then runs a Python script that controls power for a label called
8797 ``nuc1``.
8798
8799 .. note::
8800
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008801 You need to customize :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD` and
8802 :term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS` for your own setup. The one requirement
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008803 is that it accepts "on", "off", and "cycle" as the last argument.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008804
8805- When no command is defined, it connects to the device over SSH and
8806 uses the classic reboot command to reboot the device. Classic reboot
8807 is fine as long as the machine actually reboots (i.e. the SSH test
8808 has not failed). It is useful for scenarios where you have a simple
8809 setup, typically with a single board, and where some manual
8810 interaction is okay from time to time.
8811
8812If you have no hardware to automatically perform power control but still
8813wish to experiment with automated hardware testing, you can use the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008814``dialog-power-control`` script that shows a dialog prompting you to perform
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008815the required power action. This script requires either KDialog or Zenity
8816to be installed. To use this script, set the
8817:term:`TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008818variable as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008819
8820 TEST_POWERCONTROL_CMD = "${COREBASE}/scripts/contrib/dialog-power-control"
8821
8822Serial Console Connection
8823~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
8824
8825For test target classes requiring a serial console to interact with the
8826bootloader (e.g. BeagleBoneTarget, EdgeRouterTarget, and GrubTarget),
8827you need to specify a command to use to connect to the serial console of
8828the target machine by using the
8829:term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD`
8830variable and optionally the
8831:term:`TEST_SERIALCONTROL_EXTRA_ARGS`
8832variable.
8833
8834These cases could be a serial terminal program if the machine is
8835connected to a local serial port, or a ``telnet`` or ``ssh`` command
8836connecting to a remote console server. Regardless of the case, the
8837command simply needs to connect to the serial console and forward that
8838connection to standard input and output as any normal terminal program
8839does. For example, to use the picocom terminal program on serial device
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008840``/dev/ttyUSB0`` at 115200bps, you would set the variable as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008841
8842 TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "picocom /dev/ttyUSB0 -b 115200"
8843
8844For local
8845devices where the serial port device disappears when the device reboots,
8846an additional "serdevtry" wrapper script is provided. To use this
8847wrapper, simply prefix the terminal command with
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008848``${COREBASE}/scripts/contrib/serdevtry``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008849
8850 TEST_SERIALCONTROL_CMD = "${COREBASE}/scripts/contrib/serdevtry picocom -b 115200 /dev/ttyUSB0"
8851
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008852Running Tests
8853-------------
8854
8855You can start the tests automatically or manually:
8856
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05008857- *Automatically running tests:* To run the tests automatically after the
8858 OpenEmbedded build system successfully creates an image, first set the
8859 :term:`TESTIMAGE_AUTO` variable to "1" in your ``local.conf`` file in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008860 :term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008861
8862 TESTIMAGE_AUTO = "1"
8863
8864 Next, build your image. If the image successfully builds, the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008865 tests run::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008866
8867 bitbake core-image-sato
8868
8869- *Manually running tests:* To manually run the tests, first globally
8870 inherit the
Patrick Williams975a06f2022-10-21 14:42:47 -05008871 :ref:`testimage <ref-classes-testimage>` class
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008872 by editing your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008873
8874 INHERIT += "testimage"
8875
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008876 Next, use BitBake to run the tests::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008877
8878 bitbake -c testimage image
8879
8880All test files reside in ``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime`` in the
8881:term:`Source Directory`. A test name maps
8882directly to a Python module. Each test module may contain a number of
8883individual tests. Tests are usually grouped together by the area tested
8884(e.g tests for systemd reside in ``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime/systemd.py``).
8885
8886You can add tests to any layer provided you place them in the proper
8887area and you extend :term:`BBPATH` in
8888the ``local.conf`` file as normal. Be sure that tests reside in
8889``layer/lib/oeqa/runtime``.
8890
8891.. note::
8892
8893 Be sure that module names do not collide with module names used in
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008894 the default set of test modules in ``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008895
8896You can change the set of tests run by appending or overriding
8897:term:`TEST_SUITES` variable in
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008898``local.conf``. Each name in :term:`TEST_SUITES` represents a required test
8899for the image. Test modules named within :term:`TEST_SUITES` cannot be
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008900skipped even if a test is not suitable for an image (e.g. running the
8901RPM tests on an image without ``rpm``). Appending "auto" to
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008902:term:`TEST_SUITES` causes the build system to try to run all tests that are
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008903suitable for the image (i.e. each test module may elect to skip itself).
8904
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05008905The order you list tests in :term:`TEST_SUITES` is important and influences
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008906test dependencies. Consequently, tests that depend on other tests should
8907be added after the test on which they depend. For example, since the
8908``ssh`` test depends on the ``ping`` test, "ssh" needs to come after
8909"ping" in the list. The test class provides no re-ordering or dependency
8910handling.
8911
8912.. note::
8913
8914 Each module can have multiple classes with multiple test methods.
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008915 And, Python ``unittest`` rules apply.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008916
8917Here are some things to keep in mind when running tests:
8918
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008919- The default tests for the image are defined as::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008920
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05008921 DEFAULT_TEST_SUITES:pn-image = "ping ssh df connman syslog xorg scp vnc date rpm dnf dmesg"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008922
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008923- Add your own test to the list of the by using the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008924
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05008925 TEST_SUITES:append = " mytest"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008926
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008927- Run a specific list of tests as follows::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008928
8929 TEST_SUITES = "test1 test2 test3"
8930
8931 Remember, order is important. Be sure to place a test that is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008932 dependent on another test later in the order.
8933
8934Exporting Tests
8935---------------
8936
8937You can export tests so that they can run independently of the build
8938system. Exporting tests is required if you want to be able to hand the
8939test execution off to a scheduler. You can only export tests that are
8940defined in :term:`TEST_SUITES`.
8941
8942If your image is already built, make sure the following are set in your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008943``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008944
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008945 INHERIT += "testexport"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008946 TEST_TARGET_IP = "IP-address-for-the-test-target"
8947 TEST_SERVER_IP = "IP-address-for-the-test-server"
8948
8949You can then export the tests with the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008950following BitBake command form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008951
8952 $ bitbake image -c testexport
8953
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05008954Exporting the tests places them in the :term:`Build Directory` in
8955``tmp/testexport/``\ image, which is controlled by the :term:`TEST_EXPORT_DIR`
8956variable.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008957
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008958You can now run the tests outside of the build environment::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008959
8960 $ cd tmp/testexport/image
8961 $ ./runexported.py testdata.json
8962
8963Here is a complete example that shows IP addresses and uses the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008964``core-image-sato`` image::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008965
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05008966 INHERIT += "testexport"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008967 TEST_TARGET_IP = "192.168.7.2"
8968 TEST_SERVER_IP = "192.168.7.1"
8969
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008970Use BitBake to export the tests::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008971
8972 $ bitbake core-image-sato -c testexport
8973
8974Run the tests outside of
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05008975the build environment using the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008976
8977 $ cd tmp/testexport/core-image-sato
8978 $ ./runexported.py testdata.json
8979
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008980Writing New Tests
8981-----------------
8982
8983As mentioned previously, all new test files need to be in the proper
8984place for the build system to find them. New tests for additional
8985functionality outside of the core should be added to the layer that adds
8986the functionality, in ``layer/lib/oeqa/runtime`` (as long as
8987:term:`BBPATH` is extended in the
8988layer's ``layer.conf`` file as normal). Just remember the following:
8989
8990- Filenames need to map directly to test (module) names.
8991
8992- Do not use module names that collide with existing core tests.
8993
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07008994- Minimally, an empty ``__init__.py`` file must be present in the runtime
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05008995 directory.
8996
8997To create a new test, start by copying an existing module (e.g.
8998``syslog.py`` or ``gcc.py`` are good ones to use). Test modules can use
8999code from ``meta/lib/oeqa/utils``, which are helper classes.
9000
9001.. note::
9002
9003 Structure shell commands such that you rely on them and they return a
9004 single code for success. Be aware that sometimes you will need to
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009005 parse the output. See the ``df.py`` and ``date.py`` modules for examples.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009006
9007You will notice that all test classes inherit ``oeRuntimeTest``, which
9008is found in ``meta/lib/oetest.py``. This base class offers some helper
9009attributes, which are described in the following sections:
9010
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009011Class Methods
9012~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9013
9014Class methods are as follows:
9015
9016- *hasPackage(pkg):* Returns "True" if ``pkg`` is in the installed
9017 package list of the image, which is based on the manifest file that
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05009018 is generated during the :ref:`ref-tasks-rootfs` task.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009019
9020- *hasFeature(feature):* Returns "True" if the feature is in
9021 :term:`IMAGE_FEATURES` or
9022 :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`.
9023
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009024Class Attributes
9025~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9026
9027Class attributes are as follows:
9028
9029- *pscmd:* Equals "ps -ef" if ``procps`` is installed in the image.
9030 Otherwise, ``pscmd`` equals "ps" (busybox).
9031
9032- *tc:* The called test context, which gives access to the
9033 following attributes:
9034
9035 - *d:* The BitBake datastore, which allows you to use stuff such
9036 as ``oeRuntimeTest.tc.d.getVar("VIRTUAL-RUNTIME_init_manager")``.
9037
9038 - *testslist and testsrequired:* Used internally. The tests
9039 do not need these.
9040
9041 - *filesdir:* The absolute path to
9042 ``meta/lib/oeqa/runtime/files``, which contains helper files for
9043 tests meant for copying on the target such as small files written
9044 in C for compilation.
9045
9046 - *target:* The target controller object used to deploy and
9047 start an image on a particular target (e.g. Qemu, SimpleRemote,
9048 and SystemdbootTarget). Tests usually use the following:
9049
9050 - *ip:* The target's IP address.
9051
9052 - *server_ip:* The host's IP address, which is usually used
9053 by the DNF test suite.
9054
9055 - *run(cmd, timeout=None):* The single, most used method.
9056 This command is a wrapper for: ``ssh root@host "cmd"``. The
9057 command returns a tuple: (status, output), which are what their
9058 names imply - the return code of "cmd" and whatever output it
9059 produces. The optional timeout argument represents the number
9060 of seconds the test should wait for "cmd" to return. If the
9061 argument is "None", the test uses the default instance's
9062 timeout period, which is 300 seconds. If the argument is "0",
9063 the test runs until the command returns.
9064
9065 - *copy_to(localpath, remotepath):*
9066 ``scp localpath root@ip:remotepath``.
9067
9068 - *copy_from(remotepath, localpath):*
9069 ``scp root@host:remotepath localpath``.
9070
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009071Instance Attributes
9072~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9073
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07009074There is a single instance attribute, which is ``target``. The ``target``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009075instance attribute is identical to the class attribute of the same name,
9076which is described in the previous section. This attribute exists as
9077both an instance and class attribute so tests can use
9078``self.target.run(cmd)`` in instance methods instead of
9079``oeRuntimeTest.tc.target.run(cmd)``.
9080
9081Installing Packages in the DUT Without the Package Manager
9082----------------------------------------------------------
9083
9084When a test requires a package built by BitBake, it is possible to
9085install that package. Installing the package does not require a package
9086manager be installed in the device under test (DUT). It does, however,
9087require an SSH connection and the target must be using the
9088``sshcontrol`` class.
9089
9090.. note::
9091
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009092 This method uses ``scp`` to copy files from the host to the target, which
9093 causes permissions and special attributes to be lost.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009094
9095A JSON file is used to define the packages needed by a test. This file
9096must be in the same path as the file used to define the tests.
9097Furthermore, the filename must map directly to the test module name with
9098a ``.json`` extension.
9099
9100The JSON file must include an object with the test name as keys of an
9101object or an array. This object (or array of objects) uses the following
9102data:
9103
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05009104- "pkg" --- a mandatory string that is the name of the package to be
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009105 installed.
9106
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05009107- "rm" --- an optional boolean, which defaults to "false", that specifies
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009108 to remove the package after the test.
9109
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05009110- "extract" --- an optional boolean, which defaults to "false", that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009111 specifies if the package must be extracted from the package format.
9112 When set to "true", the package is not automatically installed into
9113 the DUT.
9114
9115Following is an example JSON file that handles test "foo" installing
9116package "bar" and test "foobar" installing packages "foo" and "bar".
9117Once the test is complete, the packages are removed from the DUT.
9118::
9119
9120 {
9121 "foo": {
9122 "pkg": "bar"
9123 },
9124 "foobar": [
9125 {
9126 "pkg": "foo",
9127 "rm": true
9128 },
9129 {
9130 "pkg": "bar",
9131 "rm": true
9132 }
9133 ]
9134 }
9135
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009136Debugging Tools and Techniques
9137==============================
9138
9139The exact method for debugging build failures depends on the nature of
9140the problem and on the system's area from which the bug originates.
9141Standard debugging practices such as comparison against the last known
9142working version with examination of the changes and the re-application
9143of steps to identify the one causing the problem are valid for the Yocto
9144Project just as they are for any other system. Even though it is
9145impossible to detail every possible potential failure, this section
9146provides some general tips to aid in debugging given a variety of
9147situations.
9148
9149.. note::
9150
9151 A useful feature for debugging is the error reporting tool.
9152 Configuring the Yocto Project to use this tool causes the
9153 OpenEmbedded build system to produce error reporting commands as part
9154 of the console output. You can enter the commands after the build
9155 completes to log error information into a common database, that can
9156 help you figure out what might be going wrong. For information on how
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009157 to enable and use this feature, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009158 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:using the error reporting tool`"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009159 section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009160
9161The following list shows the debugging topics in the remainder of this
9162section:
9163
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009164- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:viewing logs from failed tasks`" describes
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009165 how to find and view logs from tasks that failed during the build
9166 process.
9167
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009168- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:viewing variable values`" describes how to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009169 use the BitBake ``-e`` option to examine variable values after a
9170 recipe has been parsed.
9171
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009172- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:viewing package information with \`\`oe-pkgdata-util\`\``"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009173 describes how to use the ``oe-pkgdata-util`` utility to query
9174 :term:`PKGDATA_DIR` and
9175 display package-related information for built packages.
9176
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009177- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:viewing dependencies between recipes and tasks`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009178 describes how to use the BitBake ``-g`` option to display recipe
9179 dependency information used during the build.
9180
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009181- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:viewing task variable dependencies`" describes
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009182 how to use the ``bitbake-dumpsig`` command in conjunction with key
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -05009183 subdirectories in the :term:`Build Directory` to determine variable
9184 dependencies.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009185
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009186- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:running specific tasks`" describes
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009187 how to use several BitBake options (e.g. ``-c``, ``-C``, and ``-f``)
9188 to run specific tasks in the build chain. It can be useful to run
9189 tasks "out-of-order" when trying isolate build issues.
9190
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05009191- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:general BitBake problems`" describes how
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009192 to use BitBake's ``-D`` debug output option to reveal more about what
9193 BitBake is doing during the build.
9194
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009195- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:building with no dependencies`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009196 describes how to use the BitBake ``-b`` option to build a recipe
9197 while ignoring dependencies.
9198
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009199- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:recipe logging mechanisms`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009200 describes how to use the many recipe logging functions to produce
9201 debugging output and report errors and warnings.
9202
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009203- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:debugging parallel make races`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009204 describes how to debug situations where the build consists of several
9205 parts that are run simultaneously and when the output or result of
9206 one part is not ready for use with a different part of the build that
9207 depends on that output.
9208
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009209- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:debugging with the gnu project debugger (gdb) remotely`"
9210 describes how to use GDB to allow you to examine running programs, which can
9211 help you fix problems.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009212
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009213- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:debugging with the gnu project debugger (gdb) on the target`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009214 describes how to use GDB directly on target hardware for debugging.
9215
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009216- ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:other debugging tips`" describes
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009217 miscellaneous debugging tips that can be useful.
9218
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009219Viewing Logs from Failed Tasks
9220------------------------------
9221
9222You can find the log for a task in the file
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009223``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/temp/log.do_``\ `taskname`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009224For example, the log for the
9225:ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task of the
9226QEMU minimal image for the x86 machine (``qemux86``) might be in
9227``tmp/work/qemux86-poky-linux/core-image-minimal/1.0-r0/temp/log.do_compile``.
9228To see the commands :term:`BitBake` ran
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009229to generate a log, look at the corresponding ``run.do_``\ `taskname` file
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009230in the same directory.
9231
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009232``log.do_``\ `taskname` and ``run.do_``\ `taskname` are actually symbolic
9233links to ``log.do_``\ `taskname`\ ``.``\ `pid` and
9234``log.run_``\ `taskname`\ ``.``\ `pid`, where `pid` is the PID the task had
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009235when it ran. The symlinks always point to the files corresponding to the
9236most recent run.
9237
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009238Viewing Variable Values
9239-----------------------
9240
9241Sometimes you need to know the value of a variable as a result of
9242BitBake's parsing step. This could be because some unexpected behavior
9243occurred in your project. Perhaps an attempt to :ref:`modify a variable
9244<bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:modifying existing
9245variables>` did not work out as expected.
9246
9247BitBake's ``-e`` option is used to display variable values after
9248parsing. The following command displays the variable values after the
9249configuration files (i.e. ``local.conf``, ``bblayers.conf``,
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009250``bitbake.conf`` and so forth) have been parsed::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009251
9252 $ bitbake -e
9253
9254The following command displays variable values after a specific recipe has
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009255been parsed. The variables include those from the configuration as well::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009256
9257 $ bitbake -e recipename
9258
9259.. note::
9260
9261 Each recipe has its own private set of variables (datastore).
9262 Internally, after parsing the configuration, a copy of the resulting
9263 datastore is made prior to parsing each recipe. This copying implies
9264 that variables set in one recipe will not be visible to other
9265 recipes.
9266
9267 Likewise, each task within a recipe gets a private datastore based on
9268 the recipe datastore, which means that variables set within one task
9269 will not be visible to other tasks.
9270
9271In the output of ``bitbake -e``, each variable is preceded by a
9272description of how the variable got its value, including temporary
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009273values that were later overridden. This description also includes
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009274variable flags (varflags) set on the variable. The output can be very
9275helpful during debugging.
9276
9277Variables that are exported to the environment are preceded by
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009278``export`` in the output of ``bitbake -e``. See the following example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009279
9280 export CC="i586-poky-linux-gcc -m32 -march=i586 --sysroot=/home/ulf/poky/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86"
9281
9282In addition to variable values, the output of the ``bitbake -e`` and
9283``bitbake -e`` recipe commands includes the following information:
9284
9285- The output starts with a tree listing all configuration files and
9286 classes included globally, recursively listing the files they include
9287 or inherit in turn. Much of the behavior of the OpenEmbedded build
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009288 system (including the behavior of the :ref:`ref-manual/tasks:normal recipe build tasks`) is
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009289 implemented in the
9290 :ref:`base <ref-classes-base>` class and the
9291 classes it inherits, rather than being built into BitBake itself.
9292
9293- After the variable values, all functions appear in the output. For
9294 shell functions, variables referenced within the function body are
9295 expanded. If a function has been modified using overrides or using
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -05009296 override-style operators like ``:append`` and ``:prepend``, then the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009297 final assembled function body appears in the output.
9298
9299Viewing Package Information with ``oe-pkgdata-util``
9300----------------------------------------------------
9301
9302You can use the ``oe-pkgdata-util`` command-line utility to query
9303:term:`PKGDATA_DIR` and display
9304various package-related information. When you use the utility, you must
9305use it to view information on packages that have already been built.
9306
9307Following are a few of the available ``oe-pkgdata-util`` subcommands.
9308
9309.. note::
9310
9311 You can use the standard \* and ? globbing wildcards as part of
9312 package names and paths.
9313
9314- ``oe-pkgdata-util list-pkgs [pattern]``: Lists all packages
9315 that have been built, optionally limiting the match to packages that
9316 match pattern.
9317
9318- ``oe-pkgdata-util list-pkg-files package ...``: Lists the
9319 files and directories contained in the given packages.
9320
9321 .. note::
9322
9323 A different way to view the contents of a package is to look at
9324 the
9325 ``${``\ :term:`WORKDIR`\ ``}/packages-split``
9326 directory of the recipe that generates the package. This directory
9327 is created by the
9328 :ref:`ref-tasks-package` task
9329 and has one subdirectory for each package the recipe generates,
9330 which contains the files stored in that package.
9331
9332 If you want to inspect the ``${WORKDIR}/packages-split``
9333 directory, make sure that
9334 :ref:`rm_work <ref-classes-rm-work>` is not
9335 enabled when you build the recipe.
9336
9337- ``oe-pkgdata-util find-path path ...``: Lists the names of
9338 the packages that contain the given paths. For example, the following
9339 tells us that ``/usr/share/man/man1/make.1`` is contained in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009340 ``make-doc`` package::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009341
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009342 $ oe-pkgdata-util find-path /usr/share/man/man1/make.1
9343 make-doc: /usr/share/man/man1/make.1
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009344
9345- ``oe-pkgdata-util lookup-recipe package ...``: Lists the name
9346 of the recipes that produce the given packages.
9347
9348For more information on the ``oe-pkgdata-util`` command, use the help
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009349facility::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009350
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009351 $ oe-pkgdata-util --help
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009352 $ oe-pkgdata-util subcommand --help
9353
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009354Viewing Dependencies Between Recipes and Tasks
9355----------------------------------------------
9356
9357Sometimes it can be hard to see why BitBake wants to build other recipes
9358before the one you have specified. Dependency information can help you
9359understand why a recipe is built.
9360
9361To generate dependency information for a recipe, run the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009362command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009363
9364 $ bitbake -g recipename
9365
9366This command writes the following files in the current directory:
9367
9368- ``pn-buildlist``: A list of recipes/targets involved in building
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009369 `recipename`. "Involved" here means that at least one task from the
9370 recipe needs to run when building `recipename` from scratch. Targets
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009371 that are in
9372 :term:`ASSUME_PROVIDED`
9373 are not listed.
9374
9375- ``task-depends.dot``: A graph showing dependencies between tasks.
9376
9377The graphs are in
9378`DOT <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/DOT_%28graph_description_language%29>`__
9379format and can be converted to images (e.g. using the ``dot`` tool from
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009380`Graphviz <https://www.graphviz.org/>`__).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009381
9382.. note::
9383
9384 - DOT files use a plain text format. The graphs generated using the
9385 ``bitbake -g`` command are often so large as to be difficult to
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -05009386 read without special pruning (e.g. with BitBake's ``-I`` option)
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009387 and processing. Despite the form and size of the graphs, the
9388 corresponding ``.dot`` files can still be possible to read and
9389 provide useful information.
9390
9391 As an example, the ``task-depends.dot`` file contains lines such
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009392 as the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009393
9394 "libxslt.do_configure" -> "libxml2.do_populate_sysroot"
9395
9396 The above example line reveals that the
9397 :ref:`ref-tasks-configure`
9398 task in ``libxslt`` depends on the
9399 :ref:`ref-tasks-populate_sysroot`
9400 task in ``libxml2``, which is a normal
9401 :term:`DEPENDS` dependency
9402 between the two recipes.
9403
9404 - For an example of how ``.dot`` files can be processed, see the
9405 ``scripts/contrib/graph-tool`` Python script, which finds and
9406 displays paths between graph nodes.
9407
9408You can use a different method to view dependency information by using
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009409the following command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009410
9411 $ bitbake -g -u taskexp recipename
9412
9413This command
9414displays a GUI window from which you can view build-time and runtime
9415dependencies for the recipes involved in building recipename.
9416
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009417Viewing Task Variable Dependencies
9418----------------------------------
9419
9420As mentioned in the
9421":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-execution:checksums (signatures)`" section of the BitBake
9422User Manual, BitBake tries to automatically determine what variables a
9423task depends on so that it can rerun the task if any values of the
9424variables change. This determination is usually reliable. However, if
9425you do things like construct variable names at runtime, then you might
9426have to manually declare dependencies on those variables using
9427``vardeps`` as described in the
9428":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags`" section of the BitBake
9429User Manual.
9430
9431If you are unsure whether a variable dependency is being picked up
9432automatically for a given task, you can list the variable dependencies
9433BitBake has determined by doing the following:
9434
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050094351. Build the recipe containing the task::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009436
9437 $ bitbake recipename
9438
94392. Inside the :term:`STAMPS_DIR`
9440 directory, find the signature data (``sigdata``) file that
9441 corresponds to the task. The ``sigdata`` files contain a pickled
9442 Python database of all the metadata that went into creating the input
9443 checksum for the task. As an example, for the
9444 :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch` task of the
9445 ``db`` recipe, the ``sigdata`` file might be found in the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009446 location::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009447
9448 ${BUILDDIR}/tmp/stamps/i586-poky-linux/db/6.0.30-r1.do_fetch.sigdata.7c048c18222b16ff0bcee2000ef648b1
9449
9450 For tasks that are accelerated through the shared state
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009451 (:ref:`sstate <overview-manual/concepts:shared state cache>`) cache, an
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009452 additional ``siginfo`` file is written into
9453 :term:`SSTATE_DIR` along with
9454 the cached task output. The ``siginfo`` files contain exactly the
9455 same information as ``sigdata`` files.
9456
94573. Run ``bitbake-dumpsig`` on the ``sigdata`` or ``siginfo`` file. Here
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009458 is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009459
9460 $ bitbake-dumpsig ${BUILDDIR}/tmp/stamps/i586-poky-linux/db/6.0.30-r1.do_fetch.sigdata.7c048c18222b16ff0bcee2000ef648b1
9461
9462 In the output of the above command, you will find a line like the
9463 following, which lists all the (inferred) variable dependencies for
9464 the task. This list also includes indirect dependencies from
9465 variables depending on other variables, recursively.
9466 ::
9467
9468 Task dependencies: ['PV', 'SRCREV', 'SRC_URI', 'SRC_URI[md5sum]', 'SRC_URI[sha256sum]', 'base_do_fetch']
9469
9470 .. note::
9471
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009472 Functions (e.g. ``base_do_fetch``) also count as variable dependencies.
9473 These functions in turn depend on the variables they reference.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009474
9475 The output of ``bitbake-dumpsig`` also includes the value each
9476 variable had, a list of dependencies for each variable, and
Andrew Geissler7e0e3c02022-02-25 20:34:39 +00009477 :term:`BB_BASEHASH_IGNORE_VARS`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009478 information.
9479
9480There is also a ``bitbake-diffsigs`` command for comparing two
9481``siginfo`` or ``sigdata`` files. This command can be helpful when
9482trying to figure out what changed between two versions of a task. If you
9483call ``bitbake-diffsigs`` with just one file, the command behaves like
9484``bitbake-dumpsig``.
9485
9486You can also use BitBake to dump out the signature construction
9487information without executing tasks by using either of the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009488BitBake command-line options::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009489
9490 ‐‐dump-signatures=SIGNATURE_HANDLER
9491 -S SIGNATURE_HANDLER
9492
9493
9494.. note::
9495
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009496 Two common values for `SIGNATURE_HANDLER` are "none" and "printdiff", which
9497 dump only the signature or compare the dumped signature with the cached one,
9498 respectively.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009499
9500Using BitBake with either of these options causes BitBake to dump out
9501``sigdata`` files in the ``stamps`` directory for every task it would
9502have executed instead of building the specified target package.
9503
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009504Viewing Metadata Used to Create the Input Signature of a Shared State Task
9505--------------------------------------------------------------------------
9506
9507Seeing what metadata went into creating the input signature of a shared
9508state (sstate) task can be a useful debugging aid. This information is
9509available in signature information (``siginfo``) files in
9510:term:`SSTATE_DIR`. For
9511information on how to view and interpret information in ``siginfo``
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009512files, see the
9513":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:viewing task variable dependencies`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009514
9515For conceptual information on shared state, see the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009516":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:shared state`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009517section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual.
9518
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009519Invalidating Shared State to Force a Task to Run
9520------------------------------------------------
9521
9522The OpenEmbedded build system uses
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009523:ref:`checksums <overview-manual/concepts:checksums (signatures)>` and
9524:ref:`overview-manual/concepts:shared state` cache to avoid unnecessarily
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009525rebuilding tasks. Collectively, this scheme is known as "shared state
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009526code".
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009527
9528As with all schemes, this one has some drawbacks. It is possible that
9529you could make implicit changes to your code that the checksum
9530calculations do not take into account. These implicit changes affect a
9531task's output but do not trigger the shared state code into rebuilding a
9532recipe. Consider an example during which a tool changes its output.
9533Assume that the output of ``rpmdeps`` changes. The result of the change
9534should be that all the ``package`` and ``package_write_rpm`` shared
9535state cache items become invalid. However, because the change to the
9536output is external to the code and therefore implicit, the associated
9537shared state cache items do not become invalidated. In this case, the
9538build process uses the cached items rather than running the task again.
9539Obviously, these types of implicit changes can cause problems.
9540
9541To avoid these problems during the build, you need to understand the
9542effects of any changes you make. Realize that changes you make directly
9543to a function are automatically factored into the checksum calculation.
9544Thus, these explicit changes invalidate the associated area of shared
9545state cache. However, you need to be aware of any implicit changes that
9546are not obvious changes to the code and could affect the output of a
9547given task.
9548
9549When you identify an implicit change, you can easily take steps to
9550invalidate the cache and force the tasks to run. The steps you can take
9551are as simple as changing a function's comments in the source code. For
9552example, to invalidate package shared state files, change the comment
9553statements of
9554:ref:`ref-tasks-package` or the
9555comments of one of the functions it calls. Even though the change is
9556purely cosmetic, it causes the checksum to be recalculated and forces
9557the build system to run the task again.
9558
9559.. note::
9560
9561 For an example of a commit that makes a cosmetic change to invalidate
9562 shared state, see this
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009563 :yocto_git:`commit </poky/commit/meta/classes/package.bbclass?id=737f8bbb4f27b4837047cb9b4fbfe01dfde36d54>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009564
9565Running Specific Tasks
9566----------------------
9567
9568Any given recipe consists of a set of tasks. The standard BitBake
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05009569behavior in most cases is: :ref:`ref-tasks-fetch`, :ref:`ref-tasks-unpack`, :ref:`ref-tasks-patch`,
9570:ref:`ref-tasks-configure`, :ref:`ref-tasks-compile`, :ref:`ref-tasks-install`, :ref:`ref-tasks-package`,
9571:ref:`do_package_write_* <ref-tasks-package_write_deb>`, and :ref:`ref-tasks-build`. The default task is
9572:ref:`ref-tasks-build` and any tasks on which it depends build first. Some tasks,
9573such as :ref:`ref-tasks-devshell`, are not part of the default build chain. If you
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009574wish to run a task that is not part of the default build chain, you can
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009575use the ``-c`` option in BitBake. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009576
9577 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c devshell
9578
9579The ``-c`` option respects task dependencies, which means that all other
9580tasks (including tasks from other recipes) that the specified task
9581depends on will be run before the task. Even when you manually specify a
9582task to run with ``-c``, BitBake will only run the task if it considers
9583it "out of date". See the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009584":ref:`overview-manual/concepts:stamp files and the rerunning of tasks`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009585section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for how
9586BitBake determines whether a task is "out of date".
9587
9588If you want to force an up-to-date task to be rerun (e.g. because you
9589made manual modifications to the recipe's
9590:term:`WORKDIR` that you want to try
9591out), then you can use the ``-f`` option.
9592
9593.. note::
9594
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009595 The reason ``-f`` is never required when running the
9596 :ref:`ref-tasks-devshell` task is because the
9597 [\ :ref:`nostamp <bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-metadata:variable flags>`\ ]
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009598 variable flag is already set for the task.
9599
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009600The following example shows one way you can use the ``-f`` option::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009601
9602 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop
9603 .
9604 .
9605 make some changes to the source code in the work directory
9606 .
9607 .
9608 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c compile -f
9609 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop
9610
9611This sequence first builds and then recompiles ``matchbox-desktop``. The
9612last command reruns all tasks (basically the packaging tasks) after the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05009613compile. BitBake recognizes that the :ref:`ref-tasks-compile` task was rerun and
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009614therefore understands that the other tasks also need to be run again.
9615
9616Another, shorter way to rerun a task and all
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -06009617:ref:`ref-manual/tasks:normal recipe build tasks`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009618that depend on it is to use the ``-C`` option.
9619
9620.. note::
9621
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009622 This option is upper-cased and is separate from the ``-c``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009623 option, which is lower-cased.
9624
9625Using this option invalidates the given task and then runs the
9626:ref:`ref-tasks-build` task, which is
9627the default task if no task is given, and the tasks on which it depends.
9628You could replace the final two commands in the previous example with
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009629the following single command::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009630
9631 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -C compile
9632
9633Internally, the ``-f`` and ``-C`` options work by tainting (modifying)
9634the input checksum of the specified task. This tainting indirectly
9635causes the task and its dependent tasks to be rerun through the normal
9636task dependency mechanisms.
9637
9638.. note::
9639
9640 BitBake explicitly keeps track of which tasks have been tainted in
9641 this fashion, and will print warnings such as the following for
9642 builds involving such tasks:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009643
9644 .. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009645
9646 WARNING: /home/ulf/poky/meta/recipes-sato/matchbox-desktop/matchbox-desktop_2.1.bb.do_compile is tainted from a forced run
9647
9648
9649 The purpose of the warning is to let you know that the work directory
9650 and build output might not be in the clean state they would be in for
9651 a "normal" build, depending on what actions you took. To get rid of
9652 such warnings, you can remove the work directory and rebuild the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009653 recipe, as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009654
9655 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c clean
9656 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop
9657
9658
9659You can view a list of tasks in a given package by running the
Patrick Williams2194f502022-10-16 14:26:09 -05009660:ref:`ref-tasks-listtasks` task as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009661
9662 $ bitbake matchbox-desktop -c listtasks
9663
9664The results appear as output to the console and are also in
9665the file ``${WORKDIR}/temp/log.do_listtasks``.
9666
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009667General BitBake Problems
9668------------------------
9669
9670You can see debug output from BitBake by using the ``-D`` option. The
9671debug output gives more information about what BitBake is doing and the
9672reason behind it. Each ``-D`` option you use increases the logging
9673level. The most common usage is ``-DDD``.
9674
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009675The output from ``bitbake -DDD -v targetname`` can reveal why BitBake
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009676chose a certain version of a package or why BitBake picked a certain
9677provider. This command could also help you in a situation where you
9678think BitBake did something unexpected.
9679
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009680Building with No Dependencies
9681-----------------------------
9682
9683To build a specific recipe (``.bb`` file), you can use the following
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009684command form::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009685
9686 $ bitbake -b somepath/somerecipe.bb
9687
9688This command form does
9689not check for dependencies. Consequently, you should use it only when
9690you know existing dependencies have been met.
9691
9692.. note::
9693
9694 You can also specify fragments of the filename. In this case, BitBake
9695 checks for a unique match.
9696
9697Recipe Logging Mechanisms
9698-------------------------
9699
9700The Yocto Project provides several logging functions for producing
9701debugging output and reporting errors and warnings. For Python
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07009702functions, the following logging functions are available. All of these functions
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009703log to ``${T}/log.do_``\ `task`, and can also log to standard output
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009704(stdout) with the right settings:
9705
9706- ``bb.plain(msg)``: Writes msg as is to the log while also
9707 logging to stdout.
9708
9709- ``bb.note(msg)``: Writes "NOTE: msg" to the log. Also logs to
9710 stdout if BitBake is called with "-v".
9711
9712- ``bb.debug(level, msg)``: Writes "DEBUG: msg" to the
9713 log. Also logs to stdout if the log level is greater than or equal to
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -05009714 level. See the ":ref:`bitbake:bitbake-user-manual/bitbake-user-manual-intro:usage and syntax`" option
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009715 in the BitBake User Manual for more information.
9716
9717- ``bb.warn(msg)``: Writes "WARNING: msg" to the log while also
9718 logging to stdout.
9719
9720- ``bb.error(msg)``: Writes "ERROR: msg" to the log while also
9721 logging to standard out (stdout).
9722
9723 .. note::
9724
9725 Calling this function does not cause the task to fail.
9726
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -05009727- ``bb.fatal(msg)``: This logging function is similar to
9728 ``bb.error(msg)`` but also causes the calling task to fail.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009729
9730 .. note::
9731
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009732 ``bb.fatal()`` raises an exception, which means you do not need to put a
9733 "return" statement after the function.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009734
9735The same logging functions are also available in shell functions, under
9736the names ``bbplain``, ``bbnote``, ``bbdebug``, ``bbwarn``, ``bberror``,
9737and ``bbfatal``. The
9738:ref:`logging <ref-classes-logging>` class
9739implements these functions. See that class in the ``meta/classes``
9740folder of the :term:`Source Directory` for information.
9741
9742Logging With Python
9743~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9744
9745When creating recipes using Python and inserting code that handles build
9746logs, keep in mind the goal is to have informative logs while keeping
9747the console as "silent" as possible. Also, if you want status messages
9748in the log, use the "debug" loglevel.
9749
9750Following is an example written in Python. The code handles logging for
9751a function that determines the number of tasks needed to be run. See the
9752":ref:`ref-tasks-listtasks`"
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009753section for additional information::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009754
9755 python do_listtasks() {
9756 bb.debug(2, "Starting to figure out the task list")
9757 if noteworthy_condition:
9758 bb.note("There are 47 tasks to run")
9759 bb.debug(2, "Got to point xyz")
9760 if warning_trigger:
9761 bb.warn("Detected warning_trigger, this might be a problem later.")
9762 if recoverable_error:
9763 bb.error("Hit recoverable_error, you really need to fix this!")
9764 if fatal_error:
9765 bb.fatal("fatal_error detected, unable to print the task list")
9766 bb.plain("The tasks present are abc")
9767 bb.debug(2, "Finished figuring out the tasklist")
9768 }
9769
9770Logging With Bash
9771~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9772
9773When creating recipes using Bash and inserting code that handles build
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -05009774logs, you have the same goals --- informative with minimal console output.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009775The syntax you use for recipes written in Bash is similar to that of
9776recipes written in Python described in the previous section.
9777
9778Following is an example written in Bash. The code logs the progress of
9779the ``do_my_function`` function.
9780::
9781
9782 do_my_function() {
9783 bbdebug 2 "Running do_my_function"
9784 if [ exceptional_condition ]; then
9785 bbnote "Hit exceptional_condition"
9786 fi
9787 bbdebug 2 "Got to point xyz"
9788 if [ warning_trigger ]; then
9789 bbwarn "Detected warning_trigger, this might cause a problem later."
9790 fi
9791 if [ recoverable_error ]; then
9792 bberror "Hit recoverable_error, correcting"
9793 fi
9794 if [ fatal_error ]; then
9795 bbfatal "fatal_error detected"
9796 fi
9797 bbdebug 2 "Completed do_my_function"
9798 }
9799
9800
9801Debugging Parallel Make Races
9802-----------------------------
9803
9804A parallel ``make`` race occurs when the build consists of several parts
9805that are run simultaneously and a situation occurs when the output or
9806result of one part is not ready for use with a different part of the
9807build that depends on that output. Parallel make races are annoying and
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07009808can sometimes be difficult to reproduce and fix. However, there are some simple
9809tips and tricks that can help you debug and fix them. This section
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009810presents a real-world example of an error encountered on the Yocto
9811Project autobuilder and the process used to fix it.
9812
9813.. note::
9814
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009815 If you cannot properly fix a ``make`` race condition, you can work around it
9816 by clearing either the :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` or :term:`PARALLEL_MAKEINST`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009817 variables.
9818
9819The Failure
9820~~~~~~~~~~~
9821
9822For this example, assume that you are building an image that depends on
9823the "neard" package. And, during the build, BitBake runs into problems
9824and creates the following output.
9825
9826.. note::
9827
9828 This example log file has longer lines artificially broken to make
9829 the listing easier to read.
9830
9831If you examine the output or the log file, you see the failure during
9832``make``:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -05009833
9834.. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009835
9836 | DEBUG: SITE files ['endian-little', 'bit-32', 'ix86-common', 'common-linux', 'common-glibc', 'i586-linux', 'common']
9837 | DEBUG: Executing shell function do_compile
9838 | NOTE: make -j 16
9839 | make --no-print-directory all-am
9840 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9841 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9842 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009843 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009844 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/types.h include/near/types.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009845 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009846 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/log.h include/near/log.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009847 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009848 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/plugin.h include/near/plugin.h
9849 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9850 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9851 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009852 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009853 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/tag.h include/near/tag.h
9854 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009855 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009856 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/adapter.h include/near/adapter.h
9857 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009858 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009859 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/ndef.h include/near/ndef.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009860 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009861 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/tlv.h include/near/tlv.h
9862 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9863 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009864 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009865 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/setting.h include/near/setting.h
9866 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9867 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
9868 | /bin/mkdir -p include/near
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009869 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009870 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/device.h include/near/device.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009871 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009872 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/nfc_copy.h include/near/nfc_copy.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009873 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009874 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/snep.h include/near/snep.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009875 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009876 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/version.h include/near/version.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009877 | ln -s /home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/work/i586-poky-linux/neard/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009878 0.14-r0/neard-0.14/include/dbus.h include/near/dbus.h
9879 | ./src/genbuiltin nfctype1 nfctype2 nfctype3 nfctype4 p2p > src/builtin.h
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009880 | i586-poky-linux-gcc -m32 -march=i586 --sysroot=/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009881 build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86 -DHAVE_CONFIG_H -I. -I./include -I./src -I./gdbus -I/home/pokybuild/
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009882 yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/include/glib-2.0
9883 -I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/
9884 lib/glib-2.0/include -I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/nightly-x86/build/build/
9885 tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/include/dbus-1.0 -I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009886 nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/lib/dbus-1.0/include -I/home/pokybuild/yocto-autobuilder/
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +00009887 nightly-x86/build/build/tmp/sysroots/qemux86/usr/include/libnl3
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009888 -DNEAR_PLUGIN_BUILTIN -DPLUGINDIR=\""/usr/lib/near/plugins"\"
9889 -DCONFIGDIR=\""/etc/neard\"" -O2 -pipe -g -feliminate-unused-debug-types -c
9890 -o tools/snep-send.o tools/snep-send.c
9891 | In file included from tools/snep-send.c:16:0:
9892 | tools/../src/near.h:41:23: fatal error: near/dbus.h: No such file or directory
9893 | #include <near/dbus.h>
9894 | ^
9895 | compilation terminated.
9896 | make[1]: *** [tools/snep-send.o] Error 1
9897 | make[1]: *** Waiting for unfinished jobs....
9898 | make: *** [all] Error 2
9899 | ERROR: oe_runmake failed
9900
9901Reproducing the Error
9902~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9903
9904Because race conditions are intermittent, they do not manifest
9905themselves every time you do the build. In fact, most times the build
9906will complete without problems even though the potential race condition
9907exists. Thus, once the error surfaces, you need a way to reproduce it.
9908
9909In this example, compiling the "neard" package is causing the problem.
9910So the first thing to do is build "neard" locally. Before you start the
9911build, set the
9912:term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` variable
9913in your ``local.conf`` file to a high number (e.g. "-j 20"). Using a
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05009914high value for :term:`PARALLEL_MAKE` increases the chances of the race
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009915condition showing up::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009916
9917 $ bitbake neard
9918
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009919Once the local build for "neard" completes, start a ``devshell`` build::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009920
9921 $ bitbake neard -c devshell
9922
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009923For information on how to use a ``devshell``, see the
9924":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:using a development shell`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009925
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009926In the ``devshell``, do the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009927
9928 $ make clean
9929 $ make tools/snep-send.o
9930
9931The ``devshell`` commands cause the failure to clearly
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07009932be visible. In this case, there is a missing dependency for the ``neard``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009933Makefile target. Here is some abbreviated, sample output with the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009934missing dependency clearly visible at the end::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009935
9936 i586-poky-linux-gcc -m32 -march=i586 --sysroot=/home/scott-lenovo/......
9937 .
9938 .
9939 .
9940 tools/snep-send.c
9941 In file included from tools/snep-send.c:16:0:
9942 tools/../src/near.h:41:23: fatal error: near/dbus.h: No such file or directory
9943 #include <near/dbus.h>
9944 ^
9945 compilation terminated.
9946 make: *** [tools/snep-send.o] Error 1
9947 $
9948
9949
9950Creating a Patch for the Fix
9951~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
9952
9953Because there is a missing dependency for the Makefile target, you need
9954to patch the ``Makefile.am`` file, which is generated from
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009955``Makefile.in``. You can use Quilt to create the patch::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009956
9957 $ quilt new parallelmake.patch
9958 Patch patches/parallelmake.patch is now on top
9959 $ quilt add Makefile.am
9960 File Makefile.am added to patch patches/parallelmake.patch
9961
9962For more information on using Quilt, see the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -05009963":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:using quilt in your workflow`" section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009964
9965At this point you need to make the edits to ``Makefile.am`` to add the
9966missing dependency. For our example, you have to add the following line
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009967to the file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009968
9969 tools/snep-send.$(OBJEXT): include/near/dbus.h
9970
9971Once you have edited the file, use the ``refresh`` command to create the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009972patch::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009973
9974 $ quilt refresh
9975 Refreshed patch patches/parallelmake.patch
9976
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -07009977Once the patch file is created, you need to add it back to the originating
9978recipe folder. Here is an example assuming a top-level
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -05009979:term:`Source Directory` named ``poky``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009980
9981 $ cp patches/parallelmake.patch poky/meta/recipes-connectivity/neard/neard
9982
9983The final thing you need to do to implement the fix in the build is to
9984update the "neard" recipe (i.e. ``neard-0.14.bb``) so that the
9985:term:`SRC_URI` statement includes
9986the patch file. The recipe file is in the folder above the patch. Here
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05009987is what the edited :term:`SRC_URI` statement would look like::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009988
9989 SRC_URI = "${KERNELORG_MIRROR}/linux/network/nfc/${BPN}-${PV}.tar.xz \
9990 file://neard.in \
9991 file://neard.service.in \
9992 file://parallelmake.patch \
9993 "
9994
9995With the patch complete and moved to the correct folder and the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -05009996:term:`SRC_URI` statement updated, you can exit the ``devshell``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -05009997
9998 $ exit
9999
10000Testing the Build
10001~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10002
10003With everything in place, you can get back to trying the build again
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010004locally::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010005
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010006 $ bitbake neard
10007
10008This build should succeed.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010009
10010Now you can open up a ``devshell`` again and repeat the clean and make
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010011operations as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010012
10013 $ bitbake neard -c devshell
10014 $ make clean
10015 $ make tools/snep-send.o
10016
10017The build should work without issue.
10018
10019As with all solved problems, if they originated upstream, you need to
10020submit the fix for the recipe in OE-Core and upstream so that the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -050010021problem is taken care of at its source. See the
10022":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:submitting a change to the yocto project`"
10023section for more information.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010024
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010025Debugging With the GNU Project Debugger (GDB) Remotely
10026------------------------------------------------------
10027
10028GDB allows you to examine running programs, which in turn helps you to
10029understand and fix problems. It also allows you to perform post-mortem
10030style analysis of program crashes. GDB is available as a package within
10031the Yocto Project and is installed in SDK images by default. See the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010032":ref:`ref-manual/images:Images`" chapter in the Yocto
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010033Project Reference Manual for a description of these images. You can find
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010034information on GDB at https://sourceware.org/gdb/.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010035
10036.. note::
10037
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010038 For best results, install debug (``-dbg``) packages for the applications you
10039 are going to debug. Doing so makes extra debug symbols available that give
10040 you more meaningful output.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010041
10042Sometimes, due to memory or disk space constraints, it is not possible
10043to use GDB directly on the remote target to debug applications. These
10044constraints arise because GDB needs to load the debugging information
10045and the binaries of the process being debugged. Additionally, GDB needs
10046to perform many computations to locate information such as function
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050010047names, variable names and values, stack traces and so forth --- even
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010048before starting the debugging process. These extra computations place
10049more load on the target system and can alter the characteristics of the
10050program being debugged.
10051
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010052To help get past the previously mentioned constraints, there are two
10053methods you can use: running a debuginfod server and using gdbserver.
10054
10055Using the debuginfod server method
10056~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10057
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010058``debuginfod`` from ``elfutils`` is a way to distribute ``debuginfo`` files.
10059Running a ``debuginfod`` server makes debug symbols readily available,
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010060which means you don't need to download debugging information
10061and the binaries of the process being debugged. You can just fetch
10062debug symbols from the server.
10063
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010064To run a ``debuginfod`` server, you need to do the following:
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010065
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010066- Ensure that ``debuginfod`` is present in :term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
10067 (it already is in ``OpenEmbedded-core`` defaults and ``poky`` reference distribution).
10068 If not, set in your distro config file or in ``local.conf``::
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010069
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050010070 DISTRO_FEATURES:append = " debuginfod"
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010071
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010072 This distro feature enables the server and client library in ``elfutils``,
10073 and enables ``debuginfod`` support in clients (at the moment, ``gdb`` and ``binutils``).
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010074
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010075- Run the following commands to launch the ``debuginfod`` server on the host::
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010076
10077 $ oe-debuginfod
10078
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010079- To use ``debuginfod`` on the target, you need to know the ip:port where
10080 ``debuginfod`` is listening on the host (port defaults to 8002), and export
10081 that into the shell environment, for example in ``qemu``::
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010082
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010083 root@qemux86-64:~# export DEBUGINFOD_URLS="http://192.168.7.1:8002/"
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010084
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010085- Then debug info fetching should simply work when running the target ``gdb``,
10086 ``readelf`` or ``objdump``, for example::
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010087
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010088 root@qemux86-64:~# gdb /bin/cat
10089 ...
10090 Reading symbols from /bin/cat...
10091 Downloading separate debug info for /bin/cat...
10092 Reading symbols from /home/root/.cache/debuginfod_client/923dc4780cfbc545850c616bffa884b6b5eaf322/debuginfo...
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010093
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010094- It's also possible to use ``debuginfod-find`` to just query the server::
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010095
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010096 root@qemux86-64:~# debuginfod-find debuginfo /bin/ls
10097 /home/root/.cache/debuginfod_client/356edc585f7f82d46f94fcb87a86a3fe2d2e60bd/debuginfo
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010098
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010099
10100Using the gdbserver method
10101~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10102
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010103gdbserver, which runs on the remote target and does not load any
10104debugging information from the debugged process. Instead, a GDB instance
10105processes the debugging information that is run on a remote computer -
10106the host GDB. The host GDB then sends control commands to gdbserver to
10107make it stop or start the debugged program, as well as read or write
10108memory regions of that debugged program. All the debugging information
10109loaded and processed as well as all the heavy debugging is done by the
10110host GDB. Offloading these processes gives the gdbserver running on the
10111target a chance to remain small and fast.
10112
10113Because the host GDB is responsible for loading the debugging
10114information and for doing the necessary processing to make actual
10115debugging happen, you have to make sure the host can access the
10116unstripped binaries complete with their debugging information and also
10117be sure the target is compiled with no optimizations. The host GDB must
10118also have local access to all the libraries used by the debugged
10119program. Because gdbserver does not need any local debugging
10120information, the binaries on the remote target can remain stripped.
10121However, the binaries must also be compiled without optimization so they
10122match the host's binaries.
10123
10124To remain consistent with GDB documentation and terminology, the binary
10125being debugged on the remote target machine is referred to as the
10126"inferior" binary. For documentation on GDB see the `GDB
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010127site <https://sourceware.org/gdb/documentation/>`__.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010128
10129The following steps show you how to debug using the GNU project
10130debugger.
10131
101321. *Configure your build system to construct the companion debug
10133 filesystem:*
10134
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010135 In your ``local.conf`` file, set the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010136
10137 IMAGE_GEN_DEBUGFS = "1"
10138 IMAGE_FSTYPES_DEBUGFS = "tar.bz2"
10139
10140 These options cause the
10141 OpenEmbedded build system to generate a special companion filesystem
10142 fragment, which contains the matching source and debug symbols to
10143 your deployable filesystem. The build system does this by looking at
10144 what is in the deployed filesystem, and pulling the corresponding
10145 ``-dbg`` packages.
10146
10147 The companion debug filesystem is not a complete filesystem, but only
10148 contains the debug fragments. This filesystem must be combined with
10149 the full filesystem for debugging. Subsequent steps in this procedure
10150 show how to combine the partial filesystem with the full filesystem.
10151
101522. *Configure the system to include gdbserver in the target filesystem:*
10153
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010154 Make the following addition in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010155
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010156 EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES:append = " tools-debug"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010157
10158 The change makes
10159 sure the ``gdbserver`` package is included.
10160
101613. *Build the environment:*
10162
10163 Use the following command to construct the image and the companion
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010164 Debug Filesystem::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010165
10166 $ bitbake image
10167
10168 Build the cross GDB component and
10169 make it available for debugging. Build the SDK that matches the
10170 image. Building the SDK is best for a production build that can be
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010171 used later for debugging, especially during long term maintenance::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010172
10173 $ bitbake -c populate_sdk image
10174
10175 Alternatively, you can build the minimal toolchain components that
10176 match the target. Doing so creates a smaller than typical SDK and
10177 only contains a minimal set of components with which to build simple
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010178 test applications, as well as run the debugger::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010179
10180 $ bitbake meta-toolchain
10181
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010182 A final method is to build Gdb itself within the build system::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010183
10184 $ bitbake gdb-cross-<architecture>
10185
10186 Doing so produces a temporary copy of
10187 ``cross-gdb`` you can use for debugging during development. While
10188 this is the quickest approach, the two previous methods in this step
10189 are better when considering long-term maintenance strategies.
10190
10191 .. note::
10192
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010193 If you run ``bitbake gdb-cross``, the OpenEmbedded build system suggests
10194 the actual image (e.g. ``gdb-cross-i586``). The suggestion is usually the
10195 actual name you want to use.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010196
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500101974. *Set up the* ``debugfs``\ *:*
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010198
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010199 Run the following commands to set up the ``debugfs``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010200
10201 $ mkdir debugfs
10202 $ cd debugfs
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010203 $ tar xvfj build-dir/tmp/deploy/images/machine/image.rootfs.tar.bz2
10204 $ tar xvfj build-dir/tmp/deploy/images/machine/image-dbg.rootfs.tar.bz2
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010205
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -0500102065. *Set up GDB:*
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010207
10208 Install the SDK (if you built one) and then source the correct
10209 environment file. Sourcing the environment file puts the SDK in your
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010210 ``PATH`` environment variable and sets ``$GDB`` to the SDK's debugger.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010211
10212 If you are using the build system, Gdb is located in
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010213 `build-dir`\ ``/tmp/sysroots/``\ `host`\ ``/usr/bin/``\ `architecture`\ ``/``\ `architecture`\ ``-gdb``
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010214
102156. *Boot the target:*
10216
10217 For information on how to run QEMU, see the `QEMU
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010218 Documentation <https://wiki.qemu.org/Documentation/GettingStartedDevelopers>`__.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010219
10220 .. note::
10221
10222 Be sure to verify that your host can access the target via TCP.
10223
102247. *Debug a program:*
10225
10226 Debugging a program involves running gdbserver on the target and then
10227 running Gdb on the host. The example in this step debugs ``gzip``:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010228
10229 .. code-block:: shell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010230
10231 root@qemux86:~# gdbserver localhost:1234 /bin/gzip —help
10232
10233 For
10234 additional gdbserver options, see the `GDB Server
10235 Documentation <https://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/documentation/>`__.
10236
10237 After running gdbserver on the target, you need to run Gdb on the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010238 host and configure it and connect to the target. Use these commands::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010239
10240 $ cd directory-holding-the-debugfs-directory
10241 $ arch-gdb
10242 (gdb) set sysroot debugfs
10243 (gdb) set substitute-path /usr/src/debug debugfs/usr/src/debug
10244 (gdb) target remote IP-of-target:1234
10245
10246 At this
10247 point, everything should automatically load (i.e. matching binaries,
10248 symbols and headers).
10249
10250 .. note::
10251
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010252 The Gdb ``set`` commands in the previous example can be placed into the
10253 users ``~/.gdbinit`` file. Upon starting, Gdb automatically runs whatever
10254 commands are in that file.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010255
102568. *Deploying without a full image rebuild:*
10257
10258 In many cases, during development you want a quick method to deploy a
10259 new binary to the target and debug it, without waiting for a full
10260 image build.
10261
10262 One approach to solving this situation is to just build the component
10263 you want to debug. Once you have built the component, copy the
10264 executable directly to both the target and the host ``debugfs``.
10265
10266 If the binary is processed through the debug splitting in
10267 OpenEmbedded, you should also copy the debug items (i.e. ``.debug``
10268 contents and corresponding ``/usr/src/debug`` files) from the work
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010269 directory. Here is an example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010270
10271 $ bitbake bash
10272 $ bitbake -c devshell bash
10273 $ cd ..
10274 $ scp packages-split/bash/bin/bash target:/bin/bash
10275 $ cp -a packages-split/bash-dbg/\* path/debugfs
10276
10277Debugging with the GNU Project Debugger (GDB) on the Target
10278-----------------------------------------------------------
10279
10280The previous section addressed using GDB remotely for debugging
10281purposes, which is the most usual case due to the inherent hardware
10282limitations on many embedded devices. However, debugging in the target
10283hardware itself is also possible with more powerful devices. This
10284section describes what you need to do in order to support using GDB to
10285debug on the target hardware.
10286
10287To support this kind of debugging, you need do the following:
10288
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010289- Ensure that GDB is on the target. You can do this by making
10290 the following addition to your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010291
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010292 EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES:append = " tools-debug"
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010293
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010294- Ensure that debug symbols are present. You can do so by adding the
10295 corresponding ``-dbg`` package to :term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010296
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010297 IMAGE_INSTALL:append = " packagename-dbg"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010298
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010299 Alternatively, you can add the following to ``local.conf`` to include
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010300 all the debug symbols::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010301
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010302 EXTRA_IMAGE_FEATURES:append = " dbg-pkgs"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010303
10304.. note::
10305
10306 To improve the debug information accuracy, you can reduce the level
10307 of optimization used by the compiler. For example, when adding the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010308 following line to your ``local.conf`` file, you will reduce optimization
10309 from :term:`FULL_OPTIMIZATION` of "-O2" to :term:`DEBUG_OPTIMIZATION`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010310 of "-O -fno-omit-frame-pointer"::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010311
10312 DEBUG_BUILD = "1"
10313
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010314 Consider that this will reduce the application's performance and is
10315 recommended only for debugging purposes.
10316
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010317Other Debugging Tips
10318--------------------
10319
10320Here are some other tips that you might find useful:
10321
10322- When adding new packages, it is worth watching for undesirable items
10323 making their way into compiler command lines. For example, you do not
10324 want references to local system files like ``/usr/lib/`` or
10325 ``/usr/include/``.
10326
10327- If you want to remove the ``psplash`` boot splashscreen, add
10328 ``psplash=false`` to the kernel command line. Doing so prevents
10329 ``psplash`` from loading and thus allows you to see the console. It
10330 is also possible to switch out of the splashscreen by switching the
10331 virtual console (e.g. Fn+Left or Fn+Right on a Zaurus).
10332
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050010333- Removing :term:`TMPDIR` (usually ``tmp/``, within the
10334 :term:`Build Directory`) can often fix temporary build issues. Removing
10335 :term:`TMPDIR` is usually a relatively cheap operation, because task output
10336 will be cached in :term:`SSTATE_DIR` (usually ``sstate-cache/``, which is
10337 also in the :term:`Build Directory`).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010338
10339 .. note::
10340
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010341 Removing :term:`TMPDIR` might be a workaround rather than a fix.
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010342 Consequently, trying to determine the underlying cause of an issue before
10343 removing the directory is a good idea.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010344
10345- Understanding how a feature is used in practice within existing
10346 recipes can be very helpful. It is recommended that you configure
10347 some method that allows you to quickly search through files.
10348
10349 Using GNU Grep, you can use the following shell function to
10350 recursively search through common recipe-related files, skipping
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050010351 binary files, ``.git`` directories, and the :term:`Build Directory`
10352 (assuming its name starts with "build")::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010353
10354 g() {
10355 grep -Ir \
10356 --exclude-dir=.git \
10357 --exclude-dir='build*' \
10358 --include='*.bb*' \
10359 --include='*.inc*' \
10360 --include='*.conf*' \
10361 --include='*.py*' \
10362 "$@"
10363 }
10364
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010365 Following are some usage examples::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010366
10367 $ g FOO # Search recursively for "FOO"
10368 $ g -i foo # Search recursively for "foo", ignoring case
10369 $ g -w FOO # Search recursively for "FOO" as a word, ignoring e.g. "FOOBAR"
10370
10371 If figuring
10372 out how some feature works requires a lot of searching, it might
10373 indicate that the documentation should be extended or improved. In
10374 such cases, consider filing a documentation bug using the Yocto
10375 Project implementation of
10376 :yocto_bugs:`Bugzilla <>`. For information on
10377 how to submit a bug against the Yocto Project, see the Yocto Project
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010378 Bugzilla :yocto_wiki:`wiki page </Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -050010379 and the
10380 ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:submitting a defect against the yocto project`"
10381 section.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010382
10383 .. note::
10384
10385 The manuals might not be the right place to document variables
10386 that are purely internal and have a limited scope (e.g. internal
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010387 variables used to implement a single ``.bbclass`` file).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010388
10389Making Changes to the Yocto Project
10390===================================
10391
10392Because the Yocto Project is an open-source, community-based project,
10393you can effect changes to the project. This section presents procedures
10394that show you how to submit a defect against the project and how to
10395submit a change.
10396
10397Submitting a Defect Against the Yocto Project
10398---------------------------------------------
10399
10400Use the Yocto Project implementation of
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010401`Bugzilla <https://www.bugzilla.org/about/>`__ to submit a defect (bug)
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010402against the Yocto Project. For additional information on this
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010403implementation of Bugzilla see the ":ref:`Yocto Project
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010404Bugzilla <resources-bugtracker>`" section in the
10405Yocto Project Reference Manual. For more detail on any of the following
10406steps, see the Yocto Project
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010407:yocto_wiki:`Bugzilla wiki page </Bugzilla_Configuration_and_Bug_Tracking>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010408
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010409Use the following general steps to submit a bug:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010410
104111. Open the Yocto Project implementation of :yocto_bugs:`Bugzilla <>`.
10412
104132. Click "File a Bug" to enter a new bug.
10414
104153. Choose the appropriate "Classification", "Product", and "Component"
10416 for which the bug was found. Bugs for the Yocto Project fall into
10417 one of several classifications, which in turn break down into
10418 several products and components. For example, for a bug against the
10419 ``meta-intel`` layer, you would choose "Build System, Metadata &
10420 Runtime", "BSPs", and "bsps-meta-intel", respectively.
10421
104224. Choose the "Version" of the Yocto Project for which you found the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010423 bug (e.g. &DISTRO;).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010424
104255. Determine and select the "Severity" of the bug. The severity
10426 indicates how the bug impacted your work.
10427
104286. Choose the "Hardware" that the bug impacts.
10429
104307. Choose the "Architecture" that the bug impacts.
10431
104328. Choose a "Documentation change" item for the bug. Fixing a bug might
10433 or might not affect the Yocto Project documentation. If you are
10434 unsure of the impact to the documentation, select "Don't Know".
10435
104369. Provide a brief "Summary" of the bug. Try to limit your summary to
10437 just a line or two and be sure to capture the essence of the bug.
10438
1043910. Provide a detailed "Description" of the bug. You should provide as
10440 much detail as you can about the context, behavior, output, and so
10441 forth that surrounds the bug. You can even attach supporting files
10442 for output from logs by using the "Add an attachment" button.
10443
1044411. Click the "Submit Bug" button submit the bug. A new Bugzilla number
10445 is assigned to the bug and the defect is logged in the bug tracking
10446 system.
10447
10448Once you file a bug, the bug is processed by the Yocto Project Bug
10449Triage Team and further details concerning the bug are assigned (e.g.
10450priority and owner). You are the "Submitter" of the bug and any further
10451categorization, progress, or comments on the bug result in Bugzilla
10452sending you an automated email concerning the particular change or
10453progress to the bug.
10454
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010455Submitting a Change to the Yocto Project
10456----------------------------------------
10457
10458Contributions to the Yocto Project and OpenEmbedded are very welcome.
10459Because the system is extremely configurable and flexible, we recognize
10460that developers will want to extend, configure or optimize it for their
10461specific uses.
10462
10463The Yocto Project uses a mailing list and a patch-based workflow that is
10464similar to the Linux kernel but contains important differences. In
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -070010465general, there is a mailing list through which you can submit patches. You
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010466should send patches to the appropriate mailing list so that they can be
10467reviewed and merged by the appropriate maintainer. The specific mailing
10468list you need to use depends on the location of the code you are
10469changing. Each component (e.g. layer) should have a ``README`` file that
10470indicates where to send the changes and which process to follow.
10471
10472You can send the patch to the mailing list using whichever approach you
10473feel comfortable with to generate the patch. Once sent, the patch is
10474usually reviewed by the community at large. If somebody has concerns
10475with the patch, they will usually voice their concern over the mailing
10476list. If a patch does not receive any negative reviews, the maintainer
10477of the affected layer typically takes the patch, tests it, and then
10478based on successful testing, merges the patch.
10479
10480The "poky" repository, which is the Yocto Project's reference build
10481environment, is a hybrid repository that contains several individual
10482pieces (e.g. BitBake, Metadata, documentation, and so forth) built using
10483the combo-layer tool. The upstream location used for submitting changes
10484varies by component:
10485
10486- *Core Metadata:* Send your patch to the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010487 :oe_lists:`openembedded-core </g/openembedded-core>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010488 mailing list. For example, a change to anything under the ``meta`` or
10489 ``scripts`` directories should be sent to this mailing list.
10490
10491- *BitBake:* For changes to BitBake (i.e. anything under the
10492 ``bitbake`` directory), send your patch to the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010493 :oe_lists:`bitbake-devel </g/bitbake-devel>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010494 mailing list.
10495
Andrew Geisslerc3d88e42020-10-02 09:45:00 -050010496- *"meta-\*" trees:* These trees contain Metadata. Use the
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010497 :yocto_lists:`poky </g/poky>` mailing list.
Andrew Geisslerc3d88e42020-10-02 09:45:00 -050010498
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010499- *Documentation*: For changes to the Yocto Project documentation, use the
10500 :yocto_lists:`docs </g/docs>` mailing list.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010501
10502For changes to other layers hosted in the Yocto Project source
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010503repositories (i.e. ``yoctoproject.org``) and tools use the
10504:yocto_lists:`Yocto Project </g/yocto/>` general mailing list.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010505
10506.. note::
10507
10508 Sometimes a layer's documentation specifies to use a particular
10509 mailing list. If so, use that list.
10510
10511For additional recipes that do not fit into the core Metadata, you
10512should determine which layer the recipe should go into and submit the
10513change in the manner recommended by the documentation (e.g. the
10514``README`` file) supplied with the layer. If in doubt, please ask on the
10515Yocto general mailing list or on the openembedded-devel mailing list.
10516
10517You can also push a change upstream and request a maintainer to pull the
10518change into the component's upstream repository. You do this by pushing
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010519to a contribution repository that is upstream. See the
10520":ref:`overview-manual/development-environment:git workflows and the yocto project`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010521section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual for additional
10522concepts on working in the Yocto Project development environment.
10523
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010524Maintainers commonly use ``-next`` branches to test submissions prior to
10525merging patches. Thus, you can get an idea of the status of a patch based on
10526whether the patch has been merged into one of these branches. The commonly
10527used testing branches for OpenEmbedded-Core are as follows:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010528
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010529- *openembedded-core "master-next" branch:* This branch is part of the
10530 :oe_git:`openembedded-core </openembedded-core/>` repository and contains
10531 proposed changes to the core metadata.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010532
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010533- *poky "master-next" branch:* This branch is part of the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010534 :yocto_git:`poky </poky/>` repository and combines proposed
Andrew Geisslerd5838332022-05-27 11:33:10 -050010535 changes to BitBake, the core metadata and the poky distro.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010536
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010537Similarly, stable branches maintained by the project may have corresponding
10538``-next`` branches which collect proposed changes. For example,
10539``&DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP;-next`` and ``&DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP_MINUS_ONE;-next``
10540branches in both the "openembdedded-core" and "poky" repositories.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010541
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010542Other layers may have similar testing branches but there is no formal
10543requirement or standard for these so please check the documentation for the
10544layers you are contributing to.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010545
10546The following sections provide procedures for submitting a change.
10547
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010548Preparing Changes for Submission
10549~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010550
105511. *Make Your Changes Locally:* Make your changes in your local Git
10552 repository. You should make small, controlled, isolated changes.
10553 Keeping changes small and isolated aids review, makes
10554 merging/rebasing easier and keeps the change history clean should
10555 anyone need to refer to it in future.
10556
105572. *Stage Your Changes:* Stage your changes by using the ``git add``
10558 command on each file you changed.
10559
105603. *Commit Your Changes:* Commit the change by using the ``git commit``
10561 command. Make sure your commit information follows standards by
10562 following these accepted conventions:
10563
10564 - Be sure to include a "Signed-off-by:" line in the same style as
Patrick Williams03907ee2022-05-01 06:28:52 -050010565 required by the Linux kernel. This can be done by using the
10566 ``git commit -s`` command. Adding this line signifies that you,
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010567 the submitter, have agreed to the Developer's Certificate of
10568 Origin 1.1 as follows:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010569
10570 .. code-block:: none
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010571
10572 Developer's Certificate of Origin 1.1
10573
10574 By making a contribution to this project, I certify that:
10575
10576 (a) The contribution was created in whole or in part by me and I
10577 have the right to submit it under the open source license
10578 indicated in the file; or
10579
10580 (b) The contribution is based upon previous work that, to the best
10581 of my knowledge, is covered under an appropriate open source
10582 license and I have the right under that license to submit that
10583 work with modifications, whether created in whole or in part
10584 by me, under the same open source license (unless I am
10585 permitted to submit under a different license), as indicated
10586 in the file; or
10587
10588 (c) The contribution was provided directly to me by some other
10589 person who certified (a), (b) or (c) and I have not modified
10590 it.
10591
10592 (d) I understand and agree that this project and the contribution
10593 are public and that a record of the contribution (including all
10594 personal information I submit with it, including my sign-off) is
10595 maintained indefinitely and may be redistributed consistent with
10596 this project or the open source license(s) involved.
10597
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010598 - Provide a single-line summary of the change and, if more
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010599 explanation is needed, provide more detail in the body of the
10600 commit. This summary is typically viewable in the "shortlist" of
10601 changes. Thus, providing something short and descriptive that
10602 gives the reader a summary of the change is useful when viewing a
10603 list of many commits. You should prefix this short description
10604 with the recipe name (if changing a recipe), or else with the
10605 short form path to the file being changed.
10606
10607 - For the body of the commit message, provide detailed information
10608 that describes what you changed, why you made the change, and the
10609 approach you used. It might also be helpful if you mention how you
10610 tested the change. Provide as much detail as you can in the body
10611 of the commit message.
10612
10613 .. note::
10614
10615 You do not need to provide a more detailed explanation of a
10616 change if the change is minor to the point of the single line
10617 summary providing all the information.
10618
10619 - If the change addresses a specific bug or issue that is associated
10620 with a bug-tracking ID, include a reference to that ID in your
10621 detailed description. For example, the Yocto Project uses a
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050010622 specific convention for bug references --- any commit that addresses
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010623 a specific bug should use the following form for the detailed
10624 description. Be sure to use the actual bug-tracking ID from
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010625 Bugzilla for bug-id::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010626
10627 Fixes [YOCTO #bug-id]
10628
10629 detailed description of change
10630
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010631Using Email to Submit a Patch
10632~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10633
10634Depending on the components changed, you need to submit the email to a
10635specific mailing list. For some guidance on which mailing list to use,
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -050010636see the
10637:ref:`list <dev-manual/common-tasks:submitting a change to the yocto project>`
10638at the beginning of this section. For a description of all the available
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010639mailing lists, see the ":ref:`Mailing Lists <resources-mailinglist>`" section in the
10640Yocto Project Reference Manual.
10641
10642Here is the general procedure on how to submit a patch through email
10643without using the scripts once the steps in
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010644:ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:preparing changes for submission` have been followed:
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010645
106461. *Format the Commit:* Format the commit into an email message. To
10647 format commits, use the ``git format-patch`` command. When you
10648 provide the command, you must include a revision list or a number of
10649 patches as part of the command. For example, either of these two
10650 commands takes your most recent single commit and formats it as an
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010651 email message in the current directory::
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010652
10653 $ git format-patch -1
10654
10655 or ::
10656
10657 $ git format-patch HEAD~
10658
10659 After the command is run, the current directory contains a numbered
10660 ``.patch`` file for the commit.
10661
10662 If you provide several commits as part of the command, the
10663 ``git format-patch`` command produces a series of numbered files in
10664 the current directory – one for each commit. If you have more than
10665 one patch, you should also use the ``--cover`` option with the
10666 command, which generates a cover letter as the first "patch" in the
10667 series. You can then edit the cover letter to provide a description
10668 for the series of patches. For information on the
10669 ``git format-patch`` command, see ``GIT_FORMAT_PATCH(1)`` displayed
10670 using the ``man git-format-patch`` command.
10671
10672 .. note::
10673
10674 If you are or will be a frequent contributor to the Yocto Project
10675 or to OpenEmbedded, you might consider requesting a contrib area
10676 and the necessary associated rights.
10677
106782. *Send the patches via email:* Send the patches to the recipients and
10679 relevant mailing lists by using the ``git send-email`` command.
10680
10681 .. note::
10682
10683 In order to use ``git send-email``, you must have the proper Git packages
10684 installed on your host.
10685 For Ubuntu, Debian, and Fedora the package is ``git-email``.
10686
10687 The ``git send-email`` command sends email by using a local or remote
10688 Mail Transport Agent (MTA) such as ``msmtp``, ``sendmail``, or
10689 through a direct ``smtp`` configuration in your Git ``~/.gitconfig``
10690 file. If you are submitting patches through email only, it is very
10691 important that you submit them without any whitespace or HTML
10692 formatting that either you or your mailer introduces. The maintainer
10693 that receives your patches needs to be able to save and apply them
10694 directly from your emails. A good way to verify that what you are
10695 sending will be applicable by the maintainer is to do a dry run and
10696 send them to yourself and then save and apply them as the maintainer
10697 would.
10698
10699 The ``git send-email`` command is the preferred method for sending
10700 your patches using email since there is no risk of compromising
10701 whitespace in the body of the message, which can occur when you use
10702 your own mail client. The command also has several options that let
10703 you specify recipients and perform further editing of the email
10704 message. For information on how to use the ``git send-email``
10705 command, see ``GIT-SEND-EMAIL(1)`` displayed using the
10706 ``man git-send-email`` command.
10707
10708The Yocto Project uses a `Patchwork instance <https://patchwork.openembedded.org/>`__
10709to track the status of patches submitted to the various mailing lists and to
10710support automated patch testing. Each submitted patch is checked for common
10711mistakes and deviations from the expected patch format and submitters are
10712notified by patchtest if such mistakes are found. This process helps to
10713reduce the burden of patch review on maintainers.
10714
10715.. note::
10716
10717 This system is imperfect and changes can sometimes get lost in the flow.
10718 Asking about the status of a patch or change is reasonable if the change
10719 has been idle for a while with no feedback.
10720
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010721Using Scripts to Push a Change Upstream and Request a Pull
10722~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10723
10724For larger patch series it is preferable to send a pull request which not
10725only includes the patch but also a pointer to a branch that can be pulled
10726from. This involves making a local branch for your changes, pushing this
10727branch to an accessible repository and then using the ``create-pull-request``
10728and ``send-pull-request`` scripts from openembedded-core to create and send a
10729patch series with a link to the branch for review.
10730
10731Follow this procedure to push a change to an upstream "contrib" Git
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010732repository once the steps in :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:preparing changes for submission` have
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010733been followed:
10734
10735.. note::
10736
10737 You can find general Git information on how to push a change upstream
10738 in the
10739 `Git Community Book <https://git-scm.com/book/en/v2/Distributed-Git-Distributed-Workflows>`__.
10740
107411. *Push Your Commits to a "Contrib" Upstream:* If you have arranged for
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010742 permissions to push to an upstream contrib repository, push the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010743 change to that repository::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010744
10745 $ git push upstream_remote_repo local_branch_name
10746
10747 For example, suppose you have permissions to push
10748 into the upstream ``meta-intel-contrib`` repository and you are
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010749 working in a local branch named `your_name`\ ``/README``. The following
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010750 command pushes your local commits to the ``meta-intel-contrib``
10751 upstream repository and puts the commit in a branch named
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010752 `your_name`\ ``/README``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010753
10754 $ git push meta-intel-contrib your_name/README
10755
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -0600107562. *Determine Who to Notify:* Determine the maintainer or the mailing
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010757 list that you need to notify for the change.
10758
10759 Before submitting any change, you need to be sure who the maintainer
10760 is or what mailing list that you need to notify. Use either these
10761 methods to find out:
10762
10763 - *Maintenance File:* Examine the ``maintainers.inc`` file, which is
10764 located in the :term:`Source Directory` at
10765 ``meta/conf/distro/include``, to see who is responsible for code.
10766
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010767 - *Search by File:* Using :ref:`overview-manual/development-environment:git`, you can
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010768 enter the following command to bring up a short list of all
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010769 commits against a specific file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010770
10771 git shortlog -- filename
10772
10773 Just provide the name of the file for which you are interested. The
10774 information returned is not ordered by history but does include a
10775 list of everyone who has committed grouped by name. From the list,
10776 you can see who is responsible for the bulk of the changes against
10777 the file.
10778
10779 - *Examine the List of Mailing Lists:* For a list of the Yocto
10780 Project and related mailing lists, see the ":ref:`Mailing
10781 lists <resources-mailinglist>`" section in
10782 the Yocto Project Reference Manual.
10783
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -0600107843. *Make a Pull Request:* Notify the maintainer or the mailing list that
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010785 you have pushed a change by making a pull request.
10786
10787 The Yocto Project provides two scripts that conveniently let you
10788 generate and send pull requests to the Yocto Project. These scripts
10789 are ``create-pull-request`` and ``send-pull-request``. You can find
10790 these scripts in the ``scripts`` directory within the
10791 :term:`Source Directory` (e.g.
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010792 ``poky/scripts``).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010793
10794 Using these scripts correctly formats the requests without
10795 introducing any whitespace or HTML formatting. The maintainer that
10796 receives your patches either directly or through the mailing list
10797 needs to be able to save and apply them directly from your emails.
10798 Using these scripts is the preferred method for sending patches.
10799
10800 First, create the pull request. For example, the following command
10801 runs the script, specifies the upstream repository in the contrib
10802 directory into which you pushed the change, and provides a subject
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010803 line in the created patch files::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010804
Andrew Geissler95ac1b82021-03-31 14:34:31 -050010805 $ poky/scripts/create-pull-request -u meta-intel-contrib -s "Updated Manual Section Reference in README"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010806
10807 Running this script forms ``*.patch`` files in a folder named
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010808 ``pull-``\ `PID` in the current directory. One of the patch files is a
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010809 cover letter.
10810
10811 Before running the ``send-pull-request`` script, you must edit the
10812 cover letter patch to insert information about your change. After
10813 editing the cover letter, send the pull request. For example, the
10814 following command runs the script and specifies the patch directory
10815 and email address. In this example, the email address is a mailing
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010816 list::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010817
Andrew Geissler5199d832021-09-24 16:47:35 -050010818 $ poky/scripts/send-pull-request -p ~/meta-intel/pull-10565 -t meta-intel@lists.yoctoproject.org
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010819
10820 You need to follow the prompts as the script is interactive.
10821
10822 .. note::
10823
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050010824 For help on using these scripts, simply provide the ``-h``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010825 argument as follows::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010826
10827 $ poky/scripts/create-pull-request -h
10828 $ poky/scripts/send-pull-request -h
10829
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010830Responding to Patch Review
10831~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010832
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010833You may get feedback on your submitted patches from other community members
10834or from the automated patchtest service. If issues are identified in your
10835patch then it is usually necessary to address these before the patch will be
10836accepted into the project. In this case you should amend the patch according
10837to the feedback and submit an updated version to the relevant mailing list,
10838copying in the reviewers who provided feedback to the previous version of the
10839patch.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010840
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010841The patch should be amended using ``git commit --amend`` or perhaps ``git
10842rebase`` for more expert git users. You should also modify the ``[PATCH]``
10843tag in the email subject line when sending the revised patch to mark the new
10844iteration as ``[PATCH v2]``, ``[PATCH v3]``, etc as appropriate. This can be
10845done by passing the ``-v`` argument to ``git format-patch`` with a version
10846number.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010847
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010848Lastly please ensure that you also test your revised changes. In particular
10849please don't just edit the patch file written out by ``git format-patch`` and
10850resend it.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010851
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010852Submitting Changes to Stable Release Branches
10853~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010854
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010855The process for proposing changes to a Yocto Project stable branch differs
10856from the steps described above. Changes to a stable branch must address
10857identified bugs or CVEs and should be made carefully in order to avoid the
10858risk of introducing new bugs or breaking backwards compatibility. Typically
10859bug fixes must already be accepted into the master branch before they can be
10860backported to a stable branch unless the bug in question does not affect the
10861master branch or the fix on the master branch is unsuitable for backporting.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010862
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010863The list of stable branches along with the status and maintainer for each
10864branch can be obtained from the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010865:yocto_wiki:`Releases wiki page </Releases>`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010866
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010867.. note::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010868
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010869 Changes will not typically be accepted for branches which are marked as
10870 End-Of-Life (EOL).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010871
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010872With this in mind, the steps to submit a change for a stable branch are as
10873follows:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010874
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -0600108751. *Identify the bug or CVE to be fixed:* This information should be
10876 collected so that it can be included in your submission.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010877
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050010878 See :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:checking for vulnerabilities`
10879 for details about CVE tracking.
10880
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -0600108812. *Check if the fix is already present in the master branch:* This will
10882 result in the most straightforward path into the stable branch for the
10883 fix.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010884
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050010885 a. *If the fix is present in the master branch --- submit a backport request
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010886 by email:* You should send an email to the relevant stable branch
10887 maintainer and the mailing list with details of the bug or CVE to be
10888 fixed, the commit hash on the master branch that fixes the issue and
10889 the stable branches which you would like this fix to be backported to.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010890
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050010891 b. *If the fix is not present in the master branch --- submit the fix to the
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010892 master branch first:* This will ensure that the fix passes through the
10893 project's usual patch review and test processes before being accepted.
10894 It will also ensure that bugs are not left unresolved in the master
10895 branch itself. Once the fix is accepted in the master branch a backport
10896 request can be submitted as above.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010897
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050010898 c. *If the fix is unsuitable for the master branch --- submit a patch
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010899 directly for the stable branch:* This method should be considered as a
10900 last resort. It is typically necessary when the master branch is using
10901 a newer version of the software which includes an upstream fix for the
10902 issue or when the issue has been fixed on the master branch in a way
10903 that introduces backwards incompatible changes. In this case follow the
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010904 steps in :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:preparing changes for submission` and
10905 :ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:using email to submit a patch` but modify the subject header of your patch
Andrew Geissler6ce62a22020-11-30 19:58:47 -060010906 email to include the name of the stable branch which you are
10907 targetting. This can be done using the ``--subject-prefix`` argument to
10908 ``git format-patch``, for example to submit a patch to the dunfell
10909 branch use
10910 ``git format-patch --subject-prefix='&DISTRO_NAME_NO_CAP_MINUS_ONE;][PATCH' ...``.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010911
10912Working With Licenses
10913=====================
10914
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060010915As mentioned in the ":ref:`overview-manual/development-environment:licensing`"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010916section in the Yocto Project Overview and Concepts Manual, open source
10917projects are open to the public and they consequently have different
10918licensing structures in place. This section describes the mechanism by
10919which the :term:`OpenEmbedded Build System`
10920tracks changes to
10921licensing text and covers how to maintain open source license compliance
10922during your project's lifecycle. The section also describes how to
10923enable commercially licensed recipes, which by default are disabled.
10924
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010925Tracking License Changes
10926------------------------
10927
10928The license of an upstream project might change in the future. In order
10929to prevent these changes going unnoticed, the
10930:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`
10931variable tracks changes to the license text. The checksums are validated
10932at the end of the configure step, and if the checksums do not match, the
10933build will fail.
10934
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010935Specifying the ``LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`` Variable
10936~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10937
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010938The :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` variable contains checksums of the license text
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010939in the source code for the recipe. Following is an example of how to
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010940specify :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010941
10942 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://COPYING;md5=xxxx \
10943 file://licfile1.txt;beginline=5;endline=29;md5=yyyy \
10944 file://licfile2.txt;endline=50;md5=zzzz \
10945 ..."
10946
10947.. note::
10948
10949 - When using "beginline" and "endline", realize that line numbering
10950 begins with one and not zero. Also, the included lines are
10951 inclusive (i.e. lines five through and including 29 in the
10952 previous example for ``licfile1.txt``).
10953
10954 - When a license check fails, the selected license text is included
10955 as part of the QA message. Using this output, you can determine
10956 the exact start and finish for the needed license text.
10957
10958The build system uses the :term:`S`
10959variable as the default directory when searching files listed in
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010960:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM`. The previous example employs the default
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010961directory.
10962
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050010963Consider this next example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010964
10965 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://src/ls.c;beginline=5;endline=16;\
10966 md5=bb14ed3c4cda583abc85401304b5cd4e"
10967 LIC_FILES_CHKSUM = "file://${WORKDIR}/license.html;md5=5c94767cedb5d6987c902ac850ded2c6"
10968
10969The first line locates a file in ``${S}/src/ls.c`` and isolates lines
10970five through 16 as license text. The second line refers to a file in
10971:term:`WORKDIR`.
10972
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010973Note that :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` variable is mandatory for all recipes,
10974unless the :term:`LICENSE` variable is set to "CLOSED".
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010975
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010976Explanation of Syntax
10977~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
10978
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010979As mentioned in the previous section, the :term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` variable
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050010980lists all the important files that contain the license text for the
10981source code. It is possible to specify a checksum for an entire file, or
10982a specific section of a file (specified by beginning and ending line
10983numbers with the "beginline" and "endline" parameters, respectively).
10984The latter is useful for source files with a license notice header,
10985README documents, and so forth. If you do not use the "beginline"
10986parameter, then it is assumed that the text begins on the first line of
10987the file. Similarly, if you do not use the "endline" parameter, it is
10988assumed that the license text ends with the last line of the file.
10989
10990The "md5" parameter stores the md5 checksum of the license text. If the
10991license text changes in any way as compared to this parameter then a
10992mismatch occurs. This mismatch triggers a build failure and notifies the
10993developer. Notification allows the developer to review and address the
10994license text changes. Also note that if a mismatch occurs during the
10995build, the correct md5 checksum is placed in the build log and can be
10996easily copied to the recipe.
10997
10998There is no limit to how many files you can specify using the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050010999:term:`LIC_FILES_CHKSUM` variable. Generally, however, every project
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011000requires a few specifications for license tracking. Many projects have a
11001"COPYING" file that stores the license information for all the source
11002code files. This practice allows you to just track the "COPYING" file as
11003long as it is kept up to date.
11004
11005.. note::
11006
11007 - If you specify an empty or invalid "md5" parameter,
11008 :term:`BitBake` returns an md5
11009 mis-match error and displays the correct "md5" parameter value
11010 during the build. The correct parameter is also captured in the
11011 build log.
11012
11013 - If the whole file contains only license text, you do not need to
11014 use the "beginline" and "endline" parameters.
11015
11016Enabling Commercially Licensed Recipes
11017--------------------------------------
11018
11019By default, the OpenEmbedded build system disables components that have
11020commercial or other special licensing requirements. Such requirements
11021are defined on a recipe-by-recipe basis through the
11022:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` variable
11023definition in the affected recipe. For instance, the
11024``poky/meta/recipes-multimedia/gstreamer/gst-plugins-ugly`` recipe
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011025contains the following statement::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011026
11027 LICENSE_FLAGS = "commercial"
11028
11029Here is a
11030slightly more complicated example that contains both an explicit recipe
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011031name and version (after variable expansion)::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011032
11033 LICENSE_FLAGS = "license_${PN}_${PV}"
11034
11035In order for a component restricted by a
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050011036:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` definition to be enabled and included in an image, it
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011037needs to have a matching entry in the global
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011038:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011039variable, which is a variable typically defined in your ``local.conf``
11040file. For example, to enable the
11041``poky/meta/recipes-multimedia/gstreamer/gst-plugins-ugly`` package, you
11042could add either the string "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly" or the more
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011043general string "commercial" to :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`. See the
Andrew Geissler3b8a17c2021-04-15 15:55:55 -050011044":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:license flag matching`" section for a full
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050011045explanation of how :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` matching works. Here is the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011046example::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011047
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011048 LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED = "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011049
11050Likewise, to additionally enable the package built from the recipe
11051containing ``LICENSE_FLAGS = "license_${PN}_${PV}"``, and assuming that
11052the actual recipe name was ``emgd_1.10.bb``, the following string would
11053enable that package as well as the original ``gst-plugins-ugly``
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011054package::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011055
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011056 LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED = "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly license_emgd_1.10"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011057
11058As a convenience, you do not need to specify the
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011059complete license string for every package. You can use
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011060an abbreviated form, which consists of just the first portion or
11061portions of the license string before the initial underscore character
11062or characters. A partial string will match any license that contains the
11063given string as the first portion of its license. For example, the
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011064following value will also match both of the packages
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011065previously mentioned as well as any other packages that have licenses
11066starting with "commercial" or "license".
11067::
11068
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011069 LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED = "commercial license"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011070
11071License Flag Matching
11072~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11073
11074License flag matching allows you to control what recipes the
11075OpenEmbedded build system includes in the build. Fundamentally, the
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050011076build system attempts to match :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` strings found in
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011077recipes against strings found in :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`.
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011078A match causes the build system to include a recipe in the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011079build, while failure to find a match causes the build system to exclude
11080a recipe.
11081
11082In general, license flag matching is simple. However, understanding some
11083concepts will help you correctly and effectively use matching.
11084
11085Before a flag defined by a particular recipe is tested against the
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011086entries of :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`, the expanded
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011087string ``_${PN}`` is appended to the flag. This expansion makes each
11088:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` value recipe-specific. After expansion, the
11089string is then matched against the entries. Thus, specifying
11090``LICENSE_FLAGS = "commercial"`` in recipe "foo", for example, results
11091in the string ``"commercial_foo"``. And, to create a match, that string
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011092must appear among the entries of :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011093
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050011094Judicious use of the :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` strings and the contents of the
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011095:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` variable allows you a lot of flexibility for
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011096including or excluding recipes based on licensing. For example, you can
11097broaden the matching capabilities by using license flags string subsets
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011098in :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011099
11100.. note::
11101
11102 When using a string subset, be sure to use the part of the expanded
11103 string that precedes the appended underscore character (e.g.
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011104 ``usethispart_1.3``, ``usethispart_1.4``, and so forth).
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011105
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011106For example, simply specifying the string "commercial" in the
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011107:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` variable matches any expanded
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011108:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` definition that starts with the string
11109"commercial" such as "commercial_foo" and "commercial_bar", which
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011110are the strings the build system automatically generates for
11111hypothetical recipes named "foo" and "bar" assuming those recipes simply
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011112specify the following::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011113
11114 LICENSE_FLAGS = "commercial"
11115
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011116Thus, you can choose to exhaustively enumerate each license flag in the
11117list and allow only specific recipes into the image, or you can use a
11118string subset that causes a broader range of matches to allow a range of
11119recipes into the image.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011120
Andrew Geissler09036742021-06-25 14:25:14 -050011121This scheme works even if the :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS` string already has
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011122``_${PN}`` appended. For example, the build system turns the license
11123flag "commercial_1.2_foo" into "commercial_1.2_foo_foo" and would match
11124both the general "commercial" and the specific "commercial_1.2_foo"
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011125strings found in the :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` variable, as expected.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011126
11127Here are some other scenarios:
11128
11129- You can specify a versioned string in the recipe such as
11130 "commercial_foo_1.2" in a "foo" recipe. The build system expands this
11131 string to "commercial_foo_1.2_foo". Combine this license flag with a
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011132 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` variable that has the string
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011133 "commercial" and you match the flag along with any other flag that
11134 starts with the string "commercial".
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011135
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011136- Under the same circumstances, you can add "commercial_foo" in the
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011137 :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` variable and the build system not only
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011138 matches "commercial_foo_1.2" but also matches any license flag with
11139 the string "commercial_foo", regardless of the version.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011140
11141- You can be very specific and use both the package and version parts
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011142 in the :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` list (e.g.
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011143 "commercial_foo_1.2") to specifically match a versioned recipe.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011144
11145Other Variables Related to Commercial Licenses
11146~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11147
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -070011148There are other helpful variables related to commercial license handling,
11149defined in the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011150``poky/meta/conf/distro/include/default-distrovars.inc`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011151
11152 COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS ?= ""
11153 COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS ?= ""
11154
11155If you
11156want to enable these components, you can do so by making sure you have
11157statements similar to the following in your ``local.conf`` configuration
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011158file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011159
11160 COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS = "gst-plugins-ugly-mad \
11161 gst-plugins-ugly-mpegaudioparse"
11162 COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS = "gst-plugins-ugly-mpeg2dec \
11163 gst-plugins-ugly-mpegstream gst-plugins-bad-mpegvideoparse"
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011164 LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED = "commercial_gst-plugins-ugly commercial_gst-plugins-bad commercial_qmmp"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011165
11166
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011167Of course, you could also create a matching list for those
11168components using the more general "commercial" in the
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011169:term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED` variable, but that would also enable all
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011170the other packages with :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011171containing "commercial", which you may or may not want::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011172
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011173 LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED = "commercial"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011174
11175Specifying audio and video plugins as part of the
11176``COMMERCIAL_AUDIO_PLUGINS`` and ``COMMERCIAL_VIDEO_PLUGINS`` statements
Andrew Geissler9aee5002022-03-30 16:27:02 +000011177(along with the enabling :term:`LICENSE_FLAGS_ACCEPTED`) includes the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011178plugins or components into built images, thus adding support for media
11179formats or components.
11180
11181Maintaining Open Source License Compliance During Your Product's Lifecycle
11182--------------------------------------------------------------------------
11183
11184One of the concerns for a development organization using open source
11185software is how to maintain compliance with various open source
11186licensing during the lifecycle of the product. While this section does
11187not provide legal advice or comprehensively cover all scenarios, it does
11188present methods that you can use to assist you in meeting the compliance
11189requirements during a software release.
11190
11191With hundreds of different open source licenses that the Yocto Project
11192tracks, it is difficult to know the requirements of each and every
11193license. However, the requirements of the major FLOSS licenses can begin
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -070011194to be covered by assuming that there are three main areas of concern:
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011195
11196- Source code must be provided.
11197
11198- License text for the software must be provided.
11199
11200- Compilation scripts and modifications to the source code must be
11201 provided.
11202
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011203- spdx files can be provided.
11204
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011205There are other requirements beyond the scope of these three and the
11206methods described in this section (e.g. the mechanism through which
11207source code is distributed).
11208
11209As different organizations have different methods of complying with open
11210source licensing, this section is not meant to imply that there is only
11211one single way to meet your compliance obligations, but rather to
11212describe one method of achieving compliance. The remainder of this
11213section describes methods supported to meet the previously mentioned
11214three requirements. Once you take steps to meet these requirements, and
11215prior to releasing images, sources, and the build system, you should
11216audit all artifacts to ensure completeness.
11217
11218.. note::
11219
11220 The Yocto Project generates a license manifest during image creation
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011221 that is located in ``${DEPLOY_DIR}/licenses/``\ `image_name`\ ``-``\ `datestamp`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011222 to assist with any audits.
11223
11224Providing the Source Code
11225~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11226
11227Compliance activities should begin before you generate the final image.
11228The first thing you should look at is the requirement that tops the list
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050011229for most compliance groups --- providing the source. The Yocto Project has
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011230a few ways of meeting this requirement.
11231
11232One of the easiest ways to meet this requirement is to provide the
11233entire :term:`DL_DIR` used by the
11234build. This method, however, has a few issues. The most obvious is the
11235size of the directory since it includes all sources used in the build
11236and not just the source used in the released image. It will include
11237toolchain source, and other artifacts, which you would not generally
11238release. However, the more serious issue for most companies is
11239accidental release of proprietary software. The Yocto Project provides
11240an :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class to
11241help avoid some of these concerns.
11242
Andrew Geissler595f6302022-01-24 19:11:47 +000011243Before you employ :term:`DL_DIR` or the :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>` class, you need to
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011244decide how you choose to provide source. The source ``archiver`` class
11245can generate tarballs and SRPMs and can create them with various levels
11246of compliance in mind.
11247
11248One way of doing this (but certainly not the only way) is to release
11249just the source as a tarball. You can do this by adding the following to
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011250the ``local.conf`` file found in the :term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011251
11252 INHERIT += "archiver"
11253 ARCHIVER_MODE[src] = "original"
11254
11255During the creation of your
11256image, the source from all recipes that deploy packages to the image is
11257placed within subdirectories of ``DEPLOY_DIR/sources`` based on the
11258:term:`LICENSE` for each recipe.
11259Releasing the entire directory enables you to comply with requirements
11260concerning providing the unmodified source. It is important to note that
11261the size of the directory can get large.
11262
11263A way to help mitigate the size issue is to only release tarballs for
11264licenses that require the release of source. Let us assume you are only
11265concerned with GPL code as identified by running the following script:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011266
11267.. code-block:: shell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011268
11269 # Script to archive a subset of packages matching specific license(s)
11270 # Source and license files are copied into sub folders of package folder
11271 # Must be run from build folder
11272 #!/bin/bash
11273 src_release_dir="source-release"
11274 mkdir -p $src_release_dir
11275 for a in tmp/deploy/sources/*; do
11276 for d in $a/*; do
11277 # Get package name from path
11278 p=`basename $d`
11279 p=${p%-*}
11280 p=${p%-*}
11281 # Only archive GPL packages (update *GPL* regex for your license check)
11282 numfiles=`ls tmp/deploy/licenses/$p/*GPL* 2> /dev/null | wc -l`
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011283 if [ $numfiles -ge 1 ]; then
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011284 echo Archiving $p
11285 mkdir -p $src_release_dir/$p/source
11286 cp $d/* $src_release_dir/$p/source 2> /dev/null
11287 mkdir -p $src_release_dir/$p/license
11288 cp tmp/deploy/licenses/$p/* $src_release_dir/$p/license 2> /dev/null
11289 fi
11290 done
11291 done
11292
11293At this point, you
11294could create a tarball from the ``gpl_source_release`` directory and
11295provide that to the end user. This method would be a step toward
11296achieving compliance with section 3a of GPLv2 and with section 6 of
11297GPLv3.
11298
11299Providing License Text
11300~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11301
11302One requirement that is often overlooked is inclusion of license text.
11303This requirement also needs to be dealt with prior to generating the
11304final image. Some licenses require the license text to accompany the
11305binary. You can achieve this by adding the following to your
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011306``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011307
11308 COPY_LIC_MANIFEST = "1"
11309 COPY_LIC_DIRS = "1"
11310 LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE = "1"
11311
11312Adding these statements to the
11313configuration file ensures that the licenses collected during package
11314generation are included on your image.
11315
11316.. note::
11317
11318 Setting all three variables to "1" results in the image having two
11319 copies of the same license file. One copy resides in
11320 ``/usr/share/common-licenses`` and the other resides in
11321 ``/usr/share/license``.
11322
11323 The reason for this behavior is because
11324 :term:`COPY_LIC_DIRS` and
11325 :term:`COPY_LIC_MANIFEST`
11326 add a copy of the license when the image is built but do not offer a
11327 path for adding licenses for newly installed packages to an image.
11328 :term:`LICENSE_CREATE_PACKAGE`
11329 adds a separate package and an upgrade path for adding licenses to an
11330 image.
11331
11332As the source ``archiver`` class has already archived the original
11333unmodified source that contains the license files, you would have
11334already met the requirements for inclusion of the license information
11335with source as defined by the GPL and other open source licenses.
11336
11337Providing Compilation Scripts and Source Code Modifications
11338~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11339
11340At this point, we have addressed all we need to prior to generating the
11341image. The next two requirements are addressed during the final
11342packaging of the release.
11343
11344By releasing the version of the OpenEmbedded build system and the layers
11345used during the build, you will be providing both compilation scripts
11346and the source code modifications in one step.
11347
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060011348If the deployment team has a :ref:`overview-manual/concepts:bsp layer`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011349and a distro layer, and those
11350those layers are used to patch, compile, package, or modify (in any way)
11351any open source software included in your released images, you might be
11352required to release those layers under section 3 of GPLv2 or section 1
11353of GPLv3. One way of doing that is with a clean checkout of the version
11354of the Yocto Project and layers used during your build. Here is an
11355example:
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011356
11357.. code-block:: shell
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011358
11359 # We built using the dunfell branch of the poky repo
11360 $ git clone -b dunfell git://git.yoctoproject.org/poky
11361 $ cd poky
11362 # We built using the release_branch for our layers
11363 $ git clone -b release_branch git://git.mycompany.com/meta-my-bsp-layer
11364 $ git clone -b release_branch git://git.mycompany.com/meta-my-software-layer
11365 # clean up the .git repos
11366 $ find . -name ".git" -type d -exec rm -rf {} \;
11367
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -050011368One thing a development organization might want to consider for end-user
11369convenience is to modify
11370``meta-poky/conf/templates/default/bblayers.conf.sample`` to ensure that when
11371the end user utilizes the released build system to build an image, the
11372development organization's layers are included in the ``bblayers.conf`` file
11373automatically::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011374
11375 # POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION is increased each time build/conf/bblayers.conf
11376 # changes incompatibly
11377 POKY_BBLAYERS_CONF_VERSION = "2"
11378
11379 BBPATH = "${TOPDIR}"
11380 BBFILES ?= ""
11381
11382 BBLAYERS ?= " \
11383 ##OEROOT##/meta \
11384 ##OEROOT##/meta-poky \
11385 ##OEROOT##/meta-yocto-bsp \
11386 ##OEROOT##/meta-mylayer \
11387 "
11388
11389Creating and
11390providing an archive of the :term:`Metadata`
11391layers (recipes, configuration files, and so forth) enables you to meet
11392your requirements to include the scripts to control compilation as well
11393as any modifications to the original source.
11394
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011395Providing spdx files
11396~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11397
11398The spdx module has been integrated to a layer named meta-spdxscanner.
11399meta-spdxscanner provides several kinds of scanner. If you want to enable
11400this function, you have to follow the following steps:
11401
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -0500114021. Add meta-spdxscanner layer into ``bblayers.conf``.
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011403
Andrew Geissler87f5cff2022-09-30 13:13:31 -0500114042. Refer to the README in meta-spdxscanner to setup the environment (e.g,
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011405 setup a fossology server) needed for the scanner.
11406
114073. Meta-spdxscanner provides several methods within the bbclass to create spdx files.
11408 Please choose one that you want to use and enable the spdx task. You have to
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011409 add some config options in ``local.conf`` file in your :term:`Build Directory`.
11410 Here is an example showing how to generate spdx files during BitBake using the
11411 fossology-python.bbclass::
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011412
11413 # Select fossology-python.bbclass.
11414 INHERIT += "fossology-python"
11415 # For fossology-python.bbclass, TOKEN is necessary, so, after setup a
11416 # Fossology server, you have to create a token.
11417 TOKEN = "eyJ0eXAiO..."
11418 # The fossology server is necessary for fossology-python.bbclass.
11419 FOSSOLOGY_SERVER = "http://xx.xx.xx.xx:8081/repo"
11420 # If you want to upload the source code to a special folder:
11421 FOLDER_NAME = "xxxx" //Optional
11422 # If you don't want to put spdx files in tmp/deploy/spdx, you can enable:
11423 SPDX_DEPLOY_DIR = "${DEPLOY_DIR}" //Optional
11424
11425For more usage information refer to :yocto_git:`the meta-spdxscanner repository
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060011426</meta-spdxscanner/>`.
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011427
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -050011428Compliance Limitations with Executables Built from Static Libraries
11429~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011430
Andrew Geisslereff27472021-10-29 15:35:00 -050011431When package A is added to an image via the :term:`RDEPENDS` or :term:`RRECOMMENDS`
11432mechanisms as well as explicitly included in the image recipe with
11433:term:`IMAGE_INSTALL`, and depends on a static linked library recipe B
11434(``DEPENDS += "B"``), package B will neither appear in the generated license
11435manifest nor in the generated source tarballs. This occurs as the
11436:ref:`license <ref-classes-license>` and :ref:`archiver <ref-classes-archiver>`
11437classes assume that only packages included via :term:`RDEPENDS` or :term:`RRECOMMENDS`
11438end up in the image.
11439
11440As a result, potential obligations regarding license compliance for package B
11441may not be met.
11442
11443The Yocto Project doesn't enable static libraries by default, in part because
11444of this issue. Before a solution to this limitation is found, you need to
11445keep in mind that if your root filesystem is built from static libraries,
11446you will need to manually ensure that your deliveries are compliant
11447with the licenses of these libraries.
11448
11449Copying Non Standard Licenses
11450-----------------------------
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011451
11452Some packages, such as the linux-firmware package, have many licenses
11453that are not in any way common. You can avoid adding a lot of these
11454types of common license files, which are only applicable to a specific
11455package, by using the
11456:term:`NO_GENERIC_LICENSE`
11457variable. Using this variable also avoids QA errors when you use a
11458non-common, non-CLOSED license in a recipe.
11459
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -070011460Here is an example that uses the ``LICENSE.Abilis.txt`` file as
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011461the license from the fetched source::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011462
11463 NO_GENERIC_LICENSE[Firmware-Abilis] = "LICENSE.Abilis.txt"
11464
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011465Checking for Vulnerabilities
11466============================
11467
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011468Vulnerabilities in Poky and OE-Core
11469-----------------------------------
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011470
11471The Yocto Project has an infrastructure to track and address unfixed
11472known security vulnerabilities, as tracked by the public
11473`Common Vulnerabilities and Exposures (CVE) <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Common_Vulnerabilities_and_Exposures>`__
11474database.
11475
Andrew Geissler615f2f12022-07-15 14:00:58 -050011476The Yocto Project maintains a `list of known vulnerabilities
11477<https://autobuilder.yocto.io/pub/non-release/patchmetrics/>`__
11478for packages in Poky and OE-Core, tracking the evolution of the number of
11479unpatched CVEs and the status of patches. Such information is available for
11480the current development version and for each supported release.
11481
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011482Security is a process, not a product, and thus at any time, a number of security
11483issues may be impacting Poky and OE-Core. It is up to the maintainers, users,
11484contributors and anyone interested in the issues to investigate and possibly fix them by
11485updating software components to newer versions or by applying patches to address them.
11486It is recommended to work with Poky and OE-Core upstream maintainers and submit
11487patches to fix them, see ":ref:`dev-manual/common-tasks:submitting a change to the yocto project`" for details.
11488
11489Vulnerability check at build time
11490---------------------------------
11491
11492To enable a check for CVE security vulnerabilities using :ref:`cve-check <ref-classes-cve-check>` in the specific image
11493or target you are building, add the following setting to your configuration::
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011494
11495 INHERIT += "cve-check"
11496
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011497The CVE database contains some old incomplete entries which have been
11498deemed not to impact Poky or OE-Core. These CVE entries can be excluded from the
11499check using build configuration::
11500
11501 include conf/distro/include/cve-extra-exclusions.inc
11502
11503With this CVE check enabled, BitBake build will try to map each compiled software component
11504recipe name and version information to the CVE database and generate recipe and
11505image specific reports. These reports will contain:
11506
11507- metadata about the software component like names and versions
11508
11509- metadata about the CVE issue such as description and NVD link
11510
11511- for each software component, a list of CVEs which are possibly impacting this version
11512
11513- status of each CVE: ``Patched``, ``Unpatched`` or ``Ignored``
11514
11515The status ``Patched`` means that a patch file to address the security issue has been
11516applied. ``Unpatched`` status means that no patches to address the issue have been
11517applied and that the issue needs to be investigated. ``Ignored`` means that after
11518analysis, it has been deemed to ignore the issue as it for example affects
11519the software component on a different operating system platform.
11520
11521After build with CVE check enabled, reports for each compiled source recipe will be
11522found in ``build/tmp/deploy/cve``.
11523
11524For example the CVE check report for the ``flex-native`` recipe looks like::
11525
11526 $ cat poky/build/tmp/deploy/cve/flex-native
11527 LAYER: meta
11528 PACKAGE NAME: flex-native
11529 PACKAGE VERSION: 2.6.4
11530 CVE: CVE-2016-6354
11531 CVE STATUS: Patched
11532 CVE SUMMARY: Heap-based buffer overflow in the yy_get_next_buffer function in Flex before 2.6.1 might allow context-dependent attackers to cause a denial of service or possibly execute arbitrary code via vectors involving num_to_read.
11533 CVSS v2 BASE SCORE: 7.5
11534 CVSS v3 BASE SCORE: 9.8
11535 VECTOR: NETWORK
11536 MORE INFORMATION: https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/detail/CVE-2016-6354
11537
11538 LAYER: meta
11539 PACKAGE NAME: flex-native
11540 PACKAGE VERSION: 2.6.4
11541 CVE: CVE-2019-6293
11542 CVE STATUS: Ignored
11543 CVE SUMMARY: An issue was discovered in the function mark_beginning_as_normal in nfa.c in flex 2.6.4. There is a stack exhaustion problem caused by the mark_beginning_as_normal function making recursive calls to itself in certain scenarios involving lots of '*' characters. Remote attackers could leverage this vulnerability to cause a denial-of-service.
11544 CVSS v2 BASE SCORE: 4.3
11545 CVSS v3 BASE SCORE: 5.5
11546 VECTOR: NETWORK
11547 MORE INFORMATION: https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/detail/CVE-2019-6293
11548
11549For images, a summary of all recipes included in the image and their CVEs is also
11550generated in textual and JSON formats. These ``.cve`` and ``.json`` reports can be found
11551in the ``tmp/deploy/images`` directory for each compiled image.
11552
11553At build time CVE check will also throw warnings about ``Unpatched`` CVEs::
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011554
11555 WARNING: flex-2.6.4-r0 do_cve_check: Found unpatched CVE (CVE-2019-6293), for more information check /poky/build/tmp/work/core2-64-poky-linux/flex/2.6.4-r0/temp/cve.log
11556 WARNING: libarchive-3.5.1-r0 do_cve_check: Found unpatched CVE (CVE-2021-36976), for more information check /poky/build/tmp/work/core2-64-poky-linux/libarchive/3.5.1-r0/temp/cve.log
11557
11558It is also possible to check the CVE status of individual packages as follows::
11559
11560 bitbake -c cve_check flex libarchive
11561
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011562Fixing CVE product name and version mappings
11563--------------------------------------------
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011564
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011565By default, :ref:`cve-check <ref-classes-cve-check>` uses the recipe name :term:`BPN` as CVE
11566product name when querying the CVE database. If this mapping contains false positives, e.g.
11567some reported CVEs are not for the software component in question, or false negatives like
11568some CVEs are not found to impact the recipe when they should, then the problems can be
11569in the recipe name to CVE product mapping. These mapping issues can be fixed by setting
11570the :term:`CVE_PRODUCT` variable inside the recipe. This defines the name of software component in the
11571upstream `NIST CVE database <https://nvd.nist.gov/>`__.
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011572
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011573The variable supports using vendor and product names like this::
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011574
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011575 CVE_PRODUCT = "flex_project:flex"
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011576
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011577In this example from the vendor name used in CVE database is ``flex_project`` and
11578product is ``flex``. With this setting the ``flex`` recipe only maps to this specific
11579product and not products from other vendors with same name ``flex``.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011580
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011581Similary, when the recipe version :term:`PV` is not compatible with software versions used by
11582the upstream software component releases and the CVE database, these can be fixed using
11583:term:`CVE_VERSION` variable.
11584
11585Note that if the CVE entries in NVD databse contain bugs or have missing or incomplete
11586information, it is recommended to fix the information there directly instead of working
11587around the issues for a possibly long time in Poky and OE-Core side recipes. Feedback to
11588NVD about CVEs entries can be provided through the `NVD contact form <https://nvd.nist.gov/info/contact-form>`__.
11589
11590Fixing vulnerabilities in recipes
11591---------------------------------
11592
11593If a CVE security issue impacts a software component, it can be fixed by updating to a newer
11594version of the software component or by applying a patch. For Poky and OE-Core master branches, updating
11595to newer software component release with fixes is the best option, but patches can be applied
11596if releases are not yet available.
11597
11598For stable branches, it is preferred to apply patches for the issues. For some software
11599components minor version updates can also applied if they are backwards compatible.
11600
11601Here is an example of fixing CVE security issues with patch files,
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011602an example from the :oe_layerindex:`ffmpeg recipe</layerindex/recipe/47350>`::
11603
11604 SRC_URI = "https://www.ffmpeg.org/releases/${BP}.tar.xz \
11605 file://0001-libavutil-include-assembly-with-full-path-from-sourc.patch \
11606 file://fix-CVE-2020-20446.patch \
11607 file://fix-CVE-2020-20453.patch \
11608 file://fix-CVE-2020-22015.patch \
11609 file://fix-CVE-2020-22021.patch \
11610 file://fix-CVE-2020-22033-CVE-2020-22019.patch \
11611 file://fix-CVE-2021-33815.patch \
11612
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011613A good practice is to include the CVE identifier in both patch file name
11614and inside the patch file commit message use the format::
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011615
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011616 CVE: CVE-2020-22033
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011617
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011618CVE checker will then capture this information and change the CVE status to ``Patched``
11619in the generated reports.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011620
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011621If analysis shows that the CVE issue does not impact the recipe due to configuration, platform,
11622version or other reasons, the CVE can be marked as ``Ignored`` using :term:`CVE_CHECK_IGNORE` variable.
11623As mentioned previously, if data in the CVE database is wrong, it is recommend to fix those
11624issues in the CVE database directly.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011625
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011626Recipes can be completely skipped by CVE check by including the recipe name in
11627the :term:`CVE_CHECK_SKIP_RECIPE` variable.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011628
11629Implementation details
11630----------------------
11631
11632Here's what the :ref:`cve-check <ref-classes-cve-check>` class does to
11633find unpatched CVE IDs.
11634
11635First the code goes through each patch file provided by a recipe. If a valid CVE ID
11636is found in the name of the file, the corresponding CVE is considered as patched.
11637Don't forget that if multiple CVE IDs are found in the filename, only the last
11638one is considered. Then, the code looks for ``CVE: CVE-ID`` lines in the patch
11639file. The found CVE IDs are also considered as patched.
11640
11641Then, the code looks up all the CVE IDs in the NIST database for all the
11642products defined in :term:`CVE_PRODUCT`. Then, for each found CVE:
11643
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011644- If the package name (:term:`PN`) is part of
11645 :term:`CVE_CHECK_SKIP_RECIPE`, it is considered as ``Patched``.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011646
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011647- If the CVE ID is part of :term:`CVE_CHECK_IGNORE`, it is
11648 set as ``Ignored``.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011649
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011650- If the CVE ID is part of the patched CVE for the recipe, it is
11651 already considered as ``Patched``.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011652
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011653- Otherwise, the code checks whether the recipe version (:term:`PV`)
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011654 is within the range of versions impacted by the CVE. If so, the CVE
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011655 is considered as ``Unpatched``.
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011656
Patrick Williams213cb262021-08-07 19:21:33 -050011657The CVE database is stored in :term:`DL_DIR` and can be inspected using
11658``sqlite3`` command as follows::
11659
11660 sqlite3 downloads/CVE_CHECK/nvdcve_1.1.db .dump | grep CVE-2021-37462
11661
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011662When analyzing CVEs, it is recommended to:
11663
11664- study the latest information in `CVE database <https://nvd.nist.gov/vuln/search>`__.
11665
11666- check how upstream developers of the software component addressed the issue, e.g.
11667 what patch was applied, which upstream release contains the fix.
11668
11669- check what other Linux distributions like `Debian <https://security-tracker.debian.org/tracker/>`__
11670 did to analyze and address the issue.
11671
11672- follow security notices from other Linux distributions.
11673
11674- follow public `open source security mailing lists <https://oss-security.openwall.org/wiki/mailing-lists>`__ for
11675 discussions and advance notifications of CVE bugs and software releases with fixes.
11676
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011677Using the Error Reporting Tool
11678==============================
11679
11680The error reporting tool allows you to submit errors encountered during
11681builds to a central database. Outside of the build environment, you can
11682use a web interface to browse errors, view statistics, and query for
11683errors. The tool works using a client-server system where the client
11684portion is integrated with the installed Yocto Project
11685:term:`Source Directory` (e.g. ``poky``).
11686The server receives the information collected and saves it in a
11687database.
11688
William A. Kennington IIIac69b482021-06-02 12:28:27 -070011689There is a live instance of the error reporting server at
11690https://errors.yoctoproject.org.
11691When you want to get help with build failures, you can submit all of the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011692information on the failure easily and then point to the URL in your bug
11693report or send an email to the mailing list.
11694
11695.. note::
11696
11697 If you send error reports to this server, the reports become publicly
11698 visible.
11699
11700Enabling and Using the Tool
11701---------------------------
11702
11703By default, the error reporting tool is disabled. You can enable it by
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011704inheriting the :ref:`report-error <ref-classes-report-error>`
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011705class by adding the following statement to the end of your
Patrick Williams2390b1b2022-11-03 13:47:49 -050011706``local.conf`` file in your :term:`Build Directory`::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011707
11708 INHERIT += "report-error"
11709
11710By default, the error reporting feature stores information in
11711``${``\ :term:`LOG_DIR`\ ``}/error-report``.
11712However, you can specify a directory to use by adding the following to
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011713your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011714
11715 ERR_REPORT_DIR = "path"
11716
11717Enabling error
11718reporting causes the build process to collect the errors and store them
11719in a file as previously described. When the build system encounters an
11720error, it includes a command as part of the console output. You can run
11721the command to send the error file to the server. For example, the
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011722following command sends the errors to an upstream server::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011723
11724 $ send-error-report /home/brandusa/project/poky/build/tmp/log/error-report/error_report_201403141617.txt
11725
11726In the previous example, the errors are sent to a public database
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011727available at https://errors.yoctoproject.org, which is used by the
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011728entire community. If you specify a particular server, you can send the
11729errors to a different database. Use the following command for more
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011730information on available options::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011731
11732 $ send-error-report --help
11733
11734When sending the error file, you are prompted to review the data being
11735sent as well as to provide a name and optional email address. Once you
11736satisfy these prompts, the command returns a link from the server that
11737corresponds to your entry in the database. For example, here is a
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011738typical link: https://errors.yoctoproject.org/Errors/Details/9522/
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011739
11740Following the link takes you to a web interface where you can browse,
11741query the errors, and view statistics.
11742
11743Disabling the Tool
11744------------------
11745
11746To disable the error reporting feature, simply remove or comment out the
11747following statement from the end of your ``local.conf`` file in your
11748:term:`Build Directory`.
11749::
11750
11751 INHERIT += "report-error"
11752
11753Setting Up Your Own Error Reporting Server
11754------------------------------------------
11755
11756If you want to set up your own error reporting server, you can obtain
Andrew Geissler09209ee2020-12-13 08:44:15 -060011757the code from the Git repository at :yocto_git:`/error-report-web/`.
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011758Instructions on how to set it up are in the README document.
11759
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011760Using Wayland and Weston
11761========================
11762
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011763`Wayland <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Wayland_(display_server_protocol)>`__
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011764is a computer display server protocol that provides a method for
11765compositing window managers to communicate directly with applications
11766and video hardware and expects them to communicate with input hardware
11767using other libraries. Using Wayland with supporting targets can result
11768in better control over graphics frame rendering than an application
11769might otherwise achieve.
11770
11771The Yocto Project provides the Wayland protocol libraries and the
11772reference
Andrew Geissler4c19ea12020-10-27 13:52:24 -050011773`Weston <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Wayland_(display_server_protocol)#Weston>`__
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011774compositor as part of its release. You can find the integrated packages
11775in the ``meta`` layer of the :term:`Source Directory`.
11776Specifically, you
11777can find the recipes that build both Wayland and Weston at
11778``meta/recipes-graphics/wayland``.
11779
11780You can build both the Wayland and Weston packages for use only with
11781targets that accept the `Mesa 3D and Direct Rendering
11782Infrastructure <https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mesa_(computer_graphics)>`__,
11783which is also known as Mesa DRI. This implies that you cannot build and
11784use the packages if your target uses, for example, the Intel Embedded
11785Media and Graphics Driver (Intel EMGD) that overrides Mesa DRI.
11786
11787.. note::
11788
11789 Due to lack of EGL support, Weston 1.0.3 will not run directly on the
11790 emulated QEMU hardware. However, this version of Weston will run
11791 under X emulation without issues.
11792
11793This section describes what you need to do to implement Wayland and use
11794the Weston compositor when building an image for a supporting target.
11795
11796Enabling Wayland in an Image
11797----------------------------
11798
11799To enable Wayland, you need to enable it to be built and enable it to be
11800included (installed) in the image.
11801
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011802Building Wayland
11803~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11804
11805To cause Mesa to build the ``wayland-egl`` platform and Weston to build
11806Wayland with Kernel Mode Setting
11807(`KMS <https://wiki.archlinux.org/index.php/Kernel_Mode_Setting>`__)
11808support, include the "wayland" flag in the
11809:term:`DISTRO_FEATURES`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011810statement in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011811
Patrick Williams0ca19cc2021-08-16 14:03:13 -050011812 DISTRO_FEATURES:append = " wayland"
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011813
11814.. note::
11815
11816 If X11 has been enabled elsewhere, Weston will build Wayland with X11
11817 support
11818
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011819Installing Wayland and Weston
11820~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~~
11821
11822To install the Wayland feature into an image, you must include the
11823following
11824:term:`CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL`
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -050011825statement in your ``local.conf`` file::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011826
11827 CORE_IMAGE_EXTRA_INSTALL += "wayland weston"
11828
11829Running Weston
11830--------------
11831
11832To run Weston inside X11, enabling it as described earlier and building
11833a Sato image is sufficient. If you are running your image under Sato, a
11834Weston Launcher appears in the "Utility" category.
11835
11836Alternatively, you can run Weston through the command-line interpretor
11837(CLI), which is better suited for development work. To run Weston under
11838the CLI, you need to do the following after your image is built:
11839
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500118401. Run these commands to export ``XDG_RUNTIME_DIR``::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011841
11842 mkdir -p /tmp/$USER-weston
11843 chmod 0700 /tmp/$USER-weston
11844 export XDG_RUNTIME_DIR=/tmp/$USER-weston
11845
Andrew Geisslerc926e172021-05-07 16:11:35 -0500118462. Launch Weston in the shell::
Andrew Geisslerc9f78652020-09-18 14:11:35 -050011847
11848 weston